Table of Contents

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

 


FORM 10-K

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2016

OR

 

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from                      to                       

Commission File Number: 001-35654

 


NATIONAL BANK HOLDINGS CORPORATION

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 


 

 

Delaware

27-0563799

(State or other jurisdiction of

incorporation or organization)

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification No.)

 

7800 East Orchard Road, Suite 300, Greenwood Village, Colorado 80111

(Address of principal executive offices) (Zip Code)

Registrant’s telephone, including area code:

(720) 529-3336


Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

 

 

Title of each class

 

Name of each exchange on which registered

Class A Common Stock, Par Value $0.01

 

New York Stock Exchange

 

Securities registered pursuant to section 12(g) of the Act:

None


Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes       No  

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes       No  

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes       No  

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes       No  

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See definitions of “accelerated filer.” and “large accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Large accelerated filer

 

Accelerated filer

 

Non-accelerated filer

(do not check if a smaller reporting company)

Smaller Reporting Company

 

 

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (§ 229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.   

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes       No  

 

As of June 30, 2016, the aggregate market value of the registrant’s common stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant was approximately $565,000,000 based on the closing sale price as reported on the New York Stock Exchange.

 

APPLICABLE ONLY TO CORPORATE ISSUERS:

 

Indicate the number of shares outstanding of each of the issuer’s classes of common stock, as of the latest practicable date.

 

As of February 21, 2017, NBHC had outstanding 26,609,973 shares of Class A voting common stock with $0.01 par value per share, excluding 496,775 shares of restricted Class A common stock issued but not yet vested.

 

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

 

Portions of the Registrant’s definitive proxy statement for its 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be filed within 120 days of December 31, 2016 will be incorporated by reference into Part III of this form 10-K.  

 

 

 


 

Table of Contents

 

 

INDE X

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Page

Cautionary Notes Regarding Forward Looking Statements  

3

PART I  

Item 1.

Business

5

 

 

 

 

 

Item 1A.

Risk Factors

19

 

 

 

 

 

Item 1B.

Unresolved Staff Comments

30

 

 

 

 

 

Item 2.

Properties

30

 

 

 

 

 

Item 3.

Legal Proceedings

30

 

 

 

 

 

Item 4.

Mine Safety Disclosures

30

 

 

 

 

PART II  

Item 5.

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Shareholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

31

 

 

 

 

 

Item 6.

Selected Financial Data

34

 

 

 

 

 

Item 7.

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

41

 

 

 

 

 

Item 7A.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

75

 

 

 

 

 

Item 8.

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

76

 

 

 

 

 

Item 9.

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

126

 

 

 

 

 

Item 9A.

Controls and Procedures

126

 

 

 

 

 

Item 9B.

Other Information

128

 

 

 

 

PART III  

Item 10.

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

128

 

 

 

 

 

Item 11.

Executive Compensation

128

 

 

 

 

 

Item 12.

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Shareholder Matters

128

 

 

 

 

 

Item 13.

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

128

 

 

 

 

 

Item 14.

Principal Accountant Fees and Services

128

 

 

 

 

PART IV  

Item 15.

Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

129

 

 

 

 

Signatures  

130

 

 

 

 

Index to Exhibits  

132

 

 

 

 

 


 

Table of Contents

 

CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENT S

 

This report contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, notwithstanding that such statements are not specifically identified. Any statements about our expectations, beliefs, plans, predictions, forecasts, objectives, assumptions or future events or performance are not historical facts and may be forward-looking. These statements are often, but not always, made through the use of words or phrases such as “anticipate,” “believe,” “can,” “would,” “should,” “could,” “may,” “predict,” “seek,” “potential,” “will,” “estimate,” “target,” “plan,” “project,” “continuing,” “ongoing,” “expect,” “intend” and similar words or phrases. These statements are only predictions and involve estimates, known and unknown risks, assumptions and uncertainties. We have based these statements largely on our current expectations and projections about future events and financial trends that we believe may affect our financial condition, liquidity, results of operations, business strategy and growth prospects.

 

Forward-looking statements involve certain important risks, uncertainties and other factors, any of which could cause actual results to differ materially from those in such statements and, therefore, you are cautioned not to place undue reliance on such statements. Factors that could cause actual results to differ from those discussed in the forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to:

 

       our ability to execute our business strategy, as well as changes in our business strategy or development plans;

 

       business and economic conditions generally and in the financial services industry;

 

       economic, market, operational, liquidity, credit and interest rate risks associated with our business;

 

       effects of any changes in trade, monetary and fiscal policies and laws, including the interest rate policies of the Federal Reserve Board;

 

       changes imposed by regulatory agencies to increase our capital to a level greater than the current level required for well-capitalized financial institutions;

 

       effects of inflation, as well as, interest rate, securities market and monetary supply fluctuations;

 

       changes in the economy or supply-demand imbalances affecting local real estate values;

 

       changes in consumer spending, borrowings and savings habits;

 

       our ability to identify potential candidates for, obtain regulatory approval for, and consummate, acquisitions of financial institutions on attractive terms, or at all;

 

       our ability to integrate acquisitions or consolidations and to achieve synergies, operating efficiencies and/or other expected benefits within expected time-frames, or at all, or within expected cost projections, and to preserve the goodwill of acquired financial institutions;

 

       our ability to realize the anticipated benefits from enhancements or updates to our core operating systems from time to time without significant change in our client service or risk to our control environment; 

 

       dependence on information technology and telecommunications systems of third party services providers and the risk of system failures, interruptions or breaches of security, including those that could result in disclosure or misuse of confidential or proprietary client or other information;

 

       our ability to achieve organic loan and deposit growth and the composition of such growth;

 

       changes in sources and uses of funds, including loans, deposits and borrowings;

 

       increased competition in the financial services industry, nationally, regionally or locally, resulting in, among other things, lower returns;

3


 

Table of Contents

 

       the effect of changes in accounting policies and practices, as may be adopted by the regulatory agencies, as well as the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board, the Financial Accounting Standards Board and other accounting standard setters;

 

       the trading price of shares of the Company's stock;

 

       our ability to realize deferred tax assets or the need for a valuation allowance, or the effect of changes in tax laws on our deferred tax assets;

 

       continued consolidation in the financial services industry;

 

       our ability to maintain or increase market share and control expenses;

 

       costs and effects of changes in laws and regulations and of other legal and regulatory developments, including, but not limited to, changes in regulation that affect the fees that we charge, the resolution of legal proceedings or regulatory or other governmental inquiries, and the results of regulatory examinations, reviews or other inquiries; and changes in regulations that apply to us due to the conversion of our bank subsidiary to a Colorado state-chartered bank;

 

       technological changes;

 

       the timely development and acceptance of new products and services and perceived overall value of these products and services by our clients;

 

       changes in our management personnel and our continued ability to hire and retain qualified personnel;

 

        ability to implement and/or improve operational management and other internal risk controls and processes and our reporting system and procedures;

 

       regulatory limitations on dividends from our bank subsidiary;

 

       changes in estimates of future loan reserve requirements based upon the periodic review thereof under relevant regulatory and accounting requirements;

 

       widespread natural and other disasters, dislocations, political instability, acts of war or terrorist activities, cyberattacks or international hostilities through impacts on the economy and financial markets generally or on us or our counterparties specifically;

 

       impact of reputational risk on such matters as business generation and retention;

 

       other risks and uncertainties listed from time to time in the Company’s reports and documents filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission; and

 

       our success at managing the risks involved in the foregoing items.

 

Any forward-looking statement speaks only as of the date on which it is made, and we undertake no obligation to update any forward-looking statement to reflect events or circumstances after the date on which the statement is made or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events or circumstances, except as required by applicable law.

4


 

Table of Contents

PART I: FINANCIAL INFORMATIO N

 

Item 1.       BUSINESS .

 

Summary

 

National Bank Holdings Corporation ("NBHC" or the "Company") is a bank holding company that was incorporated in the State of Delaware in 2009 and is headquartered immediately south of Denver, in Greenwood Village, Colorado. Our primary operations are conducted through our wholly owned subsidiary, NBH Bank, referred to as the "Bank", or "NBH Bank", through which we provide a variety of banking products to both commercial and consumer clients. We service our clients through a network of 91 banking centers, with the majority of those banking centers located in the greater Kansas City area and Colorado, and through online and mobile banking products and services. As of December 31, 2016, we had $4.6 billion in assets, $2.9 billion in loans, $3.9 billion in deposits and $0.5 billion in shareholders’ equity.  

 

The Company was formed through a private offering of our common stock in 2009. As part of our goal of becoming a leading regional community bank holding company, we are pursuing a strategy of organic growth through strong banking relationships with small and medium-sized businesses and consumers in our markets, complemented by selective acquisitions of financial institutions and other complementary businesses. Our long-term business model utilizes our organic development infrastructure, low-risk balance sheet, continuous operational development and a disciplined acquisition strategy to create value and provide attractive returns.

 

We have a management team consisting of experienced banking executives led by Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer G. Timothy Laney. Mr. Laney brings over 30 years of banking experience, 24 of which were at Bank of America in a wide range of executive management roles, including serving on Bank of America’s Management Operating Committee. In late 2007, Mr. Laney joined Regions Financial as Senior Executive Vice President and Head of Business Services. Mr. Laney leads our team of executives that have significant experience in operating banks and completing and integrating mergers and acquisitions. Additionally, our Board of Directors is highly accomplished in the banking industry and includes individuals with broad experience operating and working with financial institutions, regulators, technology and corporate governance considerations.

 

Our Acquisitions

 

In October 2010, we acquired the failed Hillcrest Bank from the FDIC and began banking operations. To date, we have completed five acquisitions of banks, three of which were FDIC-assisted. We have transformed these five banks into one collective banking operation with strong organic growth, prudent underwriting, and meaningful market share with continued opportunity for expansion.

 

We believe that we have established critical mass in our current markets and have structured acquisitions that limit our credit risk, which positions us for attractive returns. The following table summarizes certain highlights of our five completed acquisitions to date, including deposits and assets at fair value as of each acquisition date:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Community Banks

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Pine River

 

of Colorado

 

Bank of Choice

 

Bank Midwest

 

Hillcrest Bank

Date acquired

 

August 1, 2015

 

 

October 21, 2011

 

 

July 22, 2011

 

 

December 10, 2010

 

 

October 22, 2010

FDIC-assisted

 

No

 

 

Yes

 

 

Yes

 

 

No

 

 

Yes

Loss share

 

No

 

 

Yes (1)

 

 

No

 

 

No

 

 

Yes (2)

Banking centers (3)

 

4

 

 

40

 

 

16

 

 

39

 

 

9 (and 32 retirement centers)

Deposits (millions)

 

$
130

 

 

$
1,195

 

 

$
760

 

 

$
2,386

 

 

$
1,234

Assets (millions)

 

$
142

 

 

$
1,228

 

 

$
950

 

 

$
2,426

 

 

$
1,377

Primary Market

 

Colorado

 

 

Colorado

 

 

Colorado

 

 

Greater Kansas City Region

 

 

Greater Kansas City Region


 

 

 

 

 

 

(1)

    

Commercial loss-share agreement (terminated November 5, 2015).

(2)

    

Single Family loss-share agreement and Commercial Shared-Loss Agreement (terminated November 5, 2015).

(3)

    

During the fourth quarter of 2013, four California banking centers acquired with the Community Banks of Colorado acquisition and 32 retirement centers acquired with the Hillcrest Bank acquisition were closed. During the third quarter of 2015, three banking centers were consolidated in our Bank Midwest network. During the second quarter of 2016, seven banking centers were consolidated in our Community Banks of Colorado network.

 

5


 

Table of Contents

All of our acquisitions were accounted for under the acquisition method of accounting, and accordingly, all assets acquired and liabilities assumed were recorded at their respective acquisition date fair values and the fair value discounts/premiums on loans are being accreted over the lives of the loans.

 

Our Transition to a State-Chartered Bank

 

On October 9, 2015, we announced the termination of the operating agreement between our bank subsidiary, NBH Bank, N.A., and its primary regulator, the OCC. On December 31, 2015, NBH Bank, N.A. converted into a Colorado state-chartered bank while maintaining membership with the Federal Reserve Bank of Kansas City and we changed the legal name of NBH Bank, N.A. to NBH Bank, which we refer to as “NBH Bank” or the “Bank”. Through NBH Bank, we operate under the following brand names: Bank Midwest in Kansas and Missouri; Community Banks of Colorado in Colorado; and Hillcrest Bank in Texas. We believe that conducting our banking operations under a single state charter streamlines our operations and enables us to more effectively and efficiently execute our growth strategy.

 

Our Market Area

 

Our core markets are broadly defined as Colorado and the greater Kansas City region. We are the fifth largest banking center network among Colorado-based banks and the fifth largest banking center network in the greater Kansas City MSA ranked by deposits as of June 30, 2016 (the last date as of which data are available), according to SNL Financial. Other major MSAs in which we operate include Dallas-Fort Worth-Arlington, Texas and Austin-Round Rock, Texas.

 

We believe that our established presence positions us well for growth opportunities in our markets. An integral component of our foundation and growth strategy has been to capitalize on market opportunities and acquire financial services franchises. Our primary focus has been on markets that we believe are characterized by some or all of the following: (i) attractive demographics with household income and population growth above the national average; (ii) concentration of business activity; (iii) high quality deposit bases; (iv) an advantageous competitive landscape that provides opportunity to achieve meaningful market presence; (v) lack of consolidation in the banking sector and corresponding opportunities for add-on transactions; and (vi) markets sizeable enough to support our long-term organic growth objectives and provide attractive acquisition opportunities. The table below describes certain key demographic statistics regarding our markets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

    

 

    

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

Top 3

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Competitor

 

 

 

 

 

# of

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Median

 

Combined

 

 

Deposits

 

Businesses

 

Population

 

Unemployment

 

Population

 

Household

 

Deposit

 

 

(billions)

 

(thousands)

 

(millions)

 

Rate (1)

    

Growth (2)

    

Income

 

Market Share

Denver, CO

 

$

75.8

 

114.9

 

2.9

 

2.6%

 

13.9%

 

$

70,249

 

54%

Front Range, CO (3)

 

 

103.6

 

182.7

 

4.6

 

2.6%

 

13.5%

 

 

68,525

 

52%

Kansas City, MO-KS MSA

 

 

65.1

 

76.0

 

2.1

 

3.8%

 

5.1%

 

 

60,635

 

43%

U.S.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4.4%

 

4.4%

 

 

55,551

 

55% (4)


 

 

 

(1)

    

Unemployment data is as of November 30, 2016.

(2)

    

For the period 2010 through 2016.

(3)

    

CO Front Range is a population weighted average of the following Colorado MSAs: Denver, Boulder, Colorado Springs, Fort Collins and Greeley.

(4)

    

Based on U.S. Top 20 MSAs (determined by population).

 

Source: SNL Financial as of December 31, 2016, except Deposits and Top 3 Competitor Combined Deposit Market Shares, which reflects data as of June 30, 2016.

 

6


 

Table of Contents

Our Business Strategy

 

As part of our goal of becoming a leading regional community bank holding company, we seek to continue to generate strong organic growth, as well as pursue selective acquisitions of financial institutions and other complementary businesses. Our focus is on building organic growth through strong banking relationships with small- and medium-sized businesses and consumers in our primary markets, while maintaining a low-risk profile designed to generate reliable income streams and attractive returns. We view our core market areas as the greater Kansas City region and Colorado. The key components of our strategic plan are:

 

·

Focus on client-centered, relationship-driven banking strategy . Our small business and commercial bankers focus on small and medium-sized businesses with an advisory approach that emphasizes understanding the client’s business and offering a complete array of loan, deposit and treasury management products and services. Our small business and commercial bankers are supported by treasury management teams in each of their markets, which allows us to more effectively deliver a comprehensive suite of products and services to our business clients and further deepen our banking relationships. Our consumer bankers focus on knowing their clients in order to best meet their financial needs, offering a full complement of loan, deposit, online and mobile banking solutions.

 

·

Expansion of commercial banking, small business banking and specialty businesses .   We have made significant investments in our commercial relationship managers, as well as developed significant capabilities across our small business banking and several specialty commercial banking offerings. Our specialized commercial banking teams are focused on structured and asset-based loans to middle market companies, as well as the energy, agriculture, government and non-profit sectors. Our strategy is to originate a high-quality loan portfolio that is diversified across industries and granular in loan size. We have preferred lender status with the Small Business Administration (“SBA”) providing a leveraged platform for growth in the small business lending segment. We believe we are well-positioned to leverage our operating and risk management infrastructure through organic growth and we intend to continue to add or repurpose our commercial relationship managers to higher growth opportunities and markets in order to drive increased profitability.

 

·

Expansion through organic growth and competitive product offerings .   We believe that our focus on serving consumers and small- to medium-sized businesses, coupled with our competitive product offerings, will provide an expanded revenue base and new sources of fee income. We conduct regular market and competitive analysis to determine which products and services are best suited for our clients. Our teams also continue to pursue opportunities to deepen client relationships, which we believe will further increase our organic loan origination volumes and attract new transaction accounts that offer lower cost of funds and higher fee generating activity.

 

·

Continue to strengthen profitability through organic growth and operating efficiencies .   We continue to utilize our comprehensive underwriting and risk management processes under one operating platform while maintaining local branding, leadership and decision making, which allows us to support growth and realize operating efficiencies throughout our enterprise. The actions taken to consolidate banking centers in conjunction with other expense management initiatives have resulted in significant cost savings. We believe that we have the infrastructure in place to support our future revenue growth without causing non-interest expenses to increase by a corresponding amount.  Our growth strategy is focused on organic initiatives in order to accelerate our growth in profitability. Key priorities to strengthen profitability include the continued ramp-up of loan production, increasing our deposits while maintaining our cost of funds, implementing additional fee-based business initiatives and further enhancing operational efficiencies.   

 

·

Maintain conservative risk profile and sound risk management practices . Strong risk management is an important element of our operating philosophy. We maintain a conservative risk culture with adherence to mature and seasoned policies across all areas of the organization. Our risk management approach seeks to identify, assess and mitigate risk and minimize any resulting losses. We have implemented processes to identify measure, monitor, and report and analyze the types of risk to which we are subject. We believe our risk management policies establish appropriate limitations that allow for the prudent oversight of such risks that include, but are not limited to the following: credit, liquidity, market, operational, legal and compliance, reputational, and strategic and business risk. 

 

7


 

Table of Contents

·

Pursue disciplined acquisitions . We expect that acquisitions will continue to be a component of our growth strategy and we intend to carefully select acquisition opportunities that we believe have stable core franchises, have significant local market share or will add asset generation capabilities or fee income streams while structuring the transactions to limit risk. Further, we seek transactions that offer opportunities for clear financial benefits with valuations that have acceptable levels of earnings accretion, tangible book value dilution/earn-back, and internal rates of return. We seek to acquire financial services franchises in markets that exhibit attractive demographic attributes and we believe that our focus on attractive markets will provide long-term opportunities for organic growth. Our focus is on our primary markets of Colorado, Missouri and Kansas, including teams, asset portfolios, specialty commercial finance businesses, and whole banks. 

 

We believe our strategy of strong organic growth through the retention, expansion and development of client-centered relationships and growth through selective acquisitions in attractive markets provides flexibility regardless of economic conditions. We also believe that our established platform for assessing, executing and integrating acquisitions creates opportunities in an economic downturn while the combination of attractive market factors, franchise scale in our targeted markets and our relationship-centered banking focus creates opportunities in an improving economic environment.

 

Products and Services

 

Through NBH Bank, our primary business is to offer a full range of traditional banking products and financial services to both our commercial, small business and consumer clients, who are predominantly located in Colorado, Missouri, Kansas and Texas. We conduct our banking business through 91 banking centers, with 47 of those located in Colorado, 42 in the greater Kansas City region and two in Texas. Our distribution network also includes 112 ATMs, fully integrated online banking and mobile banking services. We offer a high level of personalized service to our clients through our relationship managers and banking center associates. We believe that a banking relationship that includes multiple services, such as loan and deposit services, online and mobile banking solutions and treasury management products and services, is the key to profitable and long-lasting client relationships and that our local focus and decision making provide us with a competitive advantage over banks that do not have these attributes.  

 

Our primary strategic objective is to serve small- to medium-sized businesses in our markets with a variety of unique and useful services, including a full array of commercial, mortgage and non-mortgage loans, while maintaining a strong and disciplined credit culture. We offer a variety of products and services that are focused on the following areas:

 

Consumer and Small Business Banking 

 

Our consumer and small business bankers focus on knowing their clients in order to best meet their financial needs, offering a full complement of loan, deposit and online and mobile banking solutions. We strive to do business in the areas served by our banking centers, which is also where our marketing is focused, and the vast majority of our new loan clients are located in existing market areas.

 

All of our newly originated consumer loans are on a direct to consumer basis. We offer a variety of consumer and small business loans, including:  

 

Residential Real Estate Loans —Residential real estate loans consist of loans secured by the primary or secondary residence of the borrower. These loans consist of closed loans, which are typically amortizing over a 10 to 30-year term. We also offer open-ended home equity loans, which are loans secured by secondary financing on residential real estate. Our loan-to-value (LTV) benchmark for these loans is below 80% at inception along with satisfactory debt-to-income ratios. We do not originate or purchase negatively amortizing or sub-prime residential loans. Through our established mortgage banking business, we aim to originate high-quality loans for customers as part of a full banking relationship. The mortgage loans in our portfolio that meet investor criteria and pricing may also be sold in to the secondary market to buyers, such as Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac, and provide an additional source of fee income.

 

8


 

Table of Contents

Consumer Loans —Consumer loans are structured as small personal lines of credit and term loans, with the latter generally bearing interest at a higher rate and having a shorter term than residential mortgage loans. Consumer loans are both secured (for example by deposit accounts, brokerage accounts or automobiles) and unsecured and carry either a fixed rate or variable rate. Examples of our consumer loans include home improvement loans not secured by real estate, new and used automobile loans and personal lines of credit.

 

Small Business Loans —Small business loans consist of term loans, line of credit, and real estate secured loans. The terms of these loans vary by purpose and by type of underlying collateral, if any. Small business loans generally require LTV ratios of not more than 75 percent. Small business loans also assist in the growth of our deposits because many commercial loan borrowers establish noninterest-bearing and interest-bearing demand deposit accounts and banking services relationships with us. Those deposit accounts help us to reduce our overall cost of funds and those banking service relationships provide us with a source of non-interest income.

 

Commercial and Specialty Banking

 

Our commercial bankers focus on small- and medium-sized businesses with an advisory approach that emphasizes understanding the client’s business and offering a complete suite of loan, deposit and treasury management products and services. We have invested significantly in our commercial banking capabilities, attracting experienced commercial bankers from competing institutions in our markets, which have resulted in significant growth in our originated loan portfolio. To complement these efforts, we created a focused specialty banking group, which includes NBH Capital Finance (providing structured and asset-based loans to middle market companies), energy, agriculture, government and non-profit banking, treasury management and SBA lending. Our commercial relationship managers offer a wide range of commercial loan products, including:

 

Commercial and Industrial Loans —We originate commercial and industrial loans and leases, including working capital loans, equipment loans, structured and asset-based loans, energy loans, agriculture loans, government and non-profit loans, owner occupied commercial real estate loans and other commercial loans and leases. The terms of these loans vary by purpose and by type of underlying collateral, if any.

 

Working capital loans generally have terms of up to one year, are usually secured by accounts receivable and inventory and carry the personal guarantees of the principals of the business. Equipment loans are generally secured by the financed equipment at advance rates that we believe are appropriate for the equipment type. In the case of owner-occupied commercial real estate loans, we are usually the primary provider of financial services for the company and/or the principals and the primary source of repayment is through the cash flows generated by the borrowers’ business operations. Owner-occupied commercial real estate loans are typically secured by a first lien mortgage on real property plus assignments of all leases related to the properties. Underwriting guidelines generally require borrowers to contribute cash equity that results in an 80% or less loan-to-value ratio on owner-occupied properties. As of December 31, 2016, substantially all of our commercial and industrial loans were secured.

 

Non-Owner Occupied Commercial Real Estate Loans —Non-owner occupied commercial real estate loans, or non-owner occupied CRE loans, consist of loans to finance the purchase of commercial real estate, loans to support working capital needs of businesses that are secured by commercial real estate and construction and development loans. Our non-owner occupied CRE loans include loans on multi-family construction properties, commercial properties such as office buildings, retail centers, or free-standing commercial properties, multi-family and investor properties and raw land development loans.

 

Non-owner occupied CRE loans are typically secured by a first lien mortgage on multi-family, office, warehouse, hotel or retail property plus assignments of all leases related to the properties. Underwriting guidelines generally require borrowers to contribute cash equity that results in a 75% or less loan-to-value ratio.

 

We seek to reduce the risks associated with commercial mortgage lending by focusing our lending in our primary markets. Although non-owner occupied commercial real estate is not a primary focus of our lending strategy, we have developed teams in each our markets of dedicated CRE bankers who possess the depth and breadth of both market knowledge and industry expertise, which serves to further mitigate risk of this product type.

 

9


 

Table of Contents

Small Business Administration Loans —We offer a range of U.S. Small Business Administration, or SBA loans, to support manufacturers, distributors and service providers targeted to small businesses and entrepreneurs seeking growth capital, working capital, or other capital investments as an SBA Preferred Lender Provider. As a Preferred Lender Provider of the SBA, we are able to expedite SBA loan approval, closing, and servicing functions through delegated authority to underwrite and approve loans on behalf of the SBA. We utilize the SBA 7(a) loan, SBA 504 loan, SBA Express loan, and CAP Line loan programs. In addition to SBA loans, our commercial lending relationship managers also coordinate with associates in consumer and small business banking to provide personal loans and other services to the owners, managers and employees of the Bank’s commercial clients.

 

Lending Activities

 

Our loan portfolio includes commercial and industrial loans, commercial real estate loans, residential real estate loans, small business loans and consumer loans. The principal risk associated with each category of loans we make is the creditworthiness of the borrower. Borrower creditworthiness is affected by general economic conditions and the attributes of the borrower’s market or industry segment. Attributes of the relevant business market or industry segment include the economic and competitive environment, changes to supply or demand, threat of substitutes and barriers to entry and exit. In our credit underwriting process, we carefully evaluate the borrower’s industry, operating performance, liquidity and financial condition. We underwrite credits based on multiple repayment sources, including operating cash flow, liquidation of collateral and guarantor support, where appropriate. We closely monitor the operating performance, liquidity and financial condition of borrowers through analysis of periodic financial statements and meetings with the borrower’s management. As part of our credit underwriting process, we also review the borrower’s total debt obligations on a global basis. Our credit policy requires that key risks be identified and measured, documented and mitigated, to the extent possible, to seek to ensure the soundness of our loan portfolio.

 

Our credit policy also provides detailed procedures for making loans to individuals along with the regulatory requirements to ensure that all loan applications are evaluated subject to our fair lending policy. Our credit policy addresses the common credit standards for making loans to individuals, the credit analysis and financial statement requirements, the collateral requirements, including insurance coverage where appropriate, as well as the documentation required. Our ability to analyze a borrower’s current financial health and credit history, as well as the value of collateral as a secondary source of repayment, when applicable, are significant factors in determining the creditworthiness of loans to individuals. We have also adopted formal credit policies regarding our underwriting procedures for other loans including commercial and commercial real estate loans. We require various levels of internal approvals based on the characteristics of such loans, including the size, nature of the exposure and type of collateral, if any. We believe that the procedures required by our credit policies enhance internal responsibility and accountability for underwriting decisions and permit us to monitor the performance of credit decisioning. An integral element of our credit risk management strategy is the establishment and adherence to concentration limits for our portfolio. We have established concentration limits that apply to our portfolio based on product types such as commercial real estate, consumer lending, and various categories of commercial and industrial lending. For more detail on our credit policies, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations-Financial Condition-Asset Quality.”

 

Deposit Products and Other Funding Sources

 

We offer a variety of deposit products to our clients, including checking accounts, savings accounts, money market accounts and other deposit accounts, including fixed-rate, fixed maturity time deposits ranging in terms from 30 days to five years, and individual retirement accounts. We view deposits as an important part of the overall client relationship and believe they provide opportunities to cross-sell other products and services. We intend to continue our efforts to attract low-cost transaction deposits from our consumer and business banking relationships. Deposit flows are significantly influenced by general and local economic conditions, changes in prevailing interest rates, internal pricing decisions and competition. Our deposits are primarily obtained from areas surrounding our banking centers. In order to attract and retain deposits, we rely on providing competitively priced high-quality service and introducing new products and services that meet our clients' needs.

 

10


 

Table of Contents

Other Financial Products & Services

 

In addition to traditional banking activities, we provide a wide array of treasury management solutions to our clients, including: online and mobile banking, wire transfers, automated clearing house services, electronic bill payment, lock box services, remote deposit capture services, merchant processing services, cash vault, controlled disbursements, positive pay and other auxiliary services (including account reconciliation, collections, repurchase accounts, zero balance accounts and sweep accounts).

 

Competition

 

The banking landscape in our primary markets of Colorado, Kansas, Missouri and Texas is highly competitive and quite fragmented, with many small banks having limited market share while the large out-of-state national and super-regional banks control the majority of deposits and profitable banking relationships. We compete actively with national, regional and local financial services providers, including: banks, thrifts, credit unions, mortgage bankers and finance companies.

 

Competition among providers of financial products and services continues to increase, with consumers having the opportunity to select from a variety of traditional brick and mortar banks and nontraditional alternatives, such as online banks. Competition among providers is based on many factors. The primary factors driving commercial and consumer competition for loans and deposits are interest rates, the fees charged, client service levels and the range of products and services offered. In addition, other competitive factors include the location and hours of our banking centers, the client service orientation of our associates and the availability of digital banking products and services. We believe the most important of these competitive factors that determine our success are our consumer bankers’ focus on knowing their individual clients in order to best meet their financial needs and our small business and commercial bankers’ focus on small and medium-sized businesses with an advisory approach that emphasizes understanding the client’s business and offering a complete array of loan, deposit and treasury management products and services through our banking centers and our digital banking platform.

 

We recognize that there are banks with which we compete that have greater financial resources, access to more capital and higher lending capacity than we do and offer a wider range of deposit and lending instruments than we do. However, given our existing capital base, we expect to be able to meet the majority of small to medium-sized business and consumer credit needs.

 

Associates

 

At December 31, 2016, we had 928 full-time associates and 76 part-time associates.

 

SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

 

The U.S. banking industry is highly regulated under federal and state law. Banking laws, regulations, and policies affect the operations of the Company and its subsidiary. Investors should understand that the primary objective of the U.S. bank regulatory regime is the protection of depositors, the Depositors Insurance Fund (“DIF”), and the banking system as a whole, not the protection of the Company’s shareholders.

 

As a bank holding company, we are subject to inspection, examination, supervision and regulation by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”). Our bank subsidiary, NBH Bank, is a Colorado state-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve Bank of Kansas City. As such, NBH Bank is subject to examination, supervision and regulation by both the Colorado Division of Banking and the Federal Reserve. In addition, we expect that any additional businesses that we may invest in or acquire will be regulated by various state and/or federal banking regulators.

 

11


 

Table of Contents

Banking statutes and regulations are subject to continual review and revision by Congress, state legislatures and federal and state regulatory agencies. A change in such statutes or regulations, including changes in how they are interpreted or implemented, could have a material effect on our business. In addition to laws and regulations, state and federal bank regulatory agencies may issue policy statements, interpretive letters and similar written guidance pursuant to such laws and regulations, which are binding on us and our subsidiaries.

 

Banking statutes, regulations and policies could restrict our ability to diversify into other areas of financial services, acquire depository institutions and make distributions or pay dividends on our equity securities. They may also require us to provide financial support to any bank that we control, maintain capital balances in excess of those desired by management and pay higher deposit insurance premiums as a result of a general deterioration in the financial condition of NBH Bank, or other depository institutions we control.

 

The description below summarizes certain elements of the applicable bank regulatory framework. This description is not intended to describe all laws and regulations applicable to us and our subsidiaries. The description is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of the statutes, regulations, policies, interpretive letters and other written guidance that are described.

 

National Bank Holdings Corporation as a Bank Holding Company

 

As a bank holding company, we are subject to regulation under the Bank Holding Company Act (“BHCA”) and to supervision, examination, and enforcement by the Federal Reserve. Federal Reserve jurisdiction also extends to any company that we may directly or indirectly control, such as non-bank subsidiaries and other companies in which we have a controlling interest. While subjecting us to supervision and regulation, we believe that our status as a bank holding company (as opposed to being a non-controlling investor) broadens the investment opportunities available to us among public and private financial institutions.

 

The BHCA generally prohibits a bank holding company from engaging, directly or indirectly, in activities other than banking or managing or controlling banks, except for activities determined by the Federal Reserve to be so closely related to banking or managing or controlling banks as to be a proper incident thereto. Provisions of the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Financial Modernization Act of 1999 (the “GLB Act”) expanded the permissible activities of a bank holding company that qualifies as a financial holding company. Under the regulations implementing the GLB Act, a financial holding company may engage in additional activities that are financial in nature or incidental or complementary to financial activity. Those activities include, among other activities, certain insurance and securities activities. We have not yet determined whether it would be appropriate or advisable in the future to become a financial holding company.

 

NBH Bank as a Colorado State-Chartered Bank

 

On December 31, 2015, our bank subsidiary, NBH Bank, N.A., converted to a Colorado state-chartered bank operating under the name of NBH Bank. NBH Bank is also a member of the Federal Reserve Bank of Kansas City. As such, NBH Bank is subject to examination, supervision and regulation by both the Colorado Division of Banking and the Federal Reserve. NBH Bank’s deposits are insured by the FDIC through the DIF, in the manner and to the extent provided by law. As an insured bank, NBH Bank is subject to the provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, as amended (the “FDI Act”), and the FDIC’s implementing regulations thereunder, and may also be subject to supervision and examination by the FDIC under certain circumstances.

 

12


 

Table of Contents

Under the FDIC Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”), NBH Bank must submit financial statements prepared in accordance with GAAP and management reports signed by the Company’s and NBH Bank’s chief executive officer and chief accounting or financial officer concerning management’s responsibility for the financial statements, an assessment of internal controls, and an assessment of NBH Bank’s compliance with various banking laws and FDIC and other banking regulations. In addition, we must submit annual audit reports to federal regulators prepared by independent auditors. As allowed by regulations, we may use our audit report prepared for the Company to satisfy this requirement. We must provide our auditors with examination reports, supervisory agreements and reports of enforcement actions. The auditors must also attest to and report on the statements of management relating to the internal controls. FDICIA also requires that NBH Bank form an independent audit committee consisting of outside directors only, or that the Company’s audit committee be entirely independent.

 

Broad Supervision, Examination and Enforcement Powers

 

The Federal Reserve, the FDIC and state bank regulators have broad regulatory, examination and enforcement authority over bank holding companies and banks, as applicable. Bank regulators regularly examine the operations of banks and bank holding companies. In addition, banks and bank holding companies are subject to periodic reporting and filing requirements.

 

Bank regulators have various remedies available if they determine that a banking organization has violated any law or regulation, that the financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity or other aspects of a banking organization’s operations are unsatisfactory, or that the banking organization is operating in an unsafe or unsound manner. The bank regulators have the power to, among other things: enjoin “unsafe or unsound” practices, require affirmative actions to correct any violation or practice, issue administrative orders that can be judicially enforced, direct increases in capital, direct the sale of subsidiaries or other assets, limit dividends and distributions, restrict growth, assess civil monetary penalties, remove officers and directors, terminate deposit insurance, and appoint a conservator or receiver.

 

Engaging in unsafe or unsound practices or failing to comply with applicable laws, regulations and supervisory agreements could subject the Company, its subsidiaries and their respective officers, directors and institution-affiliated parties to the remedies described above and other sanctions. In addition, the FDIC could terminate NBH Bank’s deposit insurance if it determined that the Bank’s financial condition was unsafe or unsound or that the bank engaged in unsafe or unsound practices or violated an applicable rule, regulation, order or condition enacted or imposed by the bank’s regulators.

 

FDIC Statement of Policy on Qualifications for Failed Bank Acquisitions

 

As the agency responsible for resolving failed depository institutions, the FDIC has discretion to determine whether a party is qualified to bid on a failed institution. The FDIC Policy Statement imposes additional restrictions and requirements on certain “private investors” and institutions to the extent that those investors or institutions seek to acquire a failed insured depository institution from the FDIC.

 

The FDIC Policy Statement imposes several requirements on those institutions and investors to which it applies. Many of these requirements sunset after a three year time period or do not present ongoing requirements. However, some are related to the continuing presence of certain investors. Institutions are required to maintain a capital level sufficient to be “well capitalized” under regulatory standards during the remaining period of ownership of the investors. Investors that collectively own 80% or more of two or more depository institutions are required to pledge to the FDIC their proportionate interests in each institution to indemnify the FDIC against any losses it incurs in connection with the failure of one of the institutions. Institutions are prohibited from extending credit to such investors and to affiliates of such investors.

 

13


 

Table of Contents

Regulatory Capital Requirements

 

In General

 

As a bank holding company, we are subject to regulatory capital adequacy requirements implemented by the Federal Reserve. The federal banking agencies have risk-based capital adequacy guidelines intended to provide a measure of capital adequacy that reflects the degree of risk associated with a banking organization’s operations. NBH Bank also is, and other depository institution subsidiaries that we may acquire or control in the future will be, subject to capital adequacy guidelines as implemented by the relevant federal banking agency.  In the case of the Company and NBH Bank, applicable capital guidelines can be found in the Federal Reserve’s Regulations H and Q.

 

The capital rules require banks and bank holding companies to maintain a minimum common equity tier 1 capital ratio of 4.5%, a total tier 1 capital ratio of 6%, a total capital ratio of 8%, and a leverage ratio of 4%. Under recently revised guidelines, bank holding companies will ultimately be required to hold a capital conservation buffer of common equity tier 1 capital of 2.5% to avoid limitations on capital distributions and executive compensation payments. 

 

Further, the federal bank regulatory agencies may, however, set higher capital requirements for an individual bank or when a bank’s particular circumstances warrant. At this time, the bank regulatory agencies are more inclined to impose higher capital requirements in order to be considered well-capitalized, and future regulatory change could impose higher capital standards as a routine matter.

 

The Federal Reserve may also set higher capital requirements for holding companies whose circumstances warrant it. For example, holding companies experiencing internal growth or making acquisitions are expected to maintain strong capital positions substantially above the minimum supervisory levels, without significant reliance on intangible assets.

 

Prompt Corrective Action

 

The FDI Act requires federal bank regulatory agencies to take “prompt corrective action” with respect to FDIC-insured depository institutions that do not meet minimum capital requirements. A depository institution’s treatment for purposes of the prompt corrective action provisions will depend upon how its capital levels compare to various capital measures and certain other factors, as established by regulation. Federal banking regulators are required to take various mandatory supervisory actions and are authorized to take other discretionary actions with respect to institutions in the three undercapitalized categories. The severity of the action depends upon the capital category in which the institution is placed. Generally, subject to a narrow exception, the banking regulator must appoint a receiver or conservator for an institution that is critically undercapitalized. Our regulatory capital ratios and those of NBH Bank are in excess of the levels established for “well-capitalized” institutions.

 

Bank Holding Companies as a Source of Strength

 

The Federal Reserve requires that a bank holding company serve as a source of financial and managerial strength to each bank that it controls and, under appropriate circumstances, commit resources to support each such controlled bank. This support may be required at times when the bank holding company may not have the resources to provide the support. Because we are a bank holding company, the Federal Reserve views the Company (and its consolidated assets) as a source of financial and managerial strength for any controlled depository institutions.

 

Under the prompt corrective action provisions, if a controlled bank is undercapitalized, then the regulators could require its bank holding company to guarantee a capital restoration plan. In addition, if the Federal Reserve believes that a bank holding company’s activities, assets or affiliates represent a significant risk to the financial safety, soundness or stability of a controlled bank, then the Federal Reserve could require the bank holding company to terminate the activities, liquidate the assets or divest the affiliates. The regulators may require these and other actions in support of controlled banks even if such action is not in the best interests of the bank holding company or its shareholders.

 

14


 

Table of Contents

The Dodd-Frank Act codified the requirement that holding companies, like the Company, serve as a source of financial strength for their subsidiary depository institutions, by providing financial assistance to its insured depository institution subsidiaries in the event of financial distress. Under the source of strength doctrine, the Company could be required to provide financial assistance to NBH Bank should it experience financial distress.

 

In addition, capital loans by us to NBH Bank will be subordinate in right of payment to deposits and certain other indebtedness of NBH Bank. In the event of our bankruptcy, any commitment by us to a federal bank regulatory agency to maintain the capital of NBH Bank will be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee and entitled to a priority of payment.

 

Dividend Restrictions

 

The Company is a legal entity separate and distinct from its subsidiaries. Because the Company’s consolidated net income consists largely of the net income of NBH Bank, the Company’s ability to pay dividends depends upon its receipt of dividends from its subsidiary. The ability of a bank to pay dividends and make other distributions is limited by federal and state law. The specific limits depend on a number of factors, including the bank’s type of charter, recent earnings, recent dividends, level of capital and regulatory status. As a member of the Federal Reserve System and a Colorado state-chartered bank, NBH Bank is subject to Regulation H and limitations under Colorado law with respect to the payment of dividends. Non-bank subsidiaries are also limited by certain federal and state statutory provisions and regulations covering the amount of dividends that may be paid in any given year.

 

The ability of a bank holding company to pay dividends and make other distributions can also be limited. The Federal Reserve has authority to prohibit a bank holding company from paying dividends or making other distributions. A bank holding company should not pay cash dividends that exceed its net income or that can only be funded in ways that weaken the bank holding company’s financial health, such as by borrowing. In addition, as a Delaware corporation, the Company is subject to certain limitations and restrictions under Delaware corporate law with respect to the payment of dividends and other distributions.

 

Depositor Preference

 

The FDI Act provides that, in the event of the “liquidation or other resolution” of an insured depository institution, the claims of depositors of the institution (including the claims of the FDIC as subrogee of insured depositors) and certain claims for administrative expenses of the FDIC as a receiver will have priority over other general unsecured claims against the institution. If our insured depository institution fails, insured and uninsured depositors, along with the FDIC, will have priority in payment ahead of unsecured, nondeposit creditors, including us, with respect to any extensions of credit they have made to such insured depository institution.

 

Limits on Transactions with Affiliates

 

Federal law restricts the amount and the terms of both credit and non-credit transactions (generally referred to as “Covered Transactions”) between a bank and its non-bank affiliates. Covered Transactions with any single affiliate may not exceed 10% of the capital stock and surplus of the bank, and Covered Transactions with all affiliates may not exceed, in the aggregate, 20% of the bank’s capital and surplus. For a bank, capital stock and surplus refers to the bank’s tier 1 and tier 2 capital, as calculated under the risk-based capital guidelines, plus the balance of the allowance for credit losses excluded from tier 2 capital. The bank’s transactions with all of its affiliates in the aggregate are limited to 20% of the foregoing capital. In addition, in connection with Covered Transactions that are extensions of credit, the bank may be required to hold collateral to provide added security to the bank, and the types of permissible collateral may be limited. The Dodd-Frank Act generally enhances the restrictions on transactions with affiliates, including an expansion of what types of transactions are Covered Transactions to include credit exposures related to derivatives, repurchase agreements and securities lending arrangements and an increase in the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding Covered Transactions must be satisfied. As of December 31, 2016, the Company did not have any outstanding Covered Transactions.

 

15


 

Table of Contents

Regulatory Notice and Approval Requirements for Acquisitions of Control

 

We must generally receive federal bank regulatory approval before we can acquire an institution or business. Specifically, as a bank holding company, we must obtain prior approval of the Federal Reserve in connection with any acquisition that would result in the Company owning or controlling 5% or more of any class of voting securities of a bank or another bank holding company. Our ability to make investments in depository institutions will depend on our ability to obtain approval for such investments from the Federal Reserve. The Federal Reserve could deny our application based on the above criteria or other considerations. For example, we could be required to sell banking centers as a condition to receiving regulatory approval, which condition may not be acceptable to us or, if acceptable to us, may reduce the benefit of any acquisition.

 

Federal and state laws, including the BHCA and the Change in Bank Control Act, impose additional prior notice or approval requirements and ongoing regulatory requirements on any investor that seeks to acquire direct or indirect “control” of an FDIC-insured depository institution or bank holding company. Whether an investor “controls” a depository institution is based on all of the facts and circumstances surrounding the investment. As a general matter, an investor is deemed to control a depository institution or other company if the investor owns or controls 25% or more of any class of voting securities. Subject to rebuttal, an investor is presumed to control a depository institution or other company if the investor owns or controls 10% or more of any class of voting securities and either the depository institution or company is a public company or no other person will hold a greater percentage of that class of voting securities after the acquisition. If an investor’s ownership of our voting securities were to exceed certain thresholds, the investor could be deemed to “control” us for regulatory purposes. This could subject the investor to regulatory filings or other regulatory consequences.

 

Anti-Money Laundering Requirements

 

Under federal law, including the Bank Secrecy Act and the Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001 (the “USA PATRIOT Act”), certain types of financial institutions, including insured depository institutions, must maintain anti-money laundering programs that include established internal policies, procedures and controls; a designated compliance officer; an ongoing associate training program; and testing of the program by an independent audit function. Financial institutions are prohibited from entering into specified financial transactions and account relationships and must meet enhanced standards for due diligence, client identification, and recordkeeping, including in their dealings with non-U.S. financial institutions and non-U.S. clients. Financial institutions must take reasonable steps to conduct enhanced scrutiny of account relationships to guard against money laundering and to report any suspicious information maintained by financial institutions. Bank regulators routinely examine institutions for compliance with these obligations and they must consider an institution’s anti-money laundering compliance when considering regulatory applications filed by the institution, including applications for banking mergers and acquisitions. The regulatory authorities have imposed “cease and desist” orders and civil money penalty sanctions against institutions found to be violating these obligations.

 

Consumer Laws and Regulations

 

Banks and other financial institutions are subject to numerous laws and regulations intended to protect consumers in their transactions with banks. These laws include, among others, laws regarding unfair and deceptive acts and practices and usury laws, as well as the following consumer protection statutes: Truth in Lending Act, Truth in Savings Act, Electronic Funds Transfer Act, Flood Disaster Protection Act, Expedited Funds Availability Act, Equal Credit Opportunity Act, Fair and Accurate Credit Transactions Act, Fair Housing Act, Fair Credit Reporting Act, Fair Debt Collection Act, GLB Act, Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, Right to Financial Privacy Act and Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act.

 

Many states and local jurisdictions have consumer protection laws analogous, and in addition, to those listed above. These state and local laws regulate the manner in which financial institutions deal with clients when taking deposits, making loans or conducting other types of transactions.

 

16


 

Table of Contents

The Consumer Finance Protection Bureau (the “CFPB”) has broad rulemaking authority for a wide range of consumer financial laws that apply to all banks. The CFPB is authorized to issue rules for both bank and nonbank companies that offer consumer financial products and services, subject to consultation with the prudential banking regulators.  In general, however, banks with assets of $10 billion or less, such as NBH Bank, will continue to be examined for consumer compliance by their primary bank regulator.

 

Much of the CFPB’s rulemaking has focused on mortgage lending and servicing, including an important rule requiring lenders to ensure that prospective buyers have the ability to repay their mortgages. Other areas of current CFPB focus include consumer protections for prepaid cards, payday lending, debt collection, overdraft services and privacy notices. The CFPB has been particularly active in issuing rules and guidelines concerning residential mortgage lending and servicing, issuing numerous rules and guidance related to residential mortgages. Perhaps the most significant of these guidelines is the “Ability-to-Repay and Qualified Mortgage Standards under the Truth in Lending Act” portions of Regulation Z. Under the Dodd-Frank Act, creditors must make a reasonable and good faith determination, based on verified and documented information, that the consumer has a reasonable “ability to repay” a residential mortgage according to its terms. There is a statutory presumption of compliance with this requirement for mortgages that meet the requirements to be deemed “qualified mortgages.” The CFPB rule defines the key threshold terms “ability to repay” and “qualified mortgage.”

 

The CFPB has actively issued enforcement actions against both large and small entities and to entities across the entire financial service industry. The CFPB has relied upon “unfair, deceptive, or abusive acts” prohibitions as its primary enforcement tool. However, the CFPB and DOJ continue to be focused on fair lending in taking enforcement actions again banks with renewed emphasis on alleged redlining practices. Failure to comply with these laws and regulations could give rise to regulatory sanctions, client rescission rights, actions by state and local attorneys general and civil or criminal liability.

 

The Community Reinvestment Act

 

The CRA is intended to encourage banks to help meet the credit needs of their entire communities, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods, consistent with safe and sound operations. The regulators examine banks and assign each bank a public CRA rating. The CRA then requires bank regulators to take into account the bank’s record in meeting the needs of its community when considering certain applications by a bank, including applications to establish a banking center or to conduct certain mergers or acquisitions. The Federal Reserve is required to consider the CRA records of a bank holding company’s controlled banks when considering an application by the bank holding company to acquire a bank or to merge with another bank holding company.

 

When we apply for regulatory approval to make certain investments, the regulators will consider the CRA record of the target institution and our depository institution subsidiary. An unsatisfactory CRA record could substantially delay approval or result in denial of an application.

 

Reserve Requirements

 

Pursuant to regulations of the Federal Reserve, all banks are required to maintain average daily reserves at mandated ratios against their transaction accounts. In addition, reserves must be maintained on certain non-personal time deposits. These reserves must be maintained in the form of vault cash or in an account at a Federal Reserve Bank.

 

Deposit Insurance Assessments

 

All of a depositor’s accounts at an insured bank, including all non-interest bearing transaction accounts, are insured by the FDIC up to $250,000. FDIC-insured banks are required to pay deposit insurance premiums to the FDIC. The FDIC has adopted a risk-based assessment system whereby FDIC-insured depository institutions pay insurance premiums at rates based on their risk classification. An institution’s risk classification is assigned based on its capital levels and the level of supervisory concern the institution poses to the regulators.

 

17


 

Table of Contents

Assessments are based on an institution’s average total consolidated assets less average tangible equity (subject to risk-based adjustments that would further reduce the assessment base for custodial banks). NBH Bank may be able to pass part or all of this cost on to its clients, including in the form of lower interest rates on deposits, or fees to some depositors, depending on market conditions.

 

The FDIC may terminate a depository institution’s deposit insurance upon a finding that the institution’s financial condition is unsafe or unsound or that the institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices or has violated any applicable rule, regulation, order or condition enacted or imposed by the institution’s regulatory agency. If deposit insurance for a banking business we invest in or acquire were to be terminated, that would have a material adverse effect on that banking business and potentially on the Company as a whole.

 

Interstate Banking

 

Under the Riegle-Neal Interstate Banking and Branching Efficiency Act (the “Riegle-Neal Act”), a bank holding company may acquire banks in states other than its home state, subject to any state requirement that the bank has been organized and operating for a minimum period of time, not to exceed five years, and the requirement that the bank holding company not control, prior to or following the proposed acquisition, more than 10% of the total amount of deposits of insured depository institutions nationwide or, unless the acquisition is the bank holding company’s initial entry into the state, more than 30% of such deposits in the state (or such lesser or greater amount set by the state). Bank holding companies must be well capitalized and well managed, not merely adequately capitalized and adequately managed, in order to acquire a bank located outside of the bank holding company’s home state.

 

The Riegle-Neal Act also authorizes banks to merge across state lines, thereby creating interstate banking centers. A national or state bank, with the approval of its regulator, may open a de novo banking center in any state if the law of the state in which the banking center is proposed would permit the establishment of the banking center if the bank were a bank chartered in that state.

 

The Federal Reserve, OCC, and FDIC jointly issued a final rule, effective October 10, 1977, that adopted uniform regulations implementing Section 109 of the Riegle-Neal Act. Section 109 prohibits any bank from establishing or acquiring a branch or branches outside of its home state primarily for the purpose of deposit production. Congress enacted Section 109 to ensure that interstate branches would not take deposits from a community without the bank reasonably helping to meet the credit needs of that community.

 

Changes in Laws, Regulations or Policies

 

Congress and state legislatures may introduce from time to time measures or take actions that would modify the regulation of banks or bank holding companies. In addition, federal and state regulatory agencies also periodically propose and adopt changes to their regulations or change the manner in which existing regulations are applied. Such changes could increase or decrease the cost of doing business, limit or expand permissible activities or affect the competitive balance among banks and other financial institutions, all of which could affect our investment opportunities and our assessment of how attractive such opportunities may be. We cannot predict whether potential legislation will be enacted and, if enacted, the effect that it or any implementing regulations would have on our business, results of operations, liquidity or financial condition.

 

More Information

 

Our website is www.nationalbankholdings.com. We make available free of charge, through our website, annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and any amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such material with, or furnish such material to, the SEC. In addition, the public may read and copy any materials we file with the SEC at the SEC's Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549. The public may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC maintains an Internet site that contains reports, proxy and information statements, and other information regarding issuers that file electronically with the SEC at www.sec.gov.

 

18


 

Table of Contents

Item 1A.    RISK FACTORS

 

Risks Relating to Our Banking Operations

 

We are still a relatively young Company with a limited and complex operating history from which investors can evaluate our past financial and operating performance and future prospects.

 

We were organized in 2009 and acquired selected assets and assumed selected liabilities of Hillcrest Bank, Bank Midwest, Bank of Choice and Community Banks of Colorado in October 2010, December 2010, July 2011 and October 2011, respectively, and acquired Pine River Valley Bank by merger in August 2015. Because our banking operations began in late 2010, and because our acquisitions in 2010 and 2011 were of failed or troubled banks, we have a limited operating history upon which investors can evaluate our operational performance or compare our recent performance to historical performance. The business models and experiences of the depository institutions we have acquired to date and may acquire in the future may not be reflective of our plans. More importantly, because a portion of our acquired loans and OREO were covered by loss sharing agreements with the FDIC and all of the loans and OREO we acquired were marked to fair value at the time of our acquisitions, we believe that the historical financial results of the acquisitions are less useful to an evaluation of our future prospects and financial and operating performance.

 

Certain other factors may also make it difficult for investors to evaluate our future prospects and financial and operating performance, including, among others:

 

 

 

 

    

our current asset mix, loan quality and allowance for loan losses are not fully representative of our anticipated future asset mix, loan quality and allowance for loan losses, which may change materially as we continue to undertake organic loan origination and banking activities and pursue future acquisitions;

    

a portion of our loans and OREO had been covered by loss sharing agreements with the FDIC, which reimbursed a variable percentage of losses experienced on these assets; since our FDIC loss-share arrangements were terminated in the fourth quarter 2015, we may face higher losses, which losses may exceed the discounts we received;

    

the income we report from certain acquired assets due to loan discounts and accretable yield may be higher than the returns available in the current market and, if we are unable to make new performing loans and acquire other performing assets in sufficient volume, we may be unable to generate the earnings necessary to implement our growth strategy;

    

our excess cash reserves and liquid investment securities portfolio, may not be representative of our future cash position;

    

our historical cost structure and capital expenditure requirements are not necessarily reflective of our anticipated cost structure and capital spending as we continue to identify efficiencies and operate our organic banking platform; and

    

our regulatory capital ratios, which currently well exceed regulatory minimum requirements, are not necessarily representative of our future regulatory capital ratios.

 

Changes in general business and economic conditions could materially and adversely affect us.

 

Our business and operations are sensitive to general business and economic conditions in the United States and in our two core markets in Colorado and the greater Kansas City region. If the economies in our core markets, or the U.S. economy more generally, experience worsening economic conditions, including industry-specific conditions, we could be materially and adversely affected. Weak economic conditions may be characterized by deflation, fluctuations in debt and equity capital markets, including a lack of liquidity and/or depressed prices in the secondary market for mortgage loans, increased delinquencies on loans, residential and commercial real estate price declines and lower home sales and commercial activity, and further or prolonged pressure on energy prices. All of these factors would be detrimental to our business. Our business is significantly affected by monetary and related policies of the U.S. federal government, its agencies and government-sponsored entities. Changes in any of these policies are influenced by macroeconomic conditions and other factors that are beyond our control and could have a material adverse effect on us.

 

19


 

Table of Contents

Changes in the assumptions underlying our acquisition method of accounting, or other significant accounting estimates could affect our financial information and have a material adverse effect on us.

 

A material portion of our financial results is based on, and subject to, significant assumptions and subjective judgments. As a result of our acquisitions, our financial information is heavily influenced by the application of the acquisition method of accounting and was heavily influenced in prior periods by loss share accounting. Both methodologies require us to make complex assumptions, and these assumptions materially affect our financial results. As such, any financial information generated through the use of the acquisition method of accounting or loss share accounting is subject to modification or change. If our assumptions are incorrect and we change or modify our assumptions, it could have a material adverse effect on us or our previously reported results. Additionally, a change in our accounting estimates, such as our ability to realize deferred tax assets, the need for a valuation allowance or the recoverability of the goodwill recorded at the time of our acquisitions, could have a material adverse effect on our financial results.

 

Our business is highly susceptible to credit risk and fluctuations in the value of real estate and other collateral securing such credit.

 

As a lender, we are exposed to the risk that our clients will be unable to repay their loans according to their terms and that the collateral securing the payment of their loans (if any) may not be sufficient to assure repayment. The risks inherent in making any loan include risks with respect to the ability of borrowers to repay their loans and, if applicable, the period of time over which the loan is repaid, risks relating to proper loan underwriting and guidelines, risks resulting from changes in economic and industry conditions, risks inherent in dealing with individual borrowers and risks resulting from uncertainties as to the future value of collateral. Similarly, we have credit risk embedded in our securities portfolio. Our credit standards, procedures and policies may not prevent us from incurring substantial credit losses, particularly in light of market developments in recent years. A decline in residential real estate market prices and reduced levels of home sales, could adversely affect the value of collateral securing mortgage loans resulting in greater charge-offs in future periods, as well as adversely impact mortgage loan originations and gains on sale of mortgage loans. A decline in commercial real estate values would likewise adversely affect the value of collateral securing certain commercial loans and result in greater charge-offs in future periods. Declines in real estate values and home sales volumes, and financial stress on borrowers as a result of job losses or other factors, could have further adverse effects on borrowers that result in higher delinquencies and greater charge-offs in future periods, which could materially and adversely affect us.

 

We depend on our executive officers and key personnel to implement our strategy and could be harmed by the loss of their services.

 

The execution of our strategy depends in large part on the skills of our executive management team and our ability to motivate and retain these and other key personnel. Accordingly, the loss of service of one or more of our executive officers or key personnel could reduce our ability to successfully implement our growth strategy and materially and adversely affect us. Our success also depends on the experience of our banking center managers and relationship managers and on their relationships with the clients and communities they serve. The loss of these key personnel could negatively impact our banking operations. The loss of key senior personnel, or the inability to recruit and retain qualified personnel in the future, could have a material adverse effect on us.

 

Our allowance for loan losses and fair value adjustments may prove to be insufficient to absorb losses inherent in our loan or OREO portfolio.

 

We maintain an allowance for loan losses, which is a reserve established through a provision for loan losses charged to expense, which we believe is appropriate to provide for probable losses inherent in our loan portfolio. The amount of this allowance is determined by our management through periodic reviews.

 

20


 

Table of Contents

The determination of the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses inherently involves a high degree of subjectivity and requires us to make significant estimates of current credit risks and future trends, all of which may undergo material changes. Changes in economic conditions affecting borrowers, new information regarding our loans, identification of additional problem loans by us and other factors, both within and outside of our control, may require an increase in the allowance for loan losses. If the real estate markets deteriorate, we expect that we will experience increased delinquencies and credit losses, particularly with respect to construction, land development and land loans. In addition, our regulators periodically review our allowance for loan losses and may require an increase in the allowance for loan losses or the recognition of further loan charge-offs, based on judgments different than those of management. In addition, if charge-offs in future periods exceed the allowance for loan losses, we will need additional provisions to increase the allowance for loan losses. Any increases in the allowance for loan losses will result in a decrease in net income and capital and may have a material adverse effect on us.

 

We hold and acquire an amount of OREO from time to time, which may lead to volatility in operating expenses and vulnerability to declines in real property values.

 

When necessary, we foreclose on and take title to the real estate serving as collateral for our loans as part of our business. Real estate that we own but do not use in the ordinary course of our operations is referred to as “other real estate owned,” or “OREO” property. Higher OREO balances as a result of our acquisitions have led to greater expenses as we incur costs to manage and dispose of the properties. We expect that our earnings will continue to be negatively affected by various expenses associated with OREO, including personnel costs, insurance and taxes, completion and repair costs, valuation adjustments and other expenses associated with property ownership, as well as by the funding costs associated with OREO assets. We evaluate OREO properties periodically and write down the carrying value of the properties if the results of our evaluation require it. The expenses associated with OREO and any further OREO write-downs could have a material adverse effect on us.

 

We are subject to environmental liability risk associated with lending activities.

 

A significant portion of our loan portfolio is secured by real property, and we could become subject to environmental liabilities with respect to one or more of these properties. During the ordinary course of business, we may foreclose on and take title to properties securing defaulted loans. There is a risk that hazardous or toxic substances could be found on these properties, and we may be liable for remediation costs, as well as for personal injury and property damage, civil fines and criminal penalties regardless of when the hazardous conditions or toxic substances first affected any particular property. Environmental laws may require us to incur substantial expenses to address unknown liabilities and may materially reduce the affected property’s value or limit our ability to use or sell the affected property.  In addition, future laws or more stringent interpretations or enforcement policies with respect to existing laws may increase our exposure to environmental liability. Although we have policies and procedures to perform an environmental review before initiating any foreclosure action on nonresidential real property, these reviews may not be sufficient to detect all potential environmental hazards. The remediation costs and any other financial liabilities associated with an environmental hazard could have a material adverse effect on us.

 

The expanding body of federal, state and local regulation of loan servicing, collections or other aspects of our business may increase the cost of compliance and the risks of noncompliance.

 

We service our own loans, and loan servicing is subject to extensive regulation by federal, state and local governmental authorities as well as to various laws and judicial and administrative decisions imposing requirements and restrictions on those activities. The volume of new or modified laws and regulations has increased in recent years and, in addition, some individual municipalities have begun to enact laws that restrict loan servicing activities including delaying or temporarily preventing foreclosures or forcing the modification of certain mortgages. If regulators impose new or more restrictive requirements, we may incur additional significant costs to comply with such requirements which may further adversely affect us. In addition, our failure to comply with these laws and regulations could possibly lead to: civil and criminal liability; damage to our reputation in the industry; fines and penalties and litigation, including class action lawsuits; and administrative enforcement actions. Any of these outcomes could materially and adversely affect us.

 

21


 

Table of Contents

The fair value of our investment securities can fluctuate due to market conditions outside of our control.

 

We have historically taken a conservative investment strategy with our securities portfolio, with concentrations of securities that are primarily backed by government sponsored enterprises. In the future, we may seek to increase yields through more aggressive strategies, which may include a greater percentage of corporate securities and structured credit products.   Factors beyond our control can significantly influence the fair value of securities in our portfolio and can cause potential adverse changes to the fair value of these securities. These factors include, but are not limited to, rating agency actions in respect of the securities, defaults by the issuer or with respect to the underlying securities, and changes in market interest rates and instability in the capital markets. These factors, among others, could cause other-than-temporary impairments and realized and/or unrealized losses in future periods and declines in other comprehensive income, which could have a material adverse effect on us. The process for determining whether impairment of a security is other-than-temporary usually requires complex, subjective judgments about the future financial performance and liquidity of the issuer and any collateral underlying the security in order to assess the probability of receiving all contractual principal and interest payments on the security.

 

We face significant competition from other financial institutions and financial services providers, which may materially and adversely affect us.

 

Consumer and commercial banking is highly competitive. Our markets contain a large number of community and regional banks as well as a significant presence of the country’s largest commercial banks. We compete with other state and national financial institutions, including savings and loan associations, savings banks and credit unions, for deposits and loans. In addition, we compete with financial intermediaries, such as consumer finance companies, mortgage banking companies, insurance companies, securities firms, mutual funds and several government agencies, as well as major retailers, in providing various types of loans and other financial services. Some of these competitors have a long history of successful operations in our markets, greater ties to local businesses and more expansive banking relationships, as well as better established depositor bases. Some of our competitors also have greater resources and access to capital and possess an advantage by being capable of maintaining numerous banking locations in more convenient sites, operating more ATMs and conducting extensive promotional and advertising campaigns or operating a more developed internet platform. Competitors may also exhibit a greater tolerance for risk and behave more aggressively with respect to pricing in order to increase their market share.

 

Our ability to compete successfully depends on a number of factors, including, among others:

 

 

 

 

    

the ability to develop, maintain and build upon long-term client relationships based on quality service, effective and efficient products and services, high ethical standards and safe and sound assets;

    

the scope, relevance and pricing of products and services offered to meet client needs and demands;

    

the rate at which we introduce new products and services relative to our competitors;

    

the ability to attract and retain highly qualified associates to operate our business;

    

the ability to expand our market position;

    

client satisfaction with our level of service;

    

the ability to operate our business effectively and efficiently; and

    

industry and general economic trends.

 

Failure to perform in any of these areas could significantly weaken our competitive position, which could materially and adversely affect us.

 

22


 

Table of Contents

We may not be able to meet the cash flow requirements of deposit withdrawals and other business needs unless we maintain sufficient liquidity.

 

We require liquidity to make loans and to repay deposit and other liabilities as they become due or are demanded by clients. We principally depend on checking, savings and money market deposit account balances and other forms of client deposits as our primary source of funding for our lending activities. As a result of a decline in overall depositor confidence, an increase in interest rates paid by competitors, general interest rate levels, higher returns being available to clients on alternative investments and general economic conditions, a substantial number of our clients could withdraw their bank deposits with us from time to time, resulting in our deposit levels decreasing substantially, and our cash on hand may not be able to cover such withdrawals and our other business needs, including amounts necessary to operate and grow our business. This would require us to seek third party funding or other sources of liquidity, such as asset sales. Our access to third party funding sources, including our ability to raise funds through the issuance of additional shares of our common stock or other equity or equity-related securities, incurrence of debt, and federal funds purchased, may be impacted by our financial strength, performance and prospects and may also be impaired by factors that are not specific to us, such as a disruption in the financial markets or negative views and expectations about the prospects for the financial services industry, all of which may make potential funding sources more difficult to access, less reliable and more expensive. We may not have access to third party funding in sufficient amounts on favorable terms, or the ability to undertake asset sales or access other sources of liquidity, when needed, or at all, which could materially and adversely affect us.

 

Like other financial services institutions, our asset and liability structures are monetary in nature.  Such structures are affected by a variety of factors, including changes in interest rates, which can impact the value of financial instruments held by us.

 

Like other financial services institutions, we have asset and liability structures that are essentially monetary in nature and are directly affected by many factors, including domestic and international economic and political conditions, broad trends in business and finance, legislation and regulation affecting the national and international business and financial communities, monetary and fiscal policies, inflation, currency values, market conditions, the availability and terms (including cost) of short-term or long-term funding and capital, the credit capacity or perceived creditworthiness of clients and counterparties and the level and volatility of trading markets. Such factors can impact clients and counterparties of a financial services institution and may impact the value of financial instruments held by a financial services institution.

 

Our earnings and cash flows largely depend upon the level of our net interest income, which is the difference between the interest income we earn on loans, investments and other interest earning assets, and the interest we pay on interest bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings. Because different types of assets and liabilities may react differently and at different times to market interest rate changes, changes in interest rates can increase or decrease our net interest income. When interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice more quickly than interest earning assets in a period, an increase in interest rates would reduce net interest income. Similarly, when interest earning assets mature or reprice more quickly, and because the magnitude of repricing of interest earning assets is often greater than interest bearing liabilities, falling interest rates would reduce net interest income.

 

Accordingly, changes in the level of market interest rates affect our net yield on interest earning assets and liabilities, loan and investment securities portfolios and our overall results. Changes in interest rates may also have a significant impact on any future loan origination revenues. Historically, there has been an inverse correlation between the demand for loans and interest rates. Loan origination volume and revenues usually decline during periods of rising or high interest rates and increase during periods of declining or low interest rates. Changes in interest rates also have a significant impact on the carrying value of a significant percentage of the assets, both loans and investment securities, on our balance sheet. We may incur debt in the future and that debt may also be sensitive to interest rates and any increase in interest rates could materially and adversely affect us. Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors beyond our control, including general economic conditions and policies of various governmental and regulatory agencies, particularly the Federal Reserve. Changes in the Federal Reserve’s interest rate policies or other changes in monetary policies and economic conditions could materially and adversely affect us.

 

23


 

Table of Contents

We are dependent on our information technology and telecommunications systems and third-party providers, and systems failures or interruptions could have a material adverse effect on us.

 

Our business is highly dependent on the successful and uninterrupted functioning of our information technology and telecommunications systems and third-party providers. We outsource many of our major systems, such as data processing, loan servicing and deposit processing systems. The failure of these systems, or the termination of a third-party software license or service agreement on which any of these systems is based, could interrupt our operations. Because our information technology and telecommunications systems interface with and depend on third-party systems, we could experience service denials if demand for such services exceeds capacity or such third-party systems fail or experience interruptions. If significant, sustained or repeated, a system failure or service denial could compromise our ability to operate effectively, damage our reputation, result in a loss of client business, and/or subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny and possible financial liability, any of which could have a material adverse effect on us.

 

A failure in or breach of our security systems or infrastructure, or those of our third-party providers, could result in financial losses to us or in the disclosure or misuse of confidential or proprietary information, including client information, and could have a material adverse effect on us.

 

As a financial institution, we may be the target of fraudulent activity that may result in financial losses to us or our clients, privacy breaches against our clients or damage to our reputation. Such fraudulent activity may take many forms, including check fraud, electronic fraud, wire fraud, phishing, unauthorized intrusion into or use of our systems, and other dishonest acts.  We provide our clients with the ability to bank remotely, including via online, mobile and phone. The secure transmission of confidential information over the internet and other remote channels is a critical element of remote banking.

 

Our network could be vulnerable to unauthorized access, computer viruses, phishing schemes, ransomware and other security breaches. We may be required to spend significant capital and other resources to protect against the threat of security breaches and computer viruses, or to alleviate problems caused by security breaches or viruses. Given the increasingly high volume of our transactions, certain errors may be repeated or compounded before they can be discovered and rectified.  To the extent that our activities or the activities of our clients involve the storage and transmission of confidential information, security breaches and viruses could expose us to reputational damage, claims, regulatory scrutiny, litigation and other possible liabilities.  Any inability to prevent security breaches or computer viruses could also cause existing clients to lose confidence in our systems and could materially and adversely affect us. Our risk and exposure to these matters remains heightened because of the evolving nature and complexity of the threats from organized cybercriminals and hackers, and our plans to continue to provide digital banking products and services to our clients.

 

Information security risks for financial institutions like us have increased recently in part because of new technologies, the use of the internet and telecommunications technologies (including mobile devices) to conduct financial and other business transactions and the increased sophistication and activities of organized crime, perpetrators of fraud, hackers, terrorists and others. In addition to cyber-attacks or other security breaches involving the theft of sensitive and confidential information, hackers have engaged in attacks against large financial institutions, particularly denial of service attacks, that are designed to disrupt key business services, such as client-facing web sites. We are not able to anticipate or implement effective preventive measures against all security breaches of these types, especially because the techniques used change frequently and because attacks can originate from a wide variety of sources.  We employ detection and response mechanisms designed to contain and mitigate security incidents, but early detection may be thwarted by sophisticated attacks and malware designed to avoid detection.

 

24


 

Table of Contents

We also face risks related to cyber-attacks and other security breaches in connection with credit or debit card transactions that typically involve the transmission of sensitive information regarding our clients through various third parties, including merchant acquiring banks, payment processors, payment card networks (e.g., Visa, MasterCard) and our processors. Some of these parties have in the past been the target of security breaches and cyber-attacks, and because the transactions involve third parties and environments such as the point of sale that we do not control or secure, future security breaches or cyber-attacks affecting any of these third parties could impact us through no fault of our own, and in some cases we may have exposure and suffer losses for breaches or attacks relating to them. We also rely on numerous other third party service providers to conduct other aspects of our business operations and face similar risks relating to them. While we regularly conduct security assessments on these third parties, we cannot be sure that their information security protocols are sufficient to withstand a cyber-attack or other security breach.

 

Risks Relating to our Growth Strategy

 

We may not be able to effectively manage our growth.

 

Our future operating results depend to a large extent on our ability to successfully manage our growth. Our growth has placed, and it may continue to place, significant demands on our operations and management. Whether through additional acquisitions or organic growth, our current plan to expand our business is dependent upon our ability to:

 

 

 

 

    

continue to implement and improve our operational, credit, financial, legal, management and other internal risk controls and processes and our reporting systems and procedures in order to manage a growing number of client relationships;

    

scale our technology platform;

    

integrate our acquisitions and develop consistent policies throughout the various lines of businesses; and

    

attract and retain management talent.

 

 

 

 

We may not successfully implement improvements to, or integrate, our management information and control systems, procedures and processes in an efficient or timely manner and may discover deficiencies in existing systems and controls. In particular, our controls and procedures must be able to accommodate an increase in loan volume in various markets and the infrastructure that comes with new banking centers and banks. Thus, our growth strategy may divert management from our existing franchises and may require us to incur additional expenditures to expand our administrative and operational infrastructure and, if we are unable to effectively manage and grow our financial services franchise, we could be materially and adversely affected. In addition, if we are unable to manage future expansion in our operations, we may experience compliance and operational problems, have to slow the pace of growth, or have to incur additional expenditures beyond current projections to support such growth, any one of which could materially and adversely affect us.

 

Our acquisitions generally will require regulatory approvals, and failure to obtain them would restrict our growth.

 

We intend to complement and expand our business by pursuing strategic acquisitions of financial services franchises.  Generally, any acquisition of target financial institutions, banking centers or other banking assets by us will require approval by, and cooperation from, a number of governmental regulatory agencies, including the Federal Reserve and Colorado Division of Banking.  In acting on applications, our banking regulators consider, among other factors:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

the effect of the acquisition on competition;

    

the financial condition, liquidity, results of operations, capital levels and future prospects of the applicant and the bank(s) involved;

    

the quantity and complexity of previously consummated acquisitions;

    

the managerial resources of the applicant and the bank(s) involved;

    

the convenience and needs of the community, including the record of performance under the Community Reinvestment Act (which we refer to as the “CRA”); and

    

the effectiveness of the applicant in combating money laundering activities.

 

25


 

Table of Contents

Such regulators could deny our application based on the above criteria or other considerations, which would restrict our growth, or the regulatory approvals may not be granted on terms that are acceptable to us. For example, we could be required to sell banking centers as a condition to receiving regulatory approvals, and such a condition may not be acceptable to us or may reduce the benefit of any acquisition. In addition, prior to the submission of an application our regulators could discourage us from pursuing strategic acquisitions or indicate that regulatory approvals may not be granted on terms that would be acceptable to us, which could have the same effect of restricting our growth or reducing the benefit of any acquisitions.

 

The success of future transactions will depend on our ability to successfully identify and consummate acquisitions of financial services franchises that meet our investment objectives.  Because of the intense competition for acquisition opportunities and the limited number of potential targets, we may not be able to successfully consummate acquisitions on attractive terms.

 

There are significant risks associated with our strategy to identify and successfully consummate acquisitions. There are a limited number of acquisition opportunities, and we expect to encounter intense competition from other banking organizations competing for acquisitions and also from other investment funds and entities looking to acquire financial institutions and financial services franchises. Many of these entities are well established and have extensive experience in identifying and consummating acquisitions directly or through affiliates. Many of these competitors possess ongoing banking operations with greater financial, technical, human and other resources and access to capital than we do, which could limit the acquisition opportunities we pursue. Our competitors may be able to achieve greater cost savings, through consolidating operations or otherwise, than we could. These competitive limitations give others an advantage in pursuing certain acquisitions. In addition, increased competition may drive up the prices for the acquisitions we pursue and make the other acquisition terms more onerous, which would make the identification and successful consummation of those acquisitions less attractive to us. Competitors may be willing to pay more for acquisitions than we believe are justified, which could result in us having to pay more for them than we prefer or to forego the opportunity. The trading price of our common stock and of the stock of other potential acquirers may affect our ability to offer a competitive price for acquisitions where stock is proposed as acquisition consideration. As a result of the foregoing, we may be unable to successfully identify and consummate acquisitions on attractive terms, or at all, that are necessary to grow our business.

 

To the extent that we are unable to identify and consummate attractive acquisitions, or continue to increase loans through organic loan growth, we may be unable to successfully implement our growth strategy, which could materially and adversely affect us.

 

We intend to grow our business through strategic acquisitions of financial services franchises coupled with organic loan growth.  Previous availability of attractive acquisition targets may not be indicative of future acquisition opportunities, and we may be unable to identify any acquisition targets that meet our investment objectives. As our acquired loan portfolio, which generally produces higher yields than our originated loans due to loan discounts and accretable yield, is paid down, we expect downward pressure on our income to the extent that the runoff is not replaced with other high-yielding loans. As a result of the foregoing, if we are unable to replace loans in our existing portfolio with comparable high-yielding loans, we could be materially and adversely affected. We could also be materially and adversely affected if we choose to pursue riskier higher-yielding loans that fail to perform.

 

Projected operating results for businesses acquired by us may be inaccurate and may vary significantly from actual results.  To the extent that we make acquisitions that involve distressed assets, we may not be able to realize the value we predict from these assets or make sufficient provision for future losses in the value of, or accurately estimate the future writedowns to be taken in respect of, these assets.

 

We will generally establish the pricing of transactions and the capital structure of financial services franchises to be acquired by us on the basis of financial projections for such financial services franchises. In general, projected operating results will be based on the judgment of our management team.  In all cases, projections are only estimates of future results that are based upon assumptions made at the time that the projections are developed and the projected results may vary significantly from actual results. General economic, political and market conditions can have a material adverse impact on the reliability of such projections. In the event that the projections made in connection with our acquisitions, or future projections with respect to new acquisitions, are not accurate, such inaccuracies could materially and adversely affect us. 

 

26


 

Table of Contents

Delinquencies and losses in the loan portfolios and other assets we acquire may exceed our initial forecasts developed during our due diligence investigation prior to their acquisition and, thus, produce lower returns than we believed our purchase price supported. Furthermore, our due diligence investigation may not reveal all material issues. If, during the diligence process, we fail to identify all relevant issues related to an acquisition, we may be forced to later write down or write off assets, restructure our operations, or incur impairment or other charges that could result in significant losses. Any of these events could materially and adversely affect us. Economic conditions may create an uncertain environment with respect to asset valuations and there is no certainty that we will be able to sell assets or institutions after we acquire them if we determine it would be in our best interests to do so. In addition, there may be limited liquidity for certain asset classes we hold, including commercial real estate and construction and development loans. Any of the foregoing matters could materially and adversely affect us.

 

Risks Relating to the Regulation of Our Industry

 

The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 continues to materially affect our business.

 

The key effects of the Dodd-Frank Act on our business are:

 

 

 

 

    

changes to regulatory capital requirements;

    

creation of new government regulatory agencies (such as the Financial Stability Oversight Council, which oversees systemic risk, and the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, which develops and enforces rules for bank and non-bank providers of consumer financial products);

    

potential limitations on federal preemption;

    

changes to deposit insurance assessments;

    

regulation of debit interchange fees we earn;

    

changes in retail banking regulations, including potential limitations on certain fees we may charge; and

    

changes in regulation of consumer mortgage loan origination and risk retention.

 

Many provisions still require regulations to be promulgated by various federal agencies in order to be implemented, some of which have been proposed by the applicable federal agencies. The changes resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act have limited our business activities, required changes to certain of our business practices, imposed upon us more stringent capital, liquidity and leverage requirements or otherwise materially and may continue to adversely affect us. Failure to comply with the requirements could also materially and adversely affect us. Furthermore, additional uncertainties surrounding the Dodd-Frank Act, its implementation, and enforcement persist as a result of the new presidential administration. Any changes in the laws or regulations or their interpretations could be materially adverse to investors in our common stock.

 

We operate in a highly regulated environment and the laws and regulations that govern our operations, corporate governance, executive compensation and accounting principles, or changes in them, or our failure to comply with them, could materially and adversely affect us.

 

We are subject to extensive regulation, supervision, and legislation by federal and state regulators and bodies that govern almost all aspects of our operations. Intended to protect clients, depositors and the DIF, these laws and regulations, among other matters, prescribe minimum capital requirements, impose limitations on the business activities in which we can engage (including foreclosure and collection practices), limit the dividends or distributions that we can pay, restrict the ability of institutions to guarantee our debt, and impose certain specific accounting requirements on us that may be more restrictive and may result in greater or earlier charges to earnings or reductions in our capital than GAAP. Compliance with laws and regulations can be difficult and costly, and changes to laws and regulations often impose additional compliance costs. Our failure to comply with these laws and regulations, even if the failure follows good faith effort or reflects a difference in interpretation, could subject us to restrictions on our business activities, fines and other penalties, any of which could materially and adversely affect us. Further, any new laws, rules and regulations could make compliance more difficult or expensive and also materially and adversely affect us.

 

27


 

Table of Contents

The FDIC’s restoration plan and the related increased assessment rate could materially and adversely affect us.

 

The FDIC insures deposits at FDIC-insured depository institutions, such as our subsidiary bank, up to applicable limits. The amount of a particular institution’s deposit insurance assessment is based on that institution’s risk classification under an FDIC risk-based assessment system. An institution’s risk classification is assigned based on its capital levels and the level of supervisory concern the institution poses to its regulators. If current assessments imposed by the FDIC are insufficient for the DIF to meet its funding requirements, there may need to be further special assessments or increases in deposit insurance premiums. We are generally unable to control the amount of premiums that we are required to pay for FDIC insurance. Any future additional assessments, increases or required prepayments in FDIC insurance premiums may materially and adversely affect us, including by reducing our profitability or limiting our ability to pursue certain business opportunities.

 

Federal and state banking agencies periodically conduct examinations of our business, including compliance with laws and regulations, and our failure to comply with any supervisory actions to which we become subject as a result of such examinations could materially and adversely affect us.

 

Federal and state banking agencies periodically conduct examinations of our business, including compliance with laws and regulations. If, as a result of an examination, a federal or state banking agency were to determine that the financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity or other aspects of any of our operations had become unsatisfactory, or that we or our management was in violation of any law or regulation, it may take a number of different remedial actions as it deems appropriate. These actions include the power to enjoin “unsafe or unsound” practices, to require affirmative actions to correct any conditions resulting from any violation or practice, to issue an administrative order that can be judicially enforced, to direct an increase in our capital, to restrict our growth, to assess civil monetary penalties against our officers or directors, to remove officers and directors and, if it is concluded that such conditions cannot be corrected or there is an imminent risk of loss to depositors, to terminate our deposit insurance. If we become subject to such regulatory actions, we could be materially and adversely affected.

 

We are subject to the Community Reinvestment Act and fair lending laws, and failure to comply with these laws could lead to a wide variety of sanctions.

 

The CRA, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Housing Act and other fair lending laws and regulations impose nondiscriminatory lending requirements on financial institutions.  The Department of Justice and other federal agencies are responsible for enforcing these laws and regulations. A successful challenge to an institution’s performance under the CRA or fair lending laws and regulations could result in a wide variety of sanctions, including damages and civil money penalties, injunctive relief, restrictions on mergers and acquisitions activity, and restrictions on expansion activity. Private parties may also have the ability to challenge an institution’s performance under fair lending laws in private class action litigation.

 

The Federal Reserve may require us to commit capital resources to support our subsidiary bank.

 

As a matter of policy, the Federal Reserve, which examines us and our subsidiaries, expects a bank holding company to act as a source of financial and managerial strength to a subsidiary bank and to commit resources to support such subsidiary bank.  Under the “source of strength” doctrine, the Federal Reserve may require a bank holding company to make capital injections into a troubled subsidiary bank and may charge the bank holding company with engaging in unsafe and unsound practices for failure to commit resources to such a subsidiary bank. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act directs the federal bank regulators to require that all companies that directly or indirectly control an insured depository institution serve as a source of strength for the institution.  Under this requirement, we could be required to provide financial assistance to our subsidiary bank should our subsidiary bank experience financial distress.

 

28


 

Table of Contents

A capital injection may be required at times when we do not have the resources to provide it and therefore we may be required to borrow the funds or raise additional equity capital from third parties. Any loans by a holding company to its subsidiary bank are subordinate in right of payment to deposits and to certain other indebtedness of the subsidiary bank. In the event of a bank holding company’s bankruptcy, the bankruptcy trustee will assume any commitment by the holding company to a federal bank regulatory agency to maintain the capital of a subsidiary bank. Moreover, bankruptcy law provides that claims based on any such commitment will be entitled to a priority of payment over the claims of the holding company’s general unsecured creditors, including the holders of its indebtedness. Any financing that must be done by the holding company in order to make the required capital injection may be difficult and expensive and may not be available on attractive terms, or at all, which likely would have a material adverse effect on us.

 

We face a risk of noncompliance and enforcement action with the Bank Secrecy Act and other anti-money laundering statutes and regulations.

 

The federal Bank Secrecy Act, the USA PATRIOT Act and other laws and regulations require financial institutions, among other duties, to institute and maintain an effective anti-money laundering program and file suspicious activity and currency transaction reports as appropriate. The federal Financial Crimes Enforcement Network, established by the U.S. Treasury Department to administer the Bank Secrecy Act, is authorized to impose significant civil money penalties for violations of those requirements, and engages in coordinated enforcement efforts with the individual federal banking regulators, as well as the U.S. Department of Justice, Drug Enforcement Administration, and Internal Revenue Service. There is also increased scrutiny of compliance with the rules enforced by the Office of Foreign Assets Control (“OFAC”). If our policies, procedures and systems are deemed deficient or the policies, procedures and systems of the financial institutions that we may acquire in the future are deficient, we would be subject to liability, including fines and regulatory actions (such as restrictions on our ability to pay dividends and the necessity to obtain regulatory approvals to proceed with certain aspects of our business plan, including our acquisition plans), which could materially and adversely affect us. Failure to maintain and implement adequate programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing could also have serious reputational consequences for us.

 

Federal, state and local consumer lending laws may restrict our ability to originate certain mortgage loans or increase our risk of liability with respect to such loans and could increase our cost of doing business.

 

Federal, state and local laws have been adopted that are intended to eliminate certain lending practices considered “predatory.” These laws prohibit practices such as steering borrowers away from more affordable products, selling unnecessary insurance to borrowers, repeatedly refinancing loans and making loans without a reasonable expectation that the borrowers will be able to repay the loans irrespective of the value of the underlying property. It is our policy not to make predatory loans, but these laws create the potential for liability with respect to our lending and loan investment activities. They increase our cost of doing business and, ultimately, may prevent us from making certain loans and cause us to reduce the average percentage rate or the points and fees on loans that we do make.

 

29


 

Table of Contents

Our ability to pay dividends is subject to regulatory limitations and our bank subsidiary’s ability to pay dividends to us is also subject to regulatory limitations.

 

Our ability to declare and pay dividends depends both on the ability of our bank subsidiary to pay dividends to us and on certain federal regulatory considerations, including the guidelines of the Federal Reserve regarding capital adequacy and dividends. Because we are a separate legal entity from our bank subsidiary and we do not have significant operations of our own, any dividends paid by us to our shareholders would have to be paid from funds at the holding company level that are legally available therefor. However, as a bank holding company, we are subject to general regulatory restrictions on the payment of cash dividends. Federal bank regulatory agencies have the authority to prohibit bank holding companies from engaging in unsafe or unsound practices in conducting their business, which depending on the financial condition and liquidity of the holding company at the time, could include the payment of dividends. Additionally, various federal and state statutory provisions limit the amount of dividends that our bank subsidiary can pay to us as its holding company without regulatory approval. Finally, holders of our common stock are only entitled to receive such dividends as our board of directors may, in its unilateral discretion, declare out of funds legally available for such purpose based on a variety of considerations, including, without limitation, our historical and projected financial condition, liquidity and results of operations, capital levels, tax considerations, statutory and regulatory prohibitions and other limitations, general economic conditions and other factors deemed relevant by our board of directors. Accordingly, we may not pay the amount of dividends referenced in our current intention above, or any dividends at all, to our shareholders in the future.

 

Item 1B.    UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS .

 

None

 

Item 2.       PROPERTIES .

 

Our principal executive offices are located in the Denver Tech Center area immediately south of Denver, Colorado. We also have approximately 70,000 square feet of office and operations space in Kansas City, Missouri. At December 31, 2016, we operated 47 banking centers in Colorado, 42 in Kansas and Missouri, and 2 in Texas. Of these banking centers, 19 locations were leased and 72 were owned.

 

Item 3.       LEGAL PROCEEDINGS .

 

From time to time, we are a party to various litigation matters incidental to the conduct of our business. We are not presently party to any legal proceedings the resolution of which we believe would have a material adverse effect on our business, prospects, financial condition, results of operations or liquidity.

 

Item 4.       MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES .

 

None.

 

30


 

Table of Contents

PART I I

 

Item 5.       MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTER S AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES.

 

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity

 

Shares of the Company’s common stock began trading on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) under the symbol “NBHC” on September 20, 2012. Prior to September 20, 2012, there was no established public trading market for the Company’s stock. The following table presents the high and low prices of actual transactions in the Company’s common stock and cash dividends paid for the periods indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Cash

Year

 

Quarter

 

High

 

Low

 

Dividends

2016

 

First

 

$

21.40

 

$

18.41

 

$

0.05

 

 

Second

 

$

21.64

 

$

19.17

 

$

0.05

 

 

Third

 

$

24.14

 

$

19.51

 

$

0.05

 

 

Fourth

 

$

32.28

 

$

22.69

 

$

0.07

2015

 

First

 

$

19.53

 

$

17.69

 

$

0.05

 

 

Second

 

$

21.30

 

$

18.35

 

$

0.05

 

 

Third

 

$

22.04

 

$

19.20

 

$

0.05

 

 

Fourth

 

$

23.55

 

$

19.47

 

$

0.05

 

The close price of our common stock on the NYSE was $33.04 per share on February 21, 2017. The Company had 170 shareholders of record as of February 21, 2017. Management estimates that the number of beneficial owners is significantly greater.

 

In October 2012, we commenced the payment of a $0.05 per share quarterly dividend to holders of our common stock. During the third quarter of 2016, the Company increased the quarterly dividend to $0.07 per share.

 

As a bank holding company, any dividends paid to us by our bank subsidiary are subject to various federal and state regulatory limitations and also subject to the ability of our bank subsidiary to pay dividends to us. Other than (1) dividends from the Bank paid as noted above, (2) the cash held by the Company and (3) any future financing at the holding company level, we do not expect to have other liquidity sources at the holding company level. In addition, in the future, we and our bank subsidiary may enter into credit agreements or other financing arrangements that prohibit or otherwise restrict our ability to declare or pay cash dividends. Any determination to pay cash dividends in the future will be at the discretion of our Board of Directors and will depend on a variety of considerations, including, without limitation, our historical and projected financial condition, liquidity and results of operations, capital levels, tax considerations, statutory and regulatory prohibitions and other limitations, general economic conditions and other factors deemed relevant by our Board of Directors. See “Risk Factors—Our ability to pay dividends is subject to regulatory limitations and our bank subsidiary’s ability to pay dividends to us is also subject to regulatory limitations.” During 2016, the Bank paid dividends of $15.4 million to the holding company.

 

We may also execute permanent capital reductions at the Bank level in accordance with federal and state regulatory guidelines as a source of liquidity for the holding company. See note 13 for discussion of a permanent capital reduction of $140.0 million approved in February 2016.

 

31


 

Table of Contents

Performance Graph

 

The following graph presents a comparison of the Company’s performance to the indices named below. It assumes $100 invested on September 19, 2012, with dividends invested on a total return basis.

 

PICTURE 1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Period Ending

 

 

 

Index

12/19/12

12/31/12

12/31/13

12/31/14

12/31/15

12/31/16

NBH

100.00
98.92
112.63
103.18
114.75
172.88

KBW Regional Banking Index

100.00
95.19
139.76
143.16
151.74
211.10

Russell 2000 Index

100.00
99.74
138.46
145.24
138.83
168.37

 

32


 

Table of Contents

The following table sets forth information about our repurchases of our common stock during the fourth quarter of 2016:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

    

 

 

    

 

    

Maximum number

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total number of

 

(or approximate dollar

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

shares (or units)

 

value) of shares (or

 

 

Total number

 

Average

 

purchased as part of

 

units) that may yet be

 

 

of shares (or

 

price paid per

 

publicly announced

 

purchased under the

Period

 

units) purchased

 

share (or unit)

 

plans or programs

 

plans or programs (3)

October 1 - October 31, 2016

 

269,062

 

$

23.25

 

269,062

 

$

12,562,825

October 1 - October 31, 2016 (1)

 

24,401

 

 

23.70

 

 —

 

 

12,562,825

November 1, 2016 - November 30, 2016 (1)

 

339,838

 

 

27.38

 

 —

 

 

12,562,825

December 1, 2016 - December 31, 2016 (1)

 

177,226

 

 

30.85

 

 —

 

 

12,562,825

December 1, 2016 - December 31, 2016 (2)

 

297,938

 

 

31.89

 

 —

 

 

12,562,825

Total

 

1,108,465

 

$

28.06

 

269,062

 

$

12,562,825

 


 

 

 

(1)

    

These shares represent shares purchased other than through publicly announced plans and were purchased pursuant to the Company’s stock incentive plans. Pursuant to the plans, shares were purchased from plan participants at the then current market value in satisfaction of stock option exercise prices, settlements of restricted stock and tax withholdings.

(2)

    

These shares represent shares purchased other than through publicly announced plans and were purchased from warrant holders at the then current market value in satisfaction of warrant exercise prices.

(3)

    

On August 5, 2016, the Company’s Board of Directors authorized the repurchase of up to an additional $50.0 million of common stock. Under this authorization, $12,562,825 remained available for purchase at December 31, 2016.

 

Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans 

 

During the second quarter of 2014, shareholders approved the 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “2014 Plan”). Under the 2014 Plan, the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors has the authority to grant, from time to time, awards of options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units, performance units, other stock-based awards, or any combination thereof to eligible persons. As of December 31, 2016, the aggregate number of Company common stock available for issuance under the 2014 Plan was 5,588,905 shares.

 

During the second quarter of 2015, shareholders approved the Company’s 2014 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (“ESPP”). The ESPP allows employees to purchase shares of common stock through payroll deductions up to a limit of $25,000 per calendar year or 2,000 shares per offering period. The price an employee pays for shares is 90.0% of the fair market value of Company common stock on the last day of the offering period. As of December 31, 2016, the aggregate number of Company common stock available for issuance under the ESPP was 366,337 shares.

 

See note 15 to the consolidated financial statements for further detail related to these equity compensation plans.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Number of

 

 

Number of securities to be

 

Weighted-average

 

securities remaining

 

 

issued upon exercise of

 

exercise price of

 

available for future

 

 

outstanding options,

 

outstanding options,

 

issuance under equity

Plan Category

    

warrants and rights

    

warrants and rights

    

compensation plans

Equity plans approved by security holders

 

2,185,922

 

$

19.81

 

5,955,242

Equity plans not approved by security holders

 

 -

 

 

 -

 

 -

Total

 

2,185,922

 

$

19.81

 

5,955,242

 

 

33


 

Table of Contents

Item 6.       SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA .

 

The following table sets forth summary selected historical financial information as of and for the five years ended December 31, 2016. The summary selected historical consolidated financial information set forth below is derived from our audited consolidated financial statements.

 

The summary unaudited selected historical consolidated financial data set forth below should be read together with our consolidated financial statements and the related notes thereto and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” included elsewhere in this annual report. Such information is not necessarily indicative of anticipated future results. All amounts are presented in thousands, except share data, or as otherwise noted.

 

Summary of Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

 

 

2016

 

2015

 

2014

 

2013

 

2012

Consolidated Statement of Financial Condition Data:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

 

$

152,736

 

$

166,092

 

$

256,979

 

$

189,460

 

$

769,180

Investment securities available-for-sale (at fair value)

 

 

884,232

 

 

1,157,246

 

 

1,479,214

 

 

1,785,528

 

 

1,718,028

Investment securities held-to-maturity

 

 

332,505

 

 

427,503

 

 

530,590

 

 

641,907

 

 

577,486

Non-marketable securities

 

 

14,949

 

 

22,529

 

 

27,045

 

 

31,663

 

 

32,996

Loans (1)

 

 

2,860,921

 

 

2,587,673

 

 

2,162,409

 

 

1,854,094

 

 

1,832,702

Allowance for loan losses

 

 

(29,174)

 

 

(27,119)

 

 

(17,613)

 

 

(12,521)

 

 

(15,380)

Loans, net

 

 

2,831,747

 

 

2,560,554

 

 

2,144,796

 

 

1,841,573

 

 

1,817,322

Loans held for sale

 

 

24,187

 

 

13,292

 

 

5,146

 

 

5,787

 

 

5,368

FDIC indemnification asset, net

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

39,082

 

 

64,447

 

 

86,923

Other real estate owned

 

 

15,662

 

 

20,814

 

 

29,120

 

 

70,125

 

 

94,808

Premises and equipment, net

 

 

95,671

 

 

103,103

 

 

106,341

 

 

115,219

 

 

121,436

Goodwill and other intangible assets, net

 

 

66,579

 

 

72,059

 

 

76,513

 

 

81,859

 

 

87,205

Other assets

 

 

154,778

 

 

140,716

 

 

124,820

 

 

86,547

 

 

100,023

Total assets

 

$

4,573,046

 

$

4,683,908

 

$

4,819,646

 

$

4,914,115

 

$

5,410,775

Deposits

 

$

3,868,649

 

$

3,840,677

 

$

3,766,188

 

$

3,838,309

 

$

4,200,719

Other liabilities

 

 

168,208

 

 

225,687

 

 

258,883

 

 

178,014

 

 

119,497

Total liabilities

 

 

4,036,857

 

 

4,066,364

 

 

4,025,071

 

 

4,016,323

 

 

4,320,216

Total shareholders’ equity

 

 

536,189

 

 

617,544

 

 

794,575

 

 

897,792

 

 

1,090,559

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

 

$

4,573,046

 

$

4,683,908

 

$

4,819,646

 

$

4,914,115

 

$

5,410,775

 

 

34


 

Table of Contents

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As of and for the years ended

 

 

December 31,

    

December 31,

    

December 31,

    

December 31,

    

December 31,

 

    

2016

 

2015

 

2014

 

2013

 

2012

Consolidated Statement of Operations Data:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest income

 

$

160,448

 

$

171,407

 

$

184,662

 

$

195,475

 

$

233,485

Interest expense

 

 

14,808

 

 

14,462

 

 

14,413

 

 

16,514

 

 

29,234

Net interest income

 

 

145,640

 

 

156,945

 

 

170,249

 

 

178,961

 

 

204,251

Provision for loan losses

 

 

23,651

 

 

12,444

 

 

6,209

 

 

4,296

 

 

27,995

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

 

 

121,989

 

 

144,501

 

 

164,040

 

 

174,665

 

 

176,256

Non-interest income

 

 

40,027

 

 

21,448

 

 

(1,696)

 

 

20,177

 

 

37,379

Non-interest expense

 

 

136,009

 

 

158,024

 

 

150,003

 

 

183,965

 

 

209,598

Income before income taxes

 

 

26,007

 

 

7,925

 

 

12,341

 

 

10,877

 

 

4,037

Income tax expense

 

 

2,947

 

 

3,044

 

 

3,165

 

 

3,950

 

 

4,580

Net income (loss)

 

$

23,060

 

$

4,881

 

$

9,176

 

$

6,927

 

$

(543)

Share Information (2) :

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Earnings (loss) per share, basic

 

$

0.81

 

$

0.14

 

$

0.22

 

$

0.14

 

$

(0.01)

Earnings (loss) per share, diluted

 

$

0.79

 

$

0.14

 

$

0.22

 

$

0.14

 

$

(0.01)

Dividends paid

 

$

0.22

 

$

0.20

 

$

0.20

 

$

0.20

 

$

0.05

Book value per share

 

$

20.32

 

$

20.34

 

$

20.43

 

$

19.99

 

$

20.84

Tangible common book value per share (3)

 

$

18.15

 

$

18.22

 

$

18.63

 

$

18.27

 

$

19.23

Tangible common equity to tangible assets (3)

 

 

10.61%

 

 

11.98%

 

 

15.25%

 

 

16.97%

 

 

18.89%

Weighted average common shares outstanding, basic

 

 

28,313,061

 

 

34,349,996

 

 

42,404,609

 

 

50,790,410

 

 

52,214,175

Weighted average common shares outstanding, diluted

 

 

29,091,343

 

 

34,363,487

 

 

42,421,014

 

 

50,824,422

 

 

52,214,175

Common shares outstanding

 

 

26,386,583

 

 

30,358,509

 

 

38,884,953

 

 

44,918,336

 

 

52,327,672

 

 

 

(1)

    

Total loans are net of unearned discounts and deferred fees and costs.

(2)

    

Per share information is calculated based on the aggregate number of our shares of Class A common stock and Class B non-voting common stock outstanding.

(3)

    

Tangible book value per share and tangible common equity to tangible assets are non-GAAP financial measures. Tangible book value per share is computed as total shareholders’ equity less goodwill (adjusted for deferred taxes) and other intangible assets, net, divided by common shares outstanding at the balance sheet date. For purposes of computing tangible common equity to tangible assets, tangible common equity is calculated as common shareholders’ equity less goodwill (adjusted for deferred taxes) and other intangible assets, net, and tangible assets is calculated as total assets less goodwill (adjusted for deferred taxes) and other intangible assets, net. We believe that the most directly comparable GAAP financial measures are book value per share and total shareholders’ equity to total assets. See the reconciliation under “About Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”

 

35


 

Table of Contents

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As of and for the years ended

 

 

December 31, 

 

December 31, 

 

December 31, 

 

December 31, 

 

December 31, 

 

    

2016

    

2015

    

2014

    

2013

    

2012

Key Ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Return on average assets

 

0.50%

 

0.10%

 

0.19%

 

0.13%

 

(0.01)%

Return on average tangible assets (1)

 

0.57%

 

0.17%

 

0.26%

 

0.20%

 

0.05%

Return on average tangible assets before provision for loan losses and taxes FTE (1)

 

1.29%

 

0.60%

 

0.52%

 

0.40%

 

0.66%

Return on average equity

 

3.95%

 

0.70%

 

1.07%

 

0.67%

 

(0.05)%

Return on average tangible common equity (1)

 

5.04%

 

1.29%

 

1.58%

 

1.06%

 

0.27%

Interest earning assets to interest bearing liabilities (end of period) (2)

 

133.44%

 

133.71%

 

137.36%

 

137.05%

 

134.44%

Loans to deposits ratio (end of period)

 

74.58%

 

67.72%

 

57.55%

 

48.46%

 

43.76%

Average equity to average assets

 

12.55%

 

14.52%

 

17.68%

 

20.07%

 

18.91%

Non-interest bearing deposits to total deposits (end of period)

 

21.89%

 

21.22%

 

19.45%

 

17.59%

 

16.14%

Net interest margin (3)

 

3.39%

 

3.54%

 

3.83%

 

3.81%

 

3.98%

Net interest margin FTE (1)(3)

 

3.49%

 

3.60%

 

3.85%

 

3.81%

 

3.98%

Interest rate spread (4)

 

3.38%

 

3.48%

 

3.72%

 

3.68%

 

3.81%

Yield on earning assets (2)

 

3.74%

 

3.86%

 

4.15%

 

4.16%

 

4.55%

Yield on earning assets FTE (1)(2)

 

3.84%

 

3.92%

 

4.17%

 

4.16%

 

4.55%

Cost of interest bearing liabilities (2)

 

0.46%

 

0.44%

 

0.45%

 

0.48%

 

0.74%

Cost of deposits

 

0.36%

 

0.36%

 

0.37%

 

0.41%

 

0.64%

Non-interest expense to average assets

 

2.92%

 

3.27%

 

3.08%

 

3.55%

 

3.62%

Efficiency ratio FTE (1)(5)

 

68.79%

 

85.55%

 

85.82%

 

89.70%

 

84.53%

Dividend Payout Ratio

 

52.63%

 

142.86%

 

90.91%

 

142.86%

 

NM

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asset Quality Data (6)(7)(8)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-performing loans to total loans

 

1.07%

 

0.99%

 

0.50%

 

1.31%

 

1.26%

Non-performing assets to total loans and OREO

 

1.61%

 

1.81%

 

1.86%

 

4.97%

 

6.19%

Allowance for loan losses to total loans

 

1.02%

 

1.05%

 

0.81%

 

0.68%

 

0.84%

Allowance for loan losses to non-performing loans

 

94.98%

 

105.74%

 

162.89%

 

51.43%

 

66.53%

Net charge-offs to average loans

 

0.80%

 

0.12%

 

0.05%

 

0.41%

 

1.20%

 

 

 

(1)

    

Ratio represents non-GAAP financial measure. See non-GAAP reconciliation below.

(2)

    

Interest earning assets include assets that earn interest/accretion or dividends. Any market value adjustments on investment securities are excluded from interest-earning assets. Interest bearing liabilities include liabilities that must be paid interest.

(3)

    

Net interest margin represents net interest income, including accretion income on interest earning assets, as a percentage of average interest earning assets.

(4)

    

Interest rate spread represents the difference between the weighted average yield on interest earning assets and the weighted average cost of interest bearing liabilities.

(5)

    

The efficiency ratio represents non-interest expense, less intangible asset amortization, as a percentage of net interest income on a FTE basis plus non-interest income.

(6)

    

Non-performing loans were redefined during the third quarter of 2014 to only include non-accrual loans and restructured loans on non-accrual, and exclude any loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 in which the pool is still performing. All previous periods have been restated.

(7)

    

Non-performing assets include non-performing loans, other real estate owned and other repossessed assets.

(8)

    

Total loans are net of unearned discounts and fees.

NM

    

Not meaningful.

 

36


 

Table of Contents

 

About Non-GAAP Financial Measures

 

Certain of the financial measures and ratios we present, including “tangible assets,” “return on average tangible assets,” “return on average tangible assets before provision for loan losses and taxes,” “return on average tangible common equity,” “tangible common book value,” “tangible common book value per share,” “tangible common equity,” "tangible common equity to tangible assets," and "fully taxable equivalent (FTE)" metrics are supplemental measures that are not required by, or are not presented in accordance with, U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP).  We refer to these financial measures and ratios as “non-GAAP financial measures.” We consider the use of select non-GAAP financial measures and ratios to be useful for financial and operational decision making and useful in evaluating period-to-period comparisons. We believe that these non-GAAP financial measures provide meaningful supplemental information regarding our performance by excluding certain expenditures or assets that we believe are not indicative of our primary business operating results or by presenting certain metrics on a FTE basis. We believe that management and investors benefit from referring to these non-GAAP financial measures in assessing our performance and when planning, forecasting, analyzing and comparing past, present and future periods.

 

These non-GAAP financial measures should not be considered a substitute for financial information presented in accordance with GAAP and you should not rely on non-GAAP financial measures alone as measures of our performance. The non-GAAP financial measures we present may differ from non-GAAP financial measures used by our peers or other companies. In particular, the items that we exclude in our adjustments are not necessarily consistent with the items that our peers may exclude from their results of operations and key financial measures and therefore may limit the comparability of similarly named financial measures and ratios. We compensate for these limitations by providing the equivalent GAAP measures whenever we present the non-GAAP financial measures and by including a reconciliation of the impact of the components adjusted for in the non-GAAP financial measure so that both measures and the individual components may be considered when analyzing our performance.

 

37


 

Table of Contents

A reconciliation of our GAAP financial measures to the comparable non-GAAP financial measures is as follows.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 

 

December 31, 

 

December 31, 

 

December 31, 

 

December 31, 

 

    

2016

    

2015

    

2014

    

2013

    

2012

Total shareholders' equity

 

$

536,189

 

$

617,544

 

$

794,575

 

$

897,792

 

$

1,090,559

Less: goodwill and intangible assets, net

 

 

(66,580)

 

 

(72,060)

 

 

(76,513)

 

 

(81,859)

 

 

(87,205)

Add: deferred tax liability related to goodwill

 

 

9,323

 

 

7,772

 

 

6,222

 

 

4,671

 

 

3,121

Tangible common equity (non-GAAP)

 

$

478,932

 

$

553,256

 

$

724,284

 

$

820,604

 

$

1,006,475

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total assets

 

$

4,573,046

 

$

4,683,908

 

$

4,819,646

 

$

4,914,115

 

$

5,410,775

Less: goodwill and intangible assets, net

 

 

(66,580)

 

 

(72,060)

 

 

(76,513)

 

 

(81,859)

 

 

(87,205)

Add: deferred tax liability related to goodwill

 

 

9,323

 

 

7,772

 

 

6,222

 

 

4,671

 

 

3,121

Tangible assets (non-GAAP)

 

$

4,515,789

 

$

4,619,620

 

$

4,749,355

 

$

4,836,927

 

$

5,326,691

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tangible common equity to tangible assets calculations:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total shareholders' equity to total assets

 

 

11.72%

 

 

13.18%

 

 

16.49%

 

 

18.27%

 

 

20.16%

Less: impact of goodwill and intangible assets, net

 

 

(1.11)%

 

 

(1.20)%

 

 

(1.24)%

 

 

(1.30)%

 

 

(1.27)%

Tangible common equity to tangible assets (non-GAAP)

 

 

10.61%

 

 

11.98%

 

 

15.25%

 

 

16.97%

 

 

18.89%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tangible common book value per share calculations:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tangible common equity (non-GAAP)

 

$

478,932

 

$

553,256

 

$

724,284

 

$

820,604

 

$

1,006,475

Divided by: ending shares outstanding

 

 

26,386,583

 

 

30,358,509

 

 

38,884,953

 

 

44,918,336

 

 

52,327,672

Tangible common book value per share (non-GAAP)

 

$

18.15

 

$

18.22

 

$

18.63

 

$

18.27

 

$

19.23

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tangible common book value per share, excluding accumulated other comprehensive income calculations:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tangible common equity (non-GAAP)

 

$

478,932

 

$

553,256

 

$

724,284

 

$

820,604

 

$

1,006,475

Less: accumulated other comprehensive income, net of tax

 

 

1,762

 

 

(95)

 

 

(5,839)

 

 

6,756

 

 

(40,573)

Tangible common book value, excluding accumulated other comprehensive income, net of tax (non-GAAP)

 

 

480,694

 

 

553,161

 

 

718,445

 

 

827,360

 

 

965,902

Divided by: ending shares outstanding

 

 

26,386,583

 

 

30,358,509

 

 

38,884,953

 

 

44,918,336

 

 

52,327,672

Tangible common book value per share, excluding accumulated other comprehensive income, net of tax (non-GAAP)

 

$

18.22

 

$

18.22

 

$

18.48

 

$

18.42

 

$

18.46

 

38


 

Table of Contents

Return on Average Tangible Assets and Return on Average Tangible Equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

As of and for the years ended

 

 

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

 

 

2016

 

2015

 

2014

 

2013

 

2012

Net income

 

$

23,060

 

$

4,881

 

$

9,176

 

$

6,927

 

$

(543)

Add: impact of core deposit intangible amortization expense, after tax

 

 

3,343

 

 

3,295

 

 

3,260

 

 

3,235

 

 

3,233

Net income adjusted for impact of core deposit intangible amortization expense, after tax

 

$

26,403

 

$

8,176

 

$

12,436

 

$

10,162

 

$

2,690

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income before income taxes FTE (non-GAAP)

 

$

30,088

 

$

10,620

 

$

13,271

 

$

10,877

 

$

4,037

Add: impact of core deposit intangible amortization expense, before tax

 

 

5,480

 

 

5,401

 

 

5,344

 

 

5,346

 

 

5,344

Add: provision for loan losses

 

 

23,651

 

 

12,444

 

 

6,209

 

 

4,296

 

 

27,995

FTE income adjusted for impact of core deposit intangible amortization expense and provision (non-GAAP)

 

$

59,219

 

$

28,465

 

$

24,824

 

$

20,519

 

$

37,376

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Average assets

 

$

4,651,953

 

$

4,831,070

 

$

4,867,929

 

$

5,175,210

 

$

5,786,762

Less: average goodwill and intangible assets, net of deferred tax asset related to goodwill

 

 

(59,977)

 

 

(66,549)

 

 

(73,074)

 

 

(79,964)

 

 

(86,841)

Average tangible assets (non-GAAP)

 

$

4,591,976

 

$

4,764,521

 

$

4,794,855

 

$

5,095,246

 

$

5,699,921

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Average shareholders' equity

 

$

583,686

 

$

701,476

 

$

860,691

 

$

1,038,753

 

$

1,093,998

Less: average goodwill and intangible assets, net of deferred tax asset related to goodwill

 

 

(59,977)

 

 

(66,549)

 

 

(73,074)

 

 

(79,964)

 

 

(86,841)

Average tangible common equity (non-GAAP)

 

$

523,709

 

$

634,927

 

$

787,617

 

$

958,789

 

$

1,007,157

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Return on average assets

 

 

0.50%

 

 

0.10%

 

 

0.19%

 

 

0.13%

 

 

(0.01)%

Return on average tangible assets (non-GAAP)

 

 

0.57%

 

 

0.17%

 

 

0.26%

 

 

0.20%

 

 

0.05%

Return on average tangible assets before provision for loan losses and taxes FTE (non-GAAP)

 

 

1.29%

 

 

0.60%

 

 

0.52%

 

 

0.40%

 

 

0.66%

Return on average equity

 

 

3.95%

 

 

0.70%

 

 

1.07%

 

 

0.67%

 

 

(0.05)%

Return on average tangible common equity (non-GAAP)

 

 

5.04%

 

 

1.29%

 

 

1.58%

 

 

1.06%

 

 

0.27%

 

39


 

Table of Contents

Fully Taxable Equivalent Yield on Earning Assets and Net Interest Margin

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As of and for the years ended

 

 

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

    

December 31, 

 

 

2016

 

2015

 

2014

 

2013

 

2012

Interest income

 

$

160,448

 

$

171,407

 

$

184,662

 

$

195,475

 

$

233,485

Add: impact of taxable equivalent adjustment

 

 

4,081

 

 

2,695

 

 

930

 

 

 

 

Interest income FTE (non-GAAP)

 

$

164,529

 

$

174,102

 

$

185,592

 

$

195,475

 

$

233,485

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income

 

$

145,640

 

$

156,945

 

$

170,249

 

$

178,961

 

$

204,251

Add: impact of taxable equivalent adjustment

 

 

4,081

 

 

2,695

 

 

930

 

 

 

 

Net interest income FTE (non-GAAP)

 

$

149,721

 

$

159,640

 

$

171,179

 

$

178,961

 

$

204,251

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Average earning assets

 

$

4,290,171

 

$

4,439,139

 

$

4,446,903

 

$

4,698,552

 

$

5,130,836

Yield on earning assets

 

 

3.75%

 

 

3.86%

 

 

4.15%

 

 

4.16%

 

 

4.55%

Yield on earning assets FTE (non-GAAP)

 

 

3.84%

 

 

3.92%

 

 

4.17%

 

 

4.16%

 

 

4.55%

Net interest margin

 

 

3.39%

 

 

3.54%

 

 

3.83%

 

 

3.81%

 

 

3.98%

Net interest margin FTE (non-GAAP)

 

 

3.49%

 

 

3.60%

 

 

3.85%

 

 

3.81%

 

 

3.98%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

40


 

Table of Contents

Item 7.       MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.

 

The following management's discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and related notes as of and for the years   ended December 31, 2016, 2015, and 2014, and with the other financial and statistical data presented in this annual report. This discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements that involve risks, uncertainties and assumptions that may cause actual results to differ materially from management's expectations. Factors that could cause such differences are discussed in the section entitled “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors” and should be read herewith.

 

On December 31, 2015, our bank subsidiary converted to a Colorado state-charted bank and changed its name from NBH Bank, N.A. to NBH Bank. All references to NBH Bank should be considered synonymous with references to NBH Bank, N.A. prior to the name change.

 

All amounts are in thousands, except share data, or as otherwise noted.

 

Overview

 

We believe that our established presence in the attractive markets of Colorado and the greater Kansas City area positions us well for growth opportunities. Our focus is on building strong banking relationships with small to medium-sized businesses and consumers, while maintaining a low risk profile designed to generate reliable income streams and attractive returns. Through our acquisitions, we have established a solid financial services franchise with a sizable presence for deposit gathering and client relationship building necessary for growth. As of December 31, 2016, we had $4.6 billion in assets, $2.9 billion in loans, $3.9 billion in deposits and $0.5 billion in equity.

 

Operating Highlights and Key Challenges

 

Our operations resulted in the following highlights as of and for the year ended December 31, 2016 (except as noted):

 

Strategic execution

 

 

 

 

    

Net income for 2016 was $23.1 million, or $0.79 per diluted share, compared to net income of $4.9 million, or $0.14 per diluted share for 2015. The return on average tangible assets was 0.57% for year ended 2016 compared to 0.17% for the year ended 2015. The return on average tangible equity was 5.04% for the year ended 2016 compared to 1.29% for the year ended 2015.

    

Loan originations totaled a record of over $1.0 billion during the past twelve months, resulting in originated loan outstandings growth of 17.8%. Net charge-offs on non 310-30 loans totaled 0.85% for the full year. Excluding energy sector net charge-offs, the 2016 net charge-offs on non 310-30 loans totaled 0.10%, compared to 0.12% in 2015.

    

Maintained a conservatively structured loan portfolio represented by diverse industries and conservative concentrations.

    

Opportunistic capital management – repurchased 4.5 million shares during 2016, or 14.8%, at a weighted average price of $20.78. Since early 2013, we have repurchased 50.9% of our shares outstanding, at a weighted average price of $20.03.

    

Maintained focus on expenses and enhancing operational efficiencies as evidenced by 2016 non-interest expenses decreasing $22.0 million, or 13.9%, from the prior year.

 

41


 

Table of Contents

Loan portfolio

 

 

 

 

    

Total loans ended 2016 at $2.9 billion, a 10.6% increase from the prior year.

    

Organic loan originations totaled over $1.0 billion, representing a 7.3% increase from the prior year.

    

Originated loans at December 31, 2016 totaled $2.6 billion representing an increase of $387.4 million, or 17.8%, from the prior year.

    

Successfully exited $57.0 million, or 28.1%, of the remaining acquired 310-30 loan portfolio during 2016.

    

Maintained a diverse loan portfolio with no single industry sector comprising more than 15% of total loan exposure.

 

Credit quality

 

Non 310-30 loans

 

 

 

 

    

Net charge-offs on non 310-30 loans totaled 0.85% for the full year. Excluding energy sector net charge-offs, the 2016 net charge-offs on non 310-30 loans totaled 0.10%, compared to 0.12% in 2015.

    

Credit quality remained stable, as 90 days past due and non-accruing loans were 1.13% of total loans at December 31, 2016 compared to 1.08% at December 31, 2015. Non performing non 310-30 assets to total non 310-30 loans and OREO declined to 1.61% from 1.81% in the prior year.

 

ASC 310-30 loans

 

 

 

 

    

Added a net $9.5 million to accretable yield for the acquired loans accounted for under ASC 310-30.

 

Client deposit funded balance sheet

 

 

 

 

    

Average transaction deposits totaled $2.7 billion representing an increase of $142.7 million, or 5.6%, from the prior year.

    

Our relationship banking model drove solid growth in average demand deposits, adding $36.5 million, or 4.7%, from the prior year.

    

Higher-cost average time deposits decreased $103.6 million, or 8.1%, from the prior year.

    

The mix of transaction deposits to total deposits improved to 69.7% at December 31, 2016 from 68.9% in the prior year.

    

The average cost of deposits totaled 0.36%, consistent with the prior year.

 

Revenues

 

 

 

 

    

Fully taxable equivalent net interest income totaled $149.7 million, representing a decrease of $9.9 million, or 6.2%, from 2015. Lower levels of higher-yielding 310-30 loans and investment portfolio paydowns decreased interest income by $22.9 million and were partially offset by a $13.5 million increase in non 310-30 interest income from new loan originations.

    

The continued resolution of the higher-yielding acquired loan portfolio and lower rates on the originated portfolio led to a 0.11% narrowing of the fully taxable equivalent net interest margin to 3.49% from 3.60%.

 

Non-interest income totaled $40.0 million during 2016, compared to $21.4 million during 2015, increasing $18.6 million. Excluding the net $14.5 million of negative FDIC-related income and bargain purchase gain in the prior year, non-interest income increased $4.1 million, or 11.3%.

 

    

Bank card fees increased $0.5 million on the strength of higher interchange activity, while gain on sales of mortgages, net increased $0.9 million on a higher level of originations. Service charges decreased $0.9 million due to lower instances of overdrafts and OREO-related income decreased $0.1 million.

 

    

Other non-interest income increased $3.4 million primarily from a $1.8 million gain on sale of a building, net swap related income increase of $0.7 million and a $0.6 million increase in gain on recoveries of acquired loans.

 

42


 

Table of Contents

 

 

 

Expenses

 

 

 

 

    

Non-interest expense totaled $136.0 million during 2016, representing a decrease of $22.0 million, or 13.9%. The decrease was partially due to lower salaries and benefits of $3.3 million, lower occupancy and equipment of $1.6 million and lower professional fees of $1.0 million. Telecommunications and data processing expense decreased $5.5 million, or 48.1%, driven by the core system conversion completed in the fourth quarter of 2015.

    

Problem asset workout expenses and gain on sale of OREO improved a combined $4.9 million. The decrease was driven by higher year-over-year OREO gains of $1.6 million and lower problem asset workout expenses of $3.3 million as we reduced our acquired problem loan portfolio.

 

Strong capital position

 

 

 

 

    

Capital ratios are strong as our capital position remains well in excess of federal bank regulatory thresholds. As of December 31, 2016, our consolidated tier 1 leverage ratio was 10.4% and our consolidated tier 1 risk-based capital and common equity tier 1 risk-based capital ratios were both 14.2%.

    

The excess accretable yield on ASC 310-30 loans above a 4.0% yield (an approximate yield on new loan originations), and discounted at 5%, adds $0.93 after-tax to our tangible book value per share as of December 31, 2016, resulting in a tangible common book value per share of $19.08.

    

During 2016, we repurchased 4.5 million shares, or 14.8% of outstanding shares, at a weighted average price of $20.78 per share. Since early 2013, we have repurchased 26.6 million shares, or 50.9% of then outstanding shares, at an attractive weighted average price of $20.03 per share.

 

Key Challenges

 

There are a number of significant challenges confronting us and our industry. In our short history, we have acquired distressed financial institutions, and sought to rebuild them and implement operational efficiencies across the enterprise as a whole. We face continual challenges implementing our business strategy, including growing the assets and deposits of our business amidst intense competition, particularly for loans and deposits, low interest rates, changes in the regulatory environment and identifying and consummating disciplined merger and acquisition opportunities in a very competitive environment.

 

General economic conditions continued to modestly improve in 2016. Residential real estate values have largely recovered from their lows and commercial real estate property fundamentals continued to improve in our markets and nationally across all property types and classes. We consider this recovery with guarded optimism. A significant portion of our loan portfolio is secured by real estate and any deterioration in real estate values or credit quality or elevated levels of non-performing assets would ultimately have a negative impact on the quality of our loan portfolio.

 

Oil and gas prices began a steep decline in November 2014 and have remained depressed throughout 2016.  While there have been job losses related to the Energy sector, employment rates and job creation have trended favorably as other industry sectors have offset declines in Energy.  Nevertheless, the direct impact on the Energy sector has been profound and we have experienced credit deterioration and credit losses in our Energy loan portfolio. Energy loans comprised 3.2% of our total loans and prolonged or further pricing pressure on oil and gas could lead to additional credit stress in our energy portfolio.

 

Our originated loan portfolio at December 31, 2016 totaled $2.6 billion, representing an increase of $387.4 million, or 17.8%, compared to December 31, 2015, due to over $1.0 billion in 2016 loan originations, partially offset by loan paydowns, particularly in our acquired loan portfolio of $57.0 million, or 28.1%, compared to the prior year. Our acquired loans have produced higher yields than our originated loans, due to the recognition of accretion of fair value adjustments and accretable yield. The tepid economic recovery and intense loan competition have kept interest rates low during 2016, limiting the yields we have been able to obtain on originated loans. During 2016, our weighted average rate on loan originations was 3.70% (fully taxable equivalent), which is lower than the 2015 weighted average yield of our total loan portfolio of 5.71% (fully taxable equivalent). We expect downward pressure on the yields on our total loan portfolio to the extent that our originated loan portfolio does not provide sufficient yields to replace the high yields on the acquired loan portfolio as they pay down or pay off. Growth in our interest income will ultimately be dependent on our ability to generate sufficient volumes of high-quality originated loans.

43


 

Table of Contents

 

Increased regulation, impending new liquidity and capital constraints, and a continual need to bolster cybersecurity are adding costs and uncertainty to all U.S. banks and could affect profitability. Also, nontraditional participants in the market may offer increased competition as non-bank payment businesses are expanding into traditional banking products. While certain external factors are out of our control and may provide obstacles to our business strategy, we believe that we are prepared to deal with these challenges. We seek to remain flexible, yet methodical and proactive, in our strategic decision making so that we can quickly respond to market changes and the inherent challenges and opportunities that accompany such changes.

 

Application of Critical Accounting Policies

 

We use accounting principles and methods that conform to GAAP and general banking practices. We are required to apply significant judgment and make material estimates in the preparation of our financial statements and with regard to various accounting, reporting and disclosure matters. Assumptions and estimates are required to apply these principles where actual measurement is not possible or practical. The most significant of these estimates relate to the accounting for acquired loans and the determination of the ALL. These critical accounting policies and estimates are summarized below, and are further analyzed with other significant accounting policies in note 2, “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” in the notes to our consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2016.

 

Accounting for Acquired Loans

 

Included in our loan portfolio are originated loans and acquired loans. The estimated fair values of acquired loans are based on a discounted cash flow methodology that considers various factors, including the type of loan or pool of loans with similar characteristics, and related collateral, classification status, fixed or variable interest rate, maturity and any prepayment terms of the loan, whether or not the loan is amortizing, and a discount rate reflecting our assessment of risk inherent in the cash flow estimates. The determination of the fair value of acquired loans takes into account credit quality deterioration and probability of loss, and as a result the related allowance for loan losses is not carried forward at the time of acquisition.

 

A significant portion of the loans acquired in the Hillcrest Bank, Bank of Choice, and Community Banks of Colorado acquisitions had deteriorated credit quality at the date of acquisition and management accounted for all loans acquired through these acquisitions under ASC 310-30 (with the exception of loans with revolving privileges, which were outside the scope of ASC 310-30). These loans are grouped into pools based on purpose and/or type of loan, geography and risk rating, and take into account the sources of repayment and collateral. Each pool is accounted for as a single loan for which the integrity is maintained throughout the life of the asset. When a pool exhibits evidence of credit deterioration since origination and it is probable at the date of acquisition that we will not collect all principal and interest payments in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement, the expected shortfall in the expected future cash flows compared to the contractual amount due is recognized as a non-accretable difference. Any excess of the expected future cash flows over the acquisition date fair value is known as the accretable discount, or accretable yield, and through accretion is recognized as interest income over the remaining life of the respective pool. Contractual fees not expected to be collected are not included in ASC 310-30 contractual cash flows. Should fees be subsequently collected, the cash flows are accounted for as non 310-30 fee income in the period they are received. Loans that meet the criteria for non-accrual of interest at the time of acquisition may be considered performing upon and subsequent to acquisition, regardless of whether the client is contractually delinquent, if the timing and expected cash flows on such loans can be reasonably estimated and if collection of the new carrying value of such loans is expected.  If the timing and expected cash flows of a pool cannot be reasonably estimated, that pool may be placed on non-accrual status, the accretion of income will cease, and interest income will be recognized on a cash basis. In addition, a pool will be accounted for on a cash basis to the extent the remaining discount on the pool is equal its unpaid principal balance.

 

44


 

Table of Contents

Loan pools accounted for under ASC 310-30 are periodically remeasured to determine expected future cash flows. In determining the expected cash flows, we evaluate the credit profile, contractual interest rates, collateral values and expected prepayments of the loan pools. Prepayment assumptions are based on statistical models that take into account factors such as the loan interest rate, credit profile of the borrowers, the years in which the loans were originated, and whether the loans were fixed or variable rate loans.  Decreases to the expected future cash flows in the applicable pool generally result in an immediate provision for loan losses charged to the consolidated statements of operations. Conversely, subsequent increases in the expected future cash flows result in a transfer from the non-accretable difference to the accretable yield, which is then accreted as a yield adjustment over the remaining life of the pool once any previously recorded impairment expense has been recouped. These cash flow estimations are inherently subjective as they require material estimates, all of which may be susceptible to significant change.

 

Loans outside the scope of ASC 310-30 are accounted for under ASC Topic 310, Receivables . Discounts created when the loans are recorded at their estimated fair values at acquisition are accreted over the remaining life of the loan as an adjustment to the respective loan’s yield. Similar to originated loans, the accrual of interest income is discontinued on acquired loans that are not accounted for under ASC 310-30 when the collection of principal or interest, in whole or in part, is doubtful. Interest is not accrued on loans 90 days or more past due unless they are well secured and in the process of collection.

 

Allowance for Loan Losses

 

The determination of the ALL, which represents management’s estimate of probable losses inherent in our loan portfolio at the balance sheet date, including acquired loans to the extent necessary, involves a high degree of judgment and complexity. The determination of the ALL takes into consideration, among other matters, the estimated fair value of the underlying collateral, economic conditions, particularly as such conditions relate to the market areas in which we operate, historical net loan losses and other factors that warrant recognition. Any change in these factors, or the rise of any other factors that we, or our regulators, may deem necessary to consider when estimating the ALL, may materially affect the ALL and provisions for loan losses. For further discussion of the ALL, see “—Financial Condition—Asset Quality” and “—Financial Condition—Allowance for Loan Losses” and notes 2 and 7 to our consolidated financial statements.

 

Financial Condition

 

Total assets were $4.6 billion at December 31, 2016 compared to $4.7 billion at December 31, 2015. During the year ended 2016, the decrease from the investment securities portfolio and acquired 310-30 loans was used to fund loan growth. Total loans were $2.9 billion at December 31, 2016, and grew $273.2 million, or 10.6% from December 31, 2015. Originated loans totaled $2.6 billion and increased $387.4 million, or 17.8%, during 2016. We originated over $1.0 billion of loans during 2016, which grew the balances in our non 310-30 portfolio $330.2 million year-over-year, or 13.8%. The acquired 310-30 loan portfolio declined $57.0 million, or 28.1%, from December 31, 2015, as a result of the continued successful workout efforts that have been made on our existing acquired problem loans. OREO decreased $5.2 million or 24.8%, as we continue to resolve problem assets. Lower cost demand, savings, and money market ("transaction") deposits increased $49.8 million, or 1.9%, while time deposits decreased $21.8 million, or 1.8%, as we continued to focus on developing long-term banking relationships with clients. 

 

Total assets were $4.7 billion at December 31, 2015 compared to $4.8 billion at December 31, 2014. During the year ended 2015, the decrease from the investment securities portfolio and 310-30 loans was used to fund loan growth. Total loans were $2.6 billion at December 31, 2015, and grew $425.3 million, or 19.7% from December 31, 2014. We originated $966.9 million of loans during 2015, which grew the balances in our non 310-30 portfolio $502.1 million year-over-year, or 26.7%. The acquired 310-30 loan portfolio declined $76.8 million, or 27.5%, from December 31, 2014, as a result of the continued successful workout efforts that have been made on our existing acquired problem loans. OREO deceased $8.3 million, or 28.6%, as we continue to resolve problem assets. The indemnification asset and amounts due to the FDIC were eliminated from our consolidated statement of financial condition as of December 31, 2015 as a result of our termination of the loss-share agreements with the FDIC in the fourth quarter of 2015. Lower cost demand, savings, and money market ("transaction") deposits increased $237.9 million, or 9.5%, while average time deposits decreased $140.6 million, or 9.9%, as we continued to focus our deposit base on clients who were interested in market-rate time deposits and in developing long-term banking relationships. 

 

45


 

Table of Contents

Investment Securities

 

Available-for-sale

 

Total investment securities available-for-sale were $0.9 billion at December 31, 2016, compared to $1.2 billion at December 31, 2015, a decrease of $273.0 billion, or 23.6%. During 2016, maturities and pay downs of available-for-sale securities totaled $275.5 million. Purchases of available-for-sale securities during 2016 totaled $4.9 million.

 

Our available-for-sale investment securities portfolio is summarized as follows for the periods indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

    

Weighted

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

    

Weighted

 

 

Amortized

 

Fair

 

Percent of

 

average

 

Amortized

 

Fair

 

Percent of

 

average

 

 

cost

 

value

 

portfolio

 

yield

 

cost

 

value

 

portfolio

 

yield

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

223,781

 

$

227,160

 

25.8%

 

2.31%

 

$

305,773

 

$

310,978

 

26.8%

 

2.24%

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

666,616

 

 

652,739

 

73.8%

 

1.71%

 

 

861,321

 

 

845,543

 

73.1%

 

1.74%

Municipal securities

 

 

3,921

 

 

3,914

 

0.4%

 

3.34%

 

 

306

 

 

306

 

0.0%

 

0.00%

Other securities

 

 

419

 

 

419

 

0.0%

 

0.00%

 

 

419

 

 

419

 

0.1%

 

0.00%

Total investment securities available-for-sale

 

$

894,737

 

$

884,232

 

100.0%

 

1.86%

 

$

1,167,819

 

$

1,157,246

 

100.0%

 

1.87%

 

As of December 31, 2016 and 2015, generally the entire available-for-sale investment portfolio was backed by mortgages. The residential mortgage pass-through securities portfolio is comprised of both fixed rate and adjustable rate Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (“FHLMC”), Federal National Mortgage Association (“FNMA”) and Government National Mortgage Association (“GNMA”) securities. The other mortgage-backed securities are comprised of securities backed by FHLMC, FNMA and GNMA securities.

 

At December 31, 2016 and 2015, adjustable rate securities comprised 6.7% and 7.3%, respectively, of the available-for-sale MBS portfolio. The remainder of the portfolio was comprised of fixed rate amortizing securities with 10 to 30 year contractual maturities, with a weighted average coupon of 2.0% per annum and 2.1% per annum at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

 

The available-for-sale investment portfolio included $16.5 million and $19.9 million of gross unrealized losses at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively, which were partially offset by $6.0 million and $9.4 million of gross unrealized gains, respectively. In addition to the U.S. Government agency or sponsored enterprise backings of our MBS portfolio, we believe any unrecognized losses are a result of prevailing interest rates, and as such, we do not believe that any of the securities with unrealized losses were other-than-temporarily-impaired.

 

  Held-to-maturity

 

 

 

At December 31, 2016, we held $332.5 million of held-to-maturity investment securities, compared to $427.5 million at December 31, 2015, a decrease of $95.0 million, or 22.2%. The Company did not purchase any held-to-maturity securities during 2016.

 

46


 

Table of Contents

Held-to-maturity investment securities are summarized as follows as of the date indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

    

Amortized

    

Fair

    

Percent of

    

average

    

Amortized

    

Fair

    

Percent of

    

average

 

 

cost

 

value

 

portfolio

 

yield

 

cost

 

value

 

portfolio

 

yield

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

263,411

 

$

264,862

 

79.2%

 

3.24%

 

$

340,131

 

$

342,812

 

79.6%

 

3.24%

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

69,094

 

 

67,711

 

20.8%

 

1.68%

 

 

87,372

 

 

85,773

 

20.4%

 

1.69%

Total investment securities held-to-maturity

 

$

332,505

 

$

332,573

 

100.0%

 

2.91%

 

$

427,503

 

$

428,585

 

100.0%

 

2.92%

 

The residential mortgage pass-through and other residential MBS held-to-maturity investment portfolios are comprised of fixed rate FHLMC, FNMA and GNMA securities.

 

The fair value of the held-to-maturity investment portfolio was $332.6 million and $428.6 million, at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively, and included $0.1 million and $1.1 million of net unrealized gains for the respective periods.

 

Loans Overview

 

At December 31, 2016, our loan portfolio was comprised of new loans that we have originated and loans that were acquired in connection with our five acquisitions to date. As discussed in note 2 to our consolidated financial statements, in accordance with applicable accounting guidance, all acquired loans are recorded at fair value at the date of acquisition, and an allowance for loan losses is not carried over with the loans but, rather, the fair value of the loans encompasses both credit quality and contractual interest rate considerations. Loans that exhibit signs of credit deterioration at the date of acquisition are accounted for in accordance with the provisions of ASC 310-30 .   Management accounted for all loans acquired in the Hillcrest Bank, Bank of Choice and Community Banks of Colorado acquisitions under ASC 310-30, with the exception of loans with revolving privileges, which were outside the scope of ASC 310-30. In our Bank Midwest transaction, we did not acquire all of the loans of the former Bank Midwest but, rather, selected certain loans based upon specific criteria of performance, adequacy of collateral, and loan type that were performing at the time of acquisition. As a result, none of the loans acquired in the Bank Midwest transaction are accounted for under ASC 310-30. None of the loans acquired in the Pine River transaction are accounted for under ASC 310-30.

 

47


 

Table of Contents

The table below shows the loan portfolio composition and the breakout of the portfolio between ASC 310-30 loans and non 310-30 loans at the respective dates:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2016 vs 2015

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

% Change

Loans excluded from ASC 310-30:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

$

1,074,696

 

$

892,889

 

 

20.4%

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

221,544

 

 

184,619

 

 

20.0%

Agriculture

 

134,637

 

 

145,558

 

 

(7.5)%

Energy

 

90,273

 

 

146,880

 

 

(38.5)%

Total commercial

 

1,521,150

 

 

1,369,946

 

 

11.0%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

437,642

 

 

321,712

 

 

36.0%

Residential real estate

 

728,361

 

 

662,550

 

 

9.9%

Consumer

 

27,916

 

 

30,635

 

 

(8.9)%

Total loans excluded from ASC 310-30

 

2,715,069

 

 

2,384,843

 

 

13.8%

Loans accounted for under ASC 310-30:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

39,280

 

 

57,474

 

 

(31.7)%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

89,150

 

 

121,173

 

 

(26.4)%

Residential real estate

 

16,524

 

 

21,452

 

 

(23.0)%

Consumer

 

898

 

 

2,731

 

 

(67.1)%

Total loans accounted for under ASC 310-30

 

145,852

 

 

202,830

 

 

(28.1)%

Total loans

$

2,860,921

 

$

2,587,673

 

 

10.6%

 

Our loan portfolio totaled $2.9 billion at December 31, 2016, representing an increase of $273.2 million, or 10.6%, year-over-year on the strength of over $1.0 billion in loan originations between the two periods. The strong originations were the result of continued market penetration. Originated loans outstanding totaled $2.6 billion representing an increase of $387.4 million, or 17.8%, year-over-year, led by an 11.0% increase in total commercial loans. The acquired 310-30 loan portfolio declined $57.0 million, or 28.1%, from December 31, 2015 as a result of the continued successful workout efforts that have been made on exiting acquired problem loans. At December 31, 2016, $14.4 million of non 310-30 loans were held-for-sale, most of which were in the residential real estate segment.

 

We have successfully generated new relationships with small to medium-sized businesses and individuals, experiencing particularly strong loan growth in our commercial portfolio, which at December 31, 2016, was comprised of diverse industry segments. These segments included public administration-related loans of $327.7 million, finance and insurance related loans of $196.9 million, agriculture loans of $144.0 million, energy-related loans of $90.3 million, and manufacturing-related loans of $84.3 million, and a variety of smaller subcategories of commercial and industrial loans.

 

Included in our commercial loans are energy-related loans that comprised 19.2% of the Company’s risk based capital and 3.2% of total loans. The average balance per client in the energy sector was $3.8 million at December 31, 2016. Energy midstream (loans to companies that engage in consolidation, storage, and transportation of oil and gas), energy production (loans to companies engaged in exploration and production), and energy services (loans to companies that provide products and services to oil/gas companies), made up 47.9%, 36.3%, and 15.8%, respectively, of the total energy related portfolio at December 31, 2016. Unfunded commitments to energy clients totaled $96.1 million at December 31, 2016, including $63.8 million to production clients, $29.0 million to midstream clients and $3.3 million to services clients. We may not be contractually required to fund certain amounts depending on the individual circumstances of each client. Energy prices continued to be depressed through the fourth quarter of 2016, which may result in continued stress on our energy clients and the credit quality of our energy loan portfolio.

 

48


 

Table of Contents

Loans in the midstream subsector totaled $43.2 million, with an average balance per client of $8.6 million. One midstream client rated special mention at December 31, 2015, was placed on non-accrual during the first quarter of 2016, and remained on non-accrual with a loan balance of $3.0 million at December 31, 2016. Loans in the production subsector totaled $32.8 million of the energy loan balances at December 31, 2016, with an average balance per client of $2.7 million. We lend only against proven reserves of our production clients and on a senior secured basis. One production client was rated substandard at December 31, 2015, was placed on non-accrual during the first quarter of 2016 and remained on non-accrual with a loan balance of $6.5 million at December 31, 2016. Loans in the services subsector totaled $14.3 million with an average balance per client of $2.0 million. We identified two loans within the energy services sector that were placed on non-accrual in the third quarter of 2015. Both loans were resolved and charged-off during 2016. One energy services client with a loan balance of $3.2 million as of December 31, 2016, was placed on non-accrual during the third quarter of 2016 and remained on non-accrual at December 31, 2016.

 

At December 31, 2016, our non owner-occupied commercial real estate totaled $526.8 million and were 112.0% of the Company’s risk based capital, or 18.4%, of total loans, and no specific property type comprised more than 4.5% of total loans. Multi-family loans totaled $25.0 million, or less than 1.0% of total loans as of December 31, 2016. Agriculture loans totaled $134.6 million and were 28.6% of the Company’s risk based capital and 4.7% of total loans.

 

The table below shows the geographic breakout of our loan portfolio at December 31, 2016 and 2015, based on the domicile of the borrower or, in the case of collateral-dependent loans, the geographical location of the collateral:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

 

 

 

Percent of

 

 

 

 

Percent of

 

    

Loan balance

    

loan portfolio

 

Loan balance

    

loan portfolio

Colorado

 

$

1,188,155

 

41.5%

 

$

1,120,806

 

43.3%

Missouri

 

 

595,964

 

20.8%

 

 

651,386

 

25.2%

Texas

 

 

296,539

 

10.4%

 

 

274,012

 

10.6%

Kansas

 

 

245,059

 

8.6%

 

 

198,374

 

7.7%

California

 

 

90,643

 

3.2%

 

 

53,313

 

2.1%

Other

 

 

444,561

 

15.5%

 

 

289,782

 

11.1%

Total

 

$

2,860,921

 

100.0%

 

$

2,587,673

 

100.0%

 

New loan origination is a direct result of our ability to recruit and retain top banking talent, connect with clients in our markets and provide needed services at competitive rates.  Loan originations totaled a record $1.0 billion over the past twelve months, resulting in originated loan outstanding growth of 17.8% over December 31, 2015. Originations are defined as closed end funded loans and revolving lines of credit advances, net of any current period paydowns. Management utilizes this more conservative definition of originations to better approximate the impact of originations on loans outstanding and ultimately net income. The following table represents new loan originations during 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fourth quarter

    

Third quarter

    

Second quarter

    

First quarter

    

Total

 

 

2016

 

2016

 

2016

 

2016

 

2016

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

109,670

 

$

92,433

 

$

142,179

 

$

59,361

 

$

403,643

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

18,606

 

 

19,091

 

 

17,883

 

 

10,399

 

 

65,979

Agriculture

 

 

18,480

 

 

9,589

 

 

18,072

 

 

10,375

 

 

56,516

Energy

 

 

4,433

 

 

(1,251)

 

 

(17,328)

 

 

(13,984)

 

 

(28,130)

Total Commercial

 

 

151,189

 

 

119,862

 

 

160,806

 

 

66,151

 

 

498,008

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

30,227

 

 

54,456

 

 

89,109

 

 

44,876

 

 

218,668

Residential real estate

 

 

89,968

 

 

102,703

 

 

63,815

 

 

49,722

 

 

306,208

Consumer

 

 

3,566

 

 

4,995

 

 

3,158

 

 

2,671

 

 

14,390

Total

 

$

274,950

 

$

282,016

 

$

316,888

 

$

163,420

 

$

1,037,274

 

49


 

Table of Contents

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fourth quarter

    

Third quarter

    

Second quarter

    

First quarter

    

Total

 

 

2015

 

2015

 

2015

 

2015

 

2015

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

122,664

 

$

134,189

 

$

135,654

 

$

123,829

 

$

516,336

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

13,395

 

 

12,095

 

 

17,566

 

 

12,778

 

 

55,834

Agriculture

 

 

24,194

 

 

11,295

 

 

19,019

 

 

3,605

 

 

58,113

Energy

 

 

1,075

 

 

17,245

 

 

11,667

 

 

5,291

 

 

35,278

Total Commercial

 

 

161,328

 

 

174,824

 

 

183,906

 

 

145,503

 

 

665,561

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

23,260

 

 

36,480

 

 

38,113

 

 

21,898

 

 

119,751

Residential real estate

 

 

50,387

 

 

36,808

 

 

44,699

 

 

33,042

 

 

164,936

Consumer

 

 

3,086

 

 

5,616

 

 

4,669

 

 

3,247

 

 

16,618

Total

 

$

238,061

 

$

253,728

 

$

271,387

 

$

203,690

 

$

966,866

 

The tables below show the contractual maturities of our loans for the dates indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

    

Due within

    

Due after 1 but

    

Due after

    

 

 

 

 

1 Year

 

within 5 Years

 

5 Years

 

Total

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

68,485

 

$

455,444

 

$

559,421

 

$

1,083,350

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

18,887

 

 

92,739

 

 

131,434

 

 

243,060

Agriculture

 

 

22,146

 

 

92,269

 

 

29,332

 

 

143,747

Energy

 

 

18,840

 

 

71,433

 

 

 —

 

 

90,273

Total Commercial

 

 

128,358

 

 

711,885

 

 

720,187

 

 

1,560,430

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

126,784

 

 

279,135

 

 

120,873

 

 

526,792

Residential real estate

 

 

9,554

 

 

35,506

 

 

699,825

 

 

744,885

Consumer

 

 

5,529

 

 

18,164

 

 

5,121

 

 

28,814

Total loans

 

$

270,225

 

$

1,044,690

 

$

1,546,006

 

$

2,860,921

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

    

Due within

    

Due after 1 but

    

Due after

    

 

 

 

 

1 Year

 

within 5 Years

 

5 Years

 

Total

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

68,678

 

$

452,896

 

$

384,323

 

$

905,896

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

17,772

 

 

77,673

 

 

116,889

 

 

212,334

Agriculture

 

 

40,982

 

 

80,268

 

 

41,060

 

 

162,310

Energy

 

 

17,914

 

 

126,919

 

 

2,046

 

 

146,879

Total Commercial

 

 

145,346

 

 

737,756

 

 

544,318

 

 

1,427,419

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

95,100

 

 

269,582

 

 

78,204

 

 

442,886

Residential real estate

 

 

10,681

 

 

33,438

 

 

639,883

 

 

684,002

Consumer

 

 

9,469

 

 

17,820

 

 

6,077

 

 

33,366

Total loans

 

$

260,596

 

$

1,058,596

 

$

1,268,482

 

$

2,587,673

 

50


 

Table of Contents

The stated interest rate (which excludes the effects of non-refundable loan origination and commitment fees, net of costs and the accretion of fair value marks) of non 310-30 loans with maturities over one year is as follows at the dates indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

 

Fixed

 

Variable

 

Total

 

    

 

 

    

Weighted

    

 

 

    

Weighted

    

 

 

    

Weighted

 

 

Balance

 

average rate

 

Balance

 

average rate

 

Balance

 

average rate

Commercial

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial (1)

 

$

544,464

 

3.25%

 

$

464,713

 

3.80%

 

$

1,009,177

 

3.50%

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

114,513

 

4.13%

 

 

92,535

 

4.32%

 

 

207,048

 

4.41%

Agriculture

 

 

41,373

 

4.62%

 

 

72,140

 

3.68%

 

 

113,513

 

4.02%

Energy

 

 

7,174

 

0.93%

 

 

64,259

 

3.60%

 

 

71,433

 

3.05%

Total Commercial

 

 

707,524

 

3.46%

 

 

693,647

 

3.84%

 

 

1,401,171

 

3.65%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

136,965

 

4.51%

 

 

221,527

 

3.65%

 

 

358,492

 

3.98%

Residential real estate

 

 

402,616

 

3.37%

 

 

316,784

 

3.73%

 

 

719,400

 

3.53%

Consumer

 

 

19,127

 

4.49%

 

 

3,395

 

4.06%

 

 

22,522

 

4.42%

Total loans with > 1 year maturity

 

$

1,266,232

 

3.56%

 

$

1,235,353

 

3.78%

 

$

2,501,585

 

3.67%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

Fixed

 

Variable

 

Total

 

    

 

 

    

Weighted

    

 

 

    

Weighted

    

 

 

    

Weighted

 

 

Balance

 

average rate

 

Balance

 

average rate

 

Balance

 

average rate

Commercial

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial (1)

 

$

449,444

 

3.33%

 

$

379,904

 

3.78%

 

$

829,348

 

3.54%

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

85,036

 

4.43%

 

 

88,090

 

4.04%

 

 

173,126

 

4.23%

Agriculture

 

 

49,261

 

4.69%

 

 

56,076

 

3.73%

 

 

105,337

 

4.18%

Energy

 

 

3,735

 

3.93%

 

 

125,230

 

2.99%

 

 

128,965

 

3.02%

Total Commercial

 

 

587,476

 

3.61%

 

 

649,300

 

3.66%

 

 

1,236,776

 

3.63%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

137,124

 

4.56%

 

 

162,781

 

3.43%

 

 

299,905

 

3.95%

Residential real estate

 

 

359,657

 

3.50%

 

 

294,051

 

3.73%

 

 

653,708

 

3.61%

Consumer

 

 

17,822

 

4.68%

 

 

3,652

 

4.10%

 

 

21,474

 

4.58%

Total loans with > 1 year maturity

 

$

1,102,079

 

3.71%

 

$

1,109,784

 

3.65%

 

$

2,211,863

 

3.68%

 

 

 

(1)

    

Included in commercial fixed rate loans are loans totaling $313,000 and $273,346 as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively, that have been swapped to variable rates at current market pricing. Included in the commercial segment are tax exempt loans totaling $384,641 and $347,637 with a weighted average rate of 3.01% and 3.18% at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

 

 

 

Accretable Yield

 

At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the accretable yield balance was $60.5 million and $84.2 million, respectively. We re-measured the expected cash flows quarterly for all 27 remaining loan pools accounted for under ASC 310-30 utilizing the same cash flow methodology used at the time of acquisition. This re-measurement resulted in a net $9.5 million and $18.0 million reclassification from non-accretable difference to accretable yield during 2016 and 2015, respectively. 

 

51


 

Table of Contents

In addition to the accretable yield on loans accounted for under ASC 310-30, the fair value adjustments on loans outside the scope of ASC 310-30 are also accreted to interest income over the life of the loans. Total remaining accretable yield and fair value mark was as follows for the dates indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

Remaining accretable yield on loans accounted for under ASC 310-30

 

$

60,476

 

$

84,194

Remaining accretable fair value mark on loans not accounted for under ASC 310-30

 

 

3,236

 

 

5,008

Total remaining accretable yield and fair value mark

 

$

63,712

 

$

89,202

 

 

Asset Quality

 

All of the assets acquired in our acquisitions were marked to fair value at the date of acquisition, and the fair value adjustments to loans included a credit quality component. We utilize traditional credit quality metrics to evaluate the overall credit quality of our loan portfolio; however, our credit quality ratios are somewhat limited in their comparability to industry averages or to other financial institutions because of the percentage of acquired problem loans and given that any asset quality deterioration that existed at the date of acquisition was considered in the original fair value adjustments.

 

Asset quality is fundamental to our success. Accordingly, for the origination of loans, we have established a credit policy that allows for responsive, yet controlled lending with credit approval requirements that are scaled to loan size. Within the scope of the credit policy, each prospective loan is reviewed in order to determine the appropriateness and the adequacy of the loan characteristics and the security or collateral prior to making a loan. We have established underwriting standards and loan origination procedures that require appropriate documentation, including financial data and credit reports. For loans secured by real property, we require property appraisals, title insurance or a title opinion, hazard insurance and flood insurance, in each case where appropriate.

 

Additionally, we have implemented procedures to timely identify loans that may become problematic in order to ensure the most beneficial resolution to the Company. Asset quality is monitored by our credit risk management department and evaluated based on quantitative and subjective factors such as the timeliness of contractual payments received. Additional factors that are considered, particularly with commercial loans over $500,000, include the financial condition and liquidity of individual borrowers and guarantors, if any, and the value of collateral. To facilitate the oversight of asset quality, loans are categorized based on the number of days past due and on an internal risk rating system, and both are discussed in more detail below.

 

Our internal risk rating system uses a series of grades which reflect our assessment of the credit quality of loans based on an analysis of the borrower's financial condition, liquidity and ability to meet contractual debt service requirements. Loans that are perceived to have acceptable risk are categorized as “Pass” loans. “Special mention” loans represent loans that have potential credit weaknesses that deserve close attention. Special mention loans include borrowers that have potential weaknesses or unwarranted risks that, unless corrected, may threaten the borrower's ability to meet debt service requirements. However, these borrowers are still believed to have the ability to respond to and resolve the financial issues that threaten their financial situation. Loans classified as “Substandard” have a well-defined credit weakness and are inadequately protected by the current paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any. Although these loans are identified as potential problem loans, they may never become non-performing. Substandard loans have a distinct possibility of loss if the deficiencies are not corrected. “Doubtful” loans are loans that management believes that collection of payments in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement are highly questionable and improbable. Doubtful loans are deemed impaired and put on non-accrual status.

 

52


 

Table of Contents

In the event of borrower default, we may seek recovery in compliance with state lending laws, the respective loan agreements, and credit monitoring and remediation procedures that may include modifying or restructuring a loan from its original terms, for economic or legal reasons, to provide a concession to the borrower from their original terms due to borrower financial difficulties in order to facilitate repayment. Such restructured loans are considered “troubled debt restructurings” or "TDRs" in accordance with ASC 310-40, Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors . Under this guidance, modifications to loans that fall within the scope of ASC 310-30 are not considered troubled debt restructurings, regardless of otherwise meeting the definition of a troubled debt restructuring. Assets that have been foreclosed on or acquired through deed-in-lieu of foreclosure are classified as OREO until sold, and are carried at the lower of the related loan balance or the fair value of the collateral less estimated costs to sell, with any initial valuation adjustments charged to the ALL and any subsequent declines in carrying value charged to impairments on OREO.

 

Non-performing Assets

 

Non-performing assets consist of non-accrual loans, troubled debt restructurings on non-accrual, OREO and other repossessed assets.  Non-accrual loans and troubled debt restructurings on non-accrual accounted for under ASC 310-30, as described below, may be excluded from our non-performing assets to the extent that the cash flows of the loan pools are still estimable. During the third quarter of 2014, we revised our definition of non-performing assets and non-performing loans to exclude accruing loans 90 days past due and accruing troubled debt restructurings to more accurately align the financial metrics related to non-performing assets and non-performing loans with our financial results. Prior period information has been modified for this revision. Interest income that would have been recorded had non-accrual loans performed in accordance with their original contract terms during 2016, 2015 and 2014, was $2.6 million, $1.4 million and $1.2 million, respectively.

 

Our acquired non-performing assets were marked to fair value at the time of acquisition, mitigating much of our loss potential on these non-performing assets. As a result, the levels of our non-performing assets are not fully comparable to those of our peers or to industry benchmarks.

 

All loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 were classified as performing assets at December 31, 2016, as the carrying values of the respective loan or pool of loans cash flows were considered estimable and probable of collection. Therefore, interest income, through accretion of the difference between the carrying value of the loans in the pool and the pool's expected future cash flows, is being recognized on all acquired loans accounted for under ASC 310-30.

 

53


 

Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the non-performing assets as of the dates presented:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

    

December 31, 2014

    

December 31, 2013

    

December 31, 2012

Non-accrual loans:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

$

1,160

 

$

942

 

$

221

 

$

15,572

 

$

1,547

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

2,054

 

 

954

 

 

385

 

 

467

 

 

3,135

Agriculture

 

297

 

 

1,904

 

 

130

 

 

153

 

 

230

Energy

 

6,517

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Total Commercial

 

10,028

 

 

3,800

 

 

736

 

 

16,192

 

 

4,912

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

66

 

 

407

 

 

222

 

 

1,131

 

 

1,400

Residential real estate

 

3,875

 

 

3,617

 

 

2,845

 

 

3,437

 

 

3,936

Consumer

 

40

 

 

30

 

 

37

 

 

10

 

 

Total non-accrual loans

 

14,009

 

 

7,854

 

 

3,840

 

 

20,770

 

 

10,248

Restructured loans on non-accrual:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

7,527

 

 

3,888

 

 

3,994

 

 

535

 

 

2,951

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

2

 

 

319

 

 

458

 

 

225

 

 

231

Agriculture

 

1,608

 

 

81

 

 

365

 

 

 —

 

 

20

Energy

 

6,128

 

 

12,009

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Total Commercial

 

15,265

 

 

16,297

 

 

4,817

 

 

760

 

 

3,202

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 —

 

 

815

 

 

 —

 

 

169

 

 

6,908

Residential real estate

 

1,301

 

 

679

 

 

1,966

 

 

2,408

 

 

2,471

Consumer

 

142

 

 

2

 

 

190

 

 

237

 

 

290

Total restructured loans on non-accrual

 

16,708

 

 

17,793

 

 

6,973

 

 

3,574

 

 

12,871

Total non-performing loans

 

30,717

 

 

25,647

 

 

10,813

 

 

24,344

 

 

23,119

OREO

 

15,662

 

 

20,814

 

 

29,120

 

 

70,125

 

 

94,808

Other repossessed assets

 

 —

 

 

894

 

 

849

 

 

1,086

 

 

1,331

Total non-performing assets

$

46,379

 

$

47,355

 

$

40,782

 

$

95,555

 

$

119,258

Loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing interest

$

 —

 

$

166

 

$

263

 

$

129

 

$

25

Accruing restructured loans

$

5,766

 

$

8,403

 

$

19,275

 

$

11,605

 

$

17,720

ALL

$

29,174

 

$

27,119

 

$

17,613

 

$

12,521

 

$

15,380

Total non-performing loans to total loans

 

1.07%

 

 

0.99%

 

 

0.50%

 

 

1.31%

 

 

1.26%

Loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing interest to total loans

 

0.00%

 

 

0.01%

 

 

0.01%

 

 

0.01%

 

 

0.00%

Total non-performing assets to total loans and OREO

 

1.61%

 

 

1.81%

 

 

1.86%

 

 

4.97%

 

 

6.19%

ALL to non-performing loans

 

94.98%

 

 

105.74%

 

 

162.89%

 

 

51.43%

 

 

66.53%

 

Total non-performing loans increased $5.1 million during 2016, largely driven by activity within the commercial and industrial and energy sectors. Non-performing loans within the commercial and industrial sector increased $3.9 million from December 31, 2015 largely due to two loan relationships totaling $6.6 million at December 31, 2016, partially offset by charge-offs throughout the year. Non-performing energy loans increased $0.6 million during 2016 driven by three loan relationships totaling $12.6 million at December 31, 2016 that were placed on non-accrual during 2016, partially offset by two loan relationships that were resolved and charged-off during 2016. During 2016, accruing TDRs decreased $2.7 million, driven by decreases of $2.6 million within the commercial sector.

54


 

Table of Contents

The OREO balance of $15.7 million at December 31, 2016, excludes $1.6 million of minority interest in participated OREO in connection with the repossession of collateral on loans for which we were not the lead bank and we do not have a controlling interest. These properties have been repossessed by the lead banks and we have recorded our receivable due from the lead banks in other assets as minority interest in participated OREO. During 2016, $6.9 million of OREO was foreclosed on or otherwise repossessed and $16.1 million of OREO was sold resulting in a net gain of $4.4 million. OREO write-downs of $0.3 million were recorded during 2016.

 

Total non-performing loans increased $14.8 million from December 31, 2014 to December 31, 2015. The primary driver was two energy services clients in the commercial segment totaling $12.0 million that were restructured and put on non-accrual status during the year. During 2015, accruing TDRs decreased $10.9 million. The decrease was the result of payoffs of prior restructured loans, partially offset by a $6.3 million restructure of a relationship in the commercial segment.

 

The OREO balance of $20.8 million at December 31, 2015, excludes $5.5 million of minority interest in participated OREO in connection with the repossession of collateral on loans for which we were not the lead bank and we do not have a controlling interest. These properties have been repossessed by the lead banks and we have recorded our receivable due from the lead banks in other assets as minority interest in participated OREO. During 2015, $4.6 million of OREO was foreclosed on or otherwise repossessed and $15.6 million of OREO was sold resulting in a net gain of $2.8 million. OREO write-downs of $1.6 million were recorded during 2015.

 

The following table represents the carrying value of our accruing and non-accrual loans compared to the unpaid principal balance ("UPB") as of December 31, 2016:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accruing

 

Non-accrual

 

Total

 

    

Unpaid

    

 

 

    

Carrying

    

Unpaid

    

 

 

    

Carrying

    

Unpaid

    

 

 

    

Carrying

 

 

principal

 

Carrying

 

value/

 

principal

 

Carrying

 

value/

 

principal

 

Carrying

 

value/

 

 

balance

 

value

 

UPB

 

balance

 

value

 

UPB

 

balance

 

value

 

UPB

Non ASC 310-30 loans

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

1,067,439

 

$

1,066,009

 

99.9%

 

$

9,789

 

$

8,688

 

88.8%

 

$

1,077,228

 

$

1,074,697

 

99.8%

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

220,233

 

 

219,488

 

99.7%

 

 

2,363

 

 

2,056

 

87.0%

 

 

222,596

 

 

221,544

 

99.5%

Agriculture

 

 

132,951

 

 

132,731

 

99.8%

 

 

1,961

 

 

1,905

 

97.1%

 

 

134,912

 

 

134,636

 

99.8%

Energy

 

 

78,095

 

 

77,628

 

99.4%

 

 

28,357

 

 

12,645

 

44.6%

 

 

106,452

 

 

90,273

 

84.8%

Total Commercial

 

 

1,498,718

 

 

1,495,856

 

99.8%

 

 

42,470

 

 

25,294

 

59.6%

 

 

1,541,188

 

 

1,521,150

 

98.7%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

439,639

 

 

437,576

 

99.5%

 

 

72

 

 

66

 

91.7%

 

 

439,711

 

 

437,642

 

99.5%

Residential real estate

 

 

724,608

 

 

723,185

 

99.8%

 

 

6,103

 

 

5,176

 

84.8%

 

 

730,711

 

 

728,361

 

99.7%

Consumer

 

 

27,738

 

 

27,735

 

99.9%

 

 

185

 

 

181

 

97.8%

 

 

27,923

 

 

27,916

 

99.9%

Total non ASC 310-30 loans

 

 

2,690,703

 

 

2,684,352

 

99.8%

 

 

48,830

 

 

30,717

 

62.9%

 

 

2,739,533

 

 

2,715,069

 

99.1%

ASC 310-30 loans

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

 

56,433

 

 

39,280

 

69.6%

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

0.0%

 

 

56,433

 

 

39,280

 

69.6%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

107,926

 

 

89,150

 

82.6%

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

0.0%

 

 

107,926

 

 

89,150

 

82.6%

Residential real estate

 

 

24,000

 

 

16,524

 

68.9%

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

0.0%

 

 

24,000

 

 

16,524

 

68.9%

Consumer

 

 

4,973

 

 

898

 

18.1%

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

0.0%

 

 

4,973

 

 

898

 

18.1%

Total loans accounted for under ASC 310-30

 

 

193,332

 

 

145,852

 

75.4%

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

0.0%

 

 

193,332

 

 

145,852

 

75.4%

Total loans

 

$

2,884,035

 

$

2,830,204

 

98.1%

 

$

48,830

 

$

30,717

 

62.9%

 

$

2,932,865

 

$

2,860,921

 

97.5%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

55


 

Table of Contents

Past Due Loans

 

Past due status is monitored as an indicator of credit deterioration. Loans are considered past due or delinquent when the contractual principal or interest due in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement remains unpaid after the due date of the scheduled payment. Loans that are 90 days or more past due and not accounted for under ASC 310-30 are put on non-accrual status unless the loan is well secured and in the process of collection. The table below shows the past due status of loans not accounted for under ASC 310-30, based on contractual terms of the loans as of December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

Loans 30-89 days past due and still accruing interest

 

$

2,296

 

$

6,716

 

Loans 90 days past due and still accruing interest

 

 

 —

 

 

165

 

Non-accrual loans

 

 

30,717

 

 

25,647

 

Total past due and non-accrual loans

 

$

33,013

 

$

32,528

 

Total 90 days past due and still accruing interest and non-accrual loans to total loans

 

 

1.13%

 

 

1.08%

 

Total non-accrual loans to total loans

 

 

1.13%

 

 

1.08%

 

% of total past due and non-accrual loans that carry fair value marks

 

 

10.75%

 

 

22.01%

 

 

Loans 30-89 days past due and still accruing interest decreased by $4.4 million from December 31, 2015 to December 31, 2016 and loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing interest decreased $0.2 million at December 31, 2016 compared to December 31, 2015, for a collective decrease in total past due loans of $4.6 million. Non-accrual loans increased $5.1 million at December 31, 2016 compared to December 31, 2015, further described within the Non-Performing Assets discussion of Management’s Discussion and Analysis. There were no ASC 310-30 loan pools past due or on non-accrual at December 31, 2016.

 

Allowance for Loan Losses

 

The ALL represents the amount that we believe is necessary to absorb probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio at the balance sheet date and involves a high degree of judgment and complexity. Determination of the ALL is based on an evaluation of the collectability of loans, the realizable value of underlying collateral, economic conditions, historical net loan losses, the estimated loss emergence period, estimated default rates, any declines in cash flow assumptions from acquisition, loan structures, growth factors and other elements that warrant recognition and, to the extent applicable, prior loss experience. The ALL is critical to the portrayal and understanding of our financial condition, liquidity and results of operations. The determination and application of the ALL accounting policy involves judgments, estimates, and uncertainties that are subject to change. Changes in these assumptions, estimates or the conditions surrounding them may have a material impact on our financial condition, liquidity or results of operations.

 

In accordance with the applicable guidance for business combinations, acquired loans were recorded at their acquisition date fair values, which were based on expected future cash flows and included an estimate for future loan losses; therefore, no ALL was recorded as of the acquisition date. Any estimated losses on acquired loans that arise after the acquisition date are reflected in a charge to the provision for loan losses on the consolidated statements of operations.

 

Loans accounted for under the accounting guidance provided in ASC 310-30 have been grouped into pools based on the predominant risk characteristics of purpose and/or type of loan. The timing and receipt of expected principal, interest and any other cash flows of these loans are periodically remeasured and the expected future cash flows of the collective pools are compared to the carrying value of the pools. To the extent that the expected future cash flows of each pool is less than the book value of the pool, an allowance for loan losses will be established through a charge to the provision for loan. If the remeasured expected future cash flows are greater than the book value of the pools, then the improvement in the expected future cash flows is accreted into interest income over the remaining expected life of the loan pool. During 2016 and 2015, these re-measurements resulted in overall increases in expected cash flows in certain loan pools, which, absent previous valuation allowances within the same pool, are reflected in increased accretion as well as an increased amount of accretable yield and are recognized over the expected remaining lives of the underlying loans as an adjustment to yield.

 

56


 

Table of Contents

For all loans not accounted for under ASC 310-30, the determination of the ALL follows a process to determine the appropriate level of ALL that is designed to account for changes in credit quality and other risk factors. This process provides an ALL consisting of a specific allowance component based on certain individually evaluated loans and a general allowance component based on estimates of reserves needed for all other loans, segmented based on similar risk characteristics.

 

  Impaired loans less than $250,000 are included in the general allowance population. Impaired loans over $250,000 are subject to individual evaluation on a regular basis to determine the need, if any, to allocate a specific reserve to the impaired loan. Typically, these loans consist of commercial, commercial real estate and agriculture loans and exclude homogeneous loans such as residential real estate and consumer loans. Specific allowances are determined by collectively analyzing:

 

 

 

 

    

The borrower’s resources, ability, and willingness to repay in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement;

 

the likelihood of receiving financial support from any guarantors;

 

the adequacy and present value of future cash flows, less disposal costs, of any collateral; and

 

the impact current economic conditions may have on the borrower's financial condition and liquidity or the value of the collateral.

 

In evaluating the loan portfolio for an appropriate ALL level, unimpaired loans are grouped into segments based on broad characteristics such as primary use and underlying collateral. During the first quarter of 2016, the Company updated the loan classifications in its allowance for loan losses model to include owner occupied commercial real estate and agriculture within the commercial loan segment and present energy as its own loan class within the commercial segment. The prior period presentations have been reclassified to conform to the current period presentation.  We have identified four primary loan segments that are further stratified into eleven loan classes to provide more granularity in analyzing loss history and to allow for more definitive qualitative adjustments based upon specific factors affecting each loan class. Following are the loan classes within each of the four primary loan segments:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-owner occupied

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

commercial real estate

 

Residential real estate

 

Consumer

Commercial and industrial

 

Construction

 

Senior lien

 

Total Consumer

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

Acquisition and development

 

Junior lien

 

 

Agriculture

 

Multifamily

 

 

 

 

Energy

 

Non-owner occupied

 

 

 

 

 

Appropriate ALL levels are determined by segment and class utilizing risk ratings, loss history, peer loss history and qualitative adjustments.  The qualitative adjustments consider the following risk factors:

 

 

 

 

    

economic/external conditions;

    

loan administration, loan structure and procedures;

    

risk tolerance/experience;

    

loan growth;

    

trends;

    

concentrations; and

    

other.

 

Management derives an estimated annual loss rate adjusted for an estimated loss emergence period based on historical loss data categorized by segment and class. The loss rates are applied at the loan segment and class level. Our historical loss history began in 2012, resulting in minimal losses in our originated portfolio. In order to address this lack of historical data, we incorporate not only our own historical loss rates since the beginning of 2012, but we also utilize peer historical loss data, including a historical average net charge-off ratio on each loan type, relying on the Uniform Bank Performance Reports compiled by the Federal Financial Institutions Examinations Council (“FFIEC”). We may also apply a long-term estimated loss rate to pass rated credits as necessary to account for inherent risks to the portfolio. For originated loans, we assign a slightly higher portion of our loss history, but still rely on the peer loss history to account for our limited historical data. For acquired loans, we use solely our internal loss history as those loans are more seasoned and more of the actual losses in the portfolio have been from the acquired portfolio.

 

57


 

Table of Contents

The collective resulting ALL for loans not accounted for under ASC 310-30 is calculated as the sum of the specific reserves and the general reserves. While these amounts are calculated by individual loan or segment and class, the entire ALL is available for any loan that, in our judgment, should be charged-off.

 

Non 310-30 ALL

 

During 2016, we recorded $24.5 million of provision for loan losses for loans not accounted for under ASC 310-30, which primarily reflects reserves to support loan growth and specific reserves on non-performing loans, particularly in the energy sector portfolio totaling $18.9 million. Net charge-offs for non ASC 310-30 loans during 2016 totaled $21.5 million and were driven by $19.1 million of energy sector loan charge-offs. Specific reserves on impaired loans totaled $2.4 million at December 31, 2016.

 

During 2015, we recorded $12.1 million of provision for loan losses for loans not accounted for under ASC 310-30, which primarily reflects reserves to support loan growth and specific reserves on certain non-performing loans. Net charge-offs for non ASC 310-30 loans during 2015 totaled $2.9 million and were primarily from the commercial and consumer loan segments. Specific reserves on impaired loans totaled $4.3 million at December 31, 2015.

 

310-30 ALL

 

During 2016, loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 had $805 thousand of recoupment. The recoupment was driven by a previously impaired agriculture pool.

 

During 2015, seven loan pools accounted for under ASC 310-30 had combined impairments of $336 thousand as a result of decreases in expected cash flows.

 

Total ALL

 

After considering the above mentioned factors, we believe that the ALL of $29.2 million and $27.1 million is adequate to cover probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. However, it is likely that future adjustments to the ALL will be necessary and any changes to the assumptions, circumstances or estimates used in determining the ALL could adversely affect the Company's results of operations, liquidity or financial condition.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

58


 

Table of Contents

The following schedule presents, by class stratification, the changes in the ALL during the periods listed.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As of and for the years ended

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

December 31, 2014

 

 

ASC

    

Non

    

 

 

    

ASC

    

Non

    

 

 

    

ASC

    

Non

    

 

 

 

 

310-30

 

310-30

 

 

 

 

310-30

 

310-30

 

 

 

 

310-30

 

310-30

 

 

 

 

 

loans

 

loans

 

Total

 

loans

 

loans

 

Total

 

loans

 

loans

 

Total

Beginning allowance for loan losses

 

$

1,077

 

$

26,042

 

$

27,119

 

$

721

 

$

16,892

 

$

17,613

 

$

1,280

 

$

11,241

 

$

12,521

Charge-offs:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

 

 —

 

 

(20,684)

 

 

(20,684)

 

 

 —

 

 

(1,911)

 

 

(1,911)

 

 

(3)

 

 

(507)

 

 

(510)

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

(41)

 

 

(280)

 

 

(321)

 

 

 —

 

 

(222)

 

 

(222)

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Residential real estate

 

 

 —

 

 

(408)

 

 

(408)

 

 

 —

 

 

(208)

 

 

(208)

 

 

 —

 

 

(739)

 

 

(739)

Consumer

 

 

(6)

 

 

(771)

 

 

(777)

 

 

(10)

 

 

(1,196)

 

 

(1,206)

 

 

(36)

 

 

(783)

 

 

(819)

Total charge-offs

 

 

(47)

 

 

(22,143)

 

 

(22,190)

 

 

(10)

 

 

(3,537)

 

 

(3,547)

 

 

(39)

 

 

(2,029)

 

 

(2,068)

Recoveries

 

 

 —

 

 

594

 

 

594

 

 

 —

 

 

609

 

 

609

 

 

 —

 

 

951

 

 

951

Net charge-offs

 

 

(47)

 

 

(21,549)

 

 

(21,596)

 

 

(10)

 

 

(2,928)

 

 

(2,938)

 

 

(39)

 

 

(1,078)

 

 

(1,117)

(Recoupment) provision for loan loss

 

 

(805)

 

 

24,456

 

 

23,651

 

 

366

 

 

12,078

 

 

12,444

 

 

(520)

 

 

6,729

 

 

6,209

Ending allowance for loan losses

 

$

225

 

$

28,949

 

$

29,174

 

$

1,077

 

$

26,042

 

$

27,119

 

$

721

 

$

16,892

 

$

17,613

Ratio of annualized net charge-offs to average total loans during the period, respectively

 

 

0.03%

 

 

0.85%

 

 

0.80%

 

 

0.01%

 

 

0.36%

 

 

0.12%

 

 

0.01%

 

 

0.06%

 

 

0.05%

Ratio of ALL to total loans outstanding at period end, respectively

 

 

0.15%

 

 

1.07%

 

 

1.02%

 

 

0.53%

 

 

1.09%

 

 

1.05%

 

 

0.26%

 

 

0.90%

 

 

0.81%

Ratio of ALL to total non-performing loans at period end, respectively

 

 

0.00%

 

 

94.24%

 

 

94.98%

 

 

0.00%

 

 

101.54%

 

 

105.74%

 

 

0.00%

 

 

156.22%

 

 

162.89%

Total loans

 

$

145,852

 

$

2,715,069

 

$

2,860,921

 

$

202,830

 

$

2,384,843

 

$

2,587,673

 

$

279,645

 

$

1,882,764

 

$

2,162,409

Average total loans outstanding during the period

 

$

170,330

 

$

2,530,464

 

$

2,700,794

 

$

209,268

 

$

2,323,527

 

$

2,532,795

 

$

361,806

 

$

1,688,197

 

$

2,050,003

Non-performing loans

 

$

 —

 

$

30,717

 

$

30,717

 

$

 —

 

$

25,647

 

$

25,647

 

$

 —

 

$

10,813

 

$

10,813

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As of and for the years ended

 

 

December 31, 2013

 

December 31, 2012

 

 

 

ASC

    

 

Non

    

 

 

    

 

ASC

    

 

Non

    

 

 

 

 

 

310-30

 

 

310-30

 

 

 

 

 

310-30

 

 

310-30

 

 

 

 

 

 

loans

    

 

loans

    

 

Total

    

 

loans

    

 

loans

    

 

Total

Beginning allowance for loan losses

 

$

4,652

 

$

10,728

 

$

15,380

 

$

2,188

 

$

9,339

 

$

11,527

Charge-offs:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

 

(717)

 

 

(1,654)

 

 

(2,371)

 

 

(360)

 

 

(3,149)

 

 

(3,509)

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

(2,801)

 

 

(943)

 

 

(3,744)

 

 

(15,578)

 

 

(2,605)

 

 

(18,183)

Residential real estate

 

 

(623)

 

 

(882)

 

 

(1,505)

 

 

(872)

 

 

(1,132)

 

 

(2,004)

Consumer

 

 

 —

 

 

(1,001)

 

 

(1,001)

 

 

(19)

 

 

(1,502)

 

 

(1,521)

Total charge-offs

 

 

(4,141)

 

 

(4,480)

 

 

(8,621)

 

 

(16,829)

 

 

(8,387)

 

 

(25,216)

Recoveries

 

 

 —

 

 

1,466

 

 

1,466

 

 

275

 

 

799

 

 

1,074

Net charge-offs

 

 

(4,141)

 

 

(3,014)

 

 

(7,155)

 

 

(16,554)

 

 

(7,588)

 

 

(24,142)

Provision for loan loss

 

 

769

 

 

3,527

 

 

4,296

 

 

19,018

 

 

8,977

 

 

27,995

Ending allowance for loan losses

 

$

1,280

 

$

11,241

 

$

12,521

 

$

4,652

 

$

10,728

 

$

15,380

Ratio of annualized net charge-offs to average total loans during the period, respectively

 

 

0.67%

 

 

0.27%

 

 

0.41%

 

 

1.56%

 

 

0.79%

 

 

1.20%

Ratio of ALL to total loans outstanding at period end, respectively

 

 

0.28%

 

 

0.80%

 

 

0.68%

 

 

0.57%

 

 

1.06%

 

 

0.84%

Ratio of ALL to total non-performing loans at period end, respectively

 

 

8.63%

 

 

118.11%

 

 

51.43%

 

 

0.00%

 

 

46.40%

 

 

66.53%

Total loans

 

$

450,880

 

$

1,403,214

 

$

1,854,094

 

$

822,021

 

$

1,010,681

 

$

1,832,702

Average total loans outstanding during the period

 

$

620,709

 

$

1,128,545

 

$

1,749,254

 

$

1,058,092

 

$

962,147

 

$

2,020,239

Non-performing loans

 

$

14,827

 

$

9,517

 

$

24,344

 

$

 —

 

$

23,119

 

$

23,119

 

 

 

 

59


 

Table of Contents

The following table presents the allocation of the ALL and the percentage of the total amount of loans in each loan category listed as of the dates presented:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ALL as a %

 

    

Total loans

 

    

% of total loans

    

Related ALL

    

of total ALL

Commercial

 

$

1,560,430

 

 

54.6%

 

$

18,821

 

64.6%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

526,792

 

 

18.4%

 

 

5,642

 

19.3%

Residential real estate

 

 

744,885

 

 

26.0%

 

 

4,387

 

15.0%

Consumer

 

 

28,814

 

 

1.0%

 

 

324

 

1.1%

Total

 

$

2,860,921

 

 

100.0%

 

$

29,174

 

100.0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ALL as a %

 

    

Total loans

 

    

% of total loans

    

Related ALL

    

of total ALL

Commercial

 

$

1,427,420

 

 

55.2%

 

$

17,261

 

63.6%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

442,885

 

 

17.1%

 

 

4,166

 

15.4%

Residential real estate

 

 

684,002

 

 

26.4%

 

 

5,281

 

19.5%

Consumer

 

 

33,366

 

 

1.3%

 

 

411

 

1.5%

Total

 

$

2,587,673

 

 

100.0%

 

$

27,119

 

100.0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2014

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ALL as a %

 

    

Total loans

 

    

% of total loans

    

Related ALL

    

of total ALL

Commercial

 

$

1,092,885

 

 

50.6%

 

$

10,384

 

59.0%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

401,636

 

 

18.6%

 

 

3,042

 

17.3%

Residential real estate

 

 

632,700

 

 

29.2%

 

 

3,771

 

21.4%

Consumer

 

 

35,188

 

 

1.6%

 

 

416

 

2.4%

Total

 

$

2,162,409

 

 

100.0%

 

$

17,613

 

100.0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2013

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ALL as a %

 

    

Total loans

 

    

% of total loans

    

Related ALL

    

of total ALL

Commercial

 

$

794,023

 

 

42.9%

 

$

6,005

 

48.0%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

423,644

 

 

22.8%

 

 

1,766

 

14.1%

Residential real estate

 

 

599,924

 

 

32.3%

 

 

4,259

 

34.0%

Consumer

 

 

36,503

 

 

2.0%

 

 

491

 

3.9%

Total

 

$

1,854,094

 

 

100.0%

 

$

12,521

 

100.0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2012

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ALL as a %

 

    

Total loans

 

    

% of total loans

    

Related ALL

    

of total ALL

Commercial

 

$

618,371

 

 

33.7%

 

$

3,975

 

25.8%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

630,623

 

 

34.4%

 

 

6,811

 

44.3%

Residential real estate

 

 

533,377

 

 

29.1%

 

 

4,011

 

26.1%

Consumer

 

 

50,331

 

 

2.7%

 

 

583

 

3.8%

Total

 

$

1,832,702

 

 

100.0%

 

$

15,380

 

100.0%

 

The ALL allocated to commercial loans increased $1.6 million to 64.6% of total ALL at December 31, 2016, from 63.6% at December 31, 2015, primarily due to loan growth. Within the commercial ALL, the non 310-30 energy sector ALL was $3.6 million at December 31, 2016, representing a decrease of $0.2 million compared to December 31, 2015. The decrease was driven by net charge-offs of $19.1 million in the energy sector mostly offset by an energy sector provision for loan losses of $18.9 million recognized in 2016. The ALL allocated to commercial real estate non-owner occupied increased to 19.3% of the total ALL primarily due to net loan growth. The residential real estate ALL decreased $0.9 million during 2016 due to improved credit trends within the portfolio and improvements within the real estate market.

60


 

Table of Contents

Other Assets

 

Significant components of other assets were as follows as of the periods indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Increase (decrease)

 

    

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

 

Amount

 

% Change

Bank-owned life insurance

 

$

62,516

 

$

50,311

 

$

12,205

 

24.3%

Deferred tax asset

 

 

52,810

 

 

52,633

 

 

177

 

0.3%

Accrued income taxes receivable

 

 

5,252

 

 

9,427

 

 

(4,175)

 

(44.3)%

Minority interest in participated other real estate owned

 

 

1,578

 

 

5,450

 

 

(3,872)

 

(71.0)%

Accrued interest on loans

 

 

10,020

 

 

8,827

 

 

1,193

 

13.5%

Accrued interest on interest bearing bank deposits and investment securities

 

 

2,542

 

 

3,363

 

 

(821)

 

(24.4)%

Derivative asset

 

 

11,715

 

 

2,347

 

 

9,368

 

399.1%

Other miscellaneous assets

 

 

8,345

 

 

8,358

 

 

(13)

 

(0.2)%

Total other assets

 

$

154,778

 

$

140,716

 

$

14,062

 

10.0%

 

Other assets totaled $154.8 million and $140.7 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively, representing an increase of $14.1 million, or 10.0%, year-over-year. The increase was largely driven by $10.3 million of bank-owned life insurance purchased during the second quarter of 2016 and a $9.4 million increase in derivative assets, further discussed in note 20 of our consolidated financial statements. These increases were mostly offset by a $4.2 million decrease in accrued income taxes receivable, further discussed in note 19 of our consolidated financial statements, and a $3.9 million decrease in minority interest in participated other real estate owned, due to a property sale during the first quarter of 2016.

 

Other Liabilities

 

Significant components of other liabilities were as follows as of the dates indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Increase (decrease)

 

    

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

 

Amount

 

% Change

Accrued expenses

 

$

13,040

 

$

15,493

 

$

(2,453)

 

(15.8)%

Pending loan purchase settlement

 

 

5,063

 

 

9,936

 

 

(4,873)

 

(49.0)%

Accrued interest payable

 

 

4,973

 

 

4,319

 

 

654

 

15.1%

Derivative liability

 

 

3,466

 

 

8,315

 

 

(4,849)

 

(58.3)%

Other miscellaneous liabilities

 

 

10,990

 

 

11,101

 

 

(111)

 

(1.0)%

Total other liabilities

 

$

37,532

 

$

49,164

 

$

(11,632)

 

(23.7)%

 

Other liabilities totaled $37.5 million and $49.2 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively, representing a decrease of $11.6 million, or 23.7%, year-over-year. The decrease was largely driven by reduced derivative liabilities, further discussed in note 20 of our consolidated financial statements, a decrease in pending loan purchase settlement due to timing of loan settlements, and a decrease in accrued expenses. The decrease in accrued expenses was driven by a combined $2.4 million in severance accruals and banking center consolidation accruals at December 31, 2015.

 

61


 

Table of Contents

Deposits

 

Deposits from banking clients serve as a primary funding source for our banking operations and our ability to gather and manage deposit levels is critical to our success. Deposits not only provide a low-cost funding source for our loans, but also provide a foundation for the client relationships that are critical to future loan growth. The following table presents information regarding our deposit composition at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Increase (decrease)

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

Amount

 

% Change

Non-interest bearing demand deposits

    

$

846,744

 

21.9%

 

$

815,054

 

21.2%

 

$

31,690

    

3.9%

Interest bearing demand deposits

 

 

427,538

 

11.1%

 

 

436,745

 

11.4%

 

 

(9,207)

 

(2.1)%

Savings accounts

 

 

376,046

 

9.7%

 

 

357,505

 

9.3%

 

 

18,541

 

5.2%

Money market accounts

 

 

1,046,275

 

27.0%

 

 

1,037,490

 

27.0%

 

 

8,785

 

0.8%

Total transaction deposits

 

 

2,696,603

 

69.7%

 

 

2,646,794

 

68.9%

 

 

49,809

 

1.9%

Time deposits < $100,000

 

 

704,673

 

18.2%

 

 

762,038

 

19.8%

 

 

(57,365)

 

(7.5)%

Time deposits > $100,000

 

 

467,373

 

12.1%

 

 

431,845

 

11.3%

 

 

35,528

 

8.2%

Total time deposits

 

 

1,172,046

 

30.3%

 

 

1,193,883

 

31.1%

 

 

(21,837)

 

(1.8)%

Total deposits

 

$

3,868,649

 

100.0%

 

 

3,840,677

 

100.0%

 

$

27,972

 

0.7%

 

At December 31, 2016, deposits totaling $103.0 million were held-for-sale, including $51.6 million of time deposits.

 

The following table shows scheduled maturities of certificates of deposit with denominations greater than or equal to $100,000 as of December 31, 2016:

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

December 31, 2016

Three months or less

 

$

73,050

Over 3 months through 6 months

 

 

79,051

Over 6 months through 12 months

 

 

152,391

Thereafter

 

 

162,881

Total time deposits > $100,000

 

$

467,373

 

During 2016, our total deposits increased $28.0 million, or 0.7%. Non-interest bearing demand deposits increased $31.7 million, or 3.9%, from December 31, 2015, while time deposits decreased $21.8 million, or 1.8%, from December 31, 2015. As a result, the mix of transaction deposits to total deposits improved to 69.7% at December 31, 2016, from 68.9% at December 31, 2015 as we continued to focus our deposit base on clients who were interested in market-rate time deposits and in developing a long-term banking relationship. At December 31, 2016 and 2015, we had $788.8 million and $807.2 million, respectively, of time deposits that were scheduled to mature within 12 months. Of the $788.8 million in time deposits scheduled to mature within 12 months at December 31, 2016, $304.5 million were in denominations of $100,000 or more, and $484.3 million were in denominations less than $100,000. Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements provides a maturity schedule and weighted average rates of time deposits outstanding at December 31, 2016 and 2015.

 

62


 

Table of Contents

Regulatory Capital

 

Our subsidiary bank and the holding company are subject to the regulatory capital adequacy requirements of the Federal Reserve Board and the FDIC, as applicable. Failure to meet the minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly further discretionary actions by regulators that could have a material adverse effect on us. At December 31, 2016 and 2015, our subsidiary bank and the consolidated holding company exceeded all capital ratio requirements under prompt corrective action and other regulatory requirements, as further detailed in note 13 of our consolidated financial statements.

 

Results of Operations

 

Our net income depends largely on net interest income, which is the difference between interest income from interest earning assets and interest expense on interest bearing liabilities. Our results of operations are also affected by provisions for loan losses and non-interest income, such as service charges, bank card income, swap fee income, and gain on sale of mortgages, net. Our primary operating expenses, aside from interest expense, consist of salaries and benefits, occupancy costs, telecommunications data processing expense and intangible asset amortization. Any expenses related to the resolution of problem assets are also included in non-interest expense.

 

Overview of Results of Operations

 

Year ended 2016

 

We recorded net income of $23.1 million, or $0.79 per diluted share, during 2016, compared to net income of $4.9 million, or $0.14 per diluted share, during 2015. Fully taxable equivalent net interest income totaled $149.7 million representing a decrease of $9.9 million from 2015. Lower levels of higher-yielding 310-30 loans and investment portfolio paydowns decreased interest income $22.9 million and were partially offset by a $13.5 million increase in non 310-30 interest income from new loan originations during 2016. The continued resolution of the higher-yielding acquired loan portfolio and lower rates on the originated portfolio led to a 0.11% narrowing of the fully taxable equivalent net interest margin to 3.49% from 3.60% in the prior year. Average earning assets totaled $4.3 billion and decreased $0.2 billion from prior year as decreases in the higher-yielding 310-30 loan portfolio, investment portfolio paydowns and lower cash balances were mostly offset by increases in the originated loan portfolio.

 

Provision for loan loss expense was $23.7 million during 2016, compared to $12.4 million during 2015, an increase of $11.3 million driven by 2016 energy sector provision of $18.9 million. Lower net charge-offs and lower provision attributable to net loan growth partially offset the increase in the energy sector provision in the year-over-year comparison. The non 310-30 allowance for loan losses ended the year at 1.07% of total non 310-30 loans compared to 1.09% at prior year end. Net charge-offs on non 310-30 loans totaled 0.85% for the full year. Excluding energy sector net charge-offs, the 2016 net charge-offs on non 310-30 loans totaled 0.10%, compared to 0.12% in 2015.

 

Non-interest income totaled $40.0 million during 2016, compared to $21.4 million during 2015, increasing $18.6 million. Excluding the net $14.5 million of negative FDIC-related income and bargain purchase gain in the prior year, non-interest income increased $4.1 million, or 11.3%. The increase was driven by growth in bank card fees of $0.5 million on the strength of higher interchange activity, while gain on sale of mortgages, net increased $0.9 million on a higher level of originations. These increases were partially offset by $0.9 million lower service charges due to lower instances of overdrafts and lower OREO-related income of $0.1 million. Other non-interest income increased $3.4 million primarily from a $1.8 million gain on sale of a building, net swap related income increase of $0.7 million and a $0.6 million increase in gain on recoveries of acquired loans. 

Non-interest expense totaled $136.0 million during 2016, representing a decrease of $22.0 million, or 13.9%, from the prior year. The decrease was partially due to lower salaries and benefits of $3.3 million, lower occupancy and equipment of $1.6 million, lower marketing expenses of $1.8 million and lower professional fees of $1.0 million. Telecommunications and data processing expense decreased $5.5 million from the prior year benefiting from the core system conversion. Problem asset workout expenses and gain on sale of OREO improved a combined $4.9 million. Additionally, the prior period included banking center consolidation related expenses of $1.4 million, and warrant liability expense of $0.1 million.

 

63


 

Table of Contents

Years ended 2015 and 2014

 

We recorded net income of $4.9 million, or $0.14 per diluted share, during 2015, compared to net income of $9.2 million, or $0.22 per diluted share, during 2014. Net interest income totaled $156.9 million during 2015 and decreased $13.3 million, or 7.8%, from 2014.  The decrease was primarily driven by lower levels of higher-yielding acquired loans of $124.4 million, or 34.4%. Average interest earning assets remained consistent as increases in the originated loan portfolio offset reductions in the investment portfolio and non-strategic acquired loans. The continued resolution of the higher-yielding acquired non-strategic loan portfolio and higher levels of lower-yielding short-term investments led to a 25 basis point narrowing of the fully taxable equivalent net interest margin to 3.60% from 3.85% in the prior year.

 

Provision for loan loss expense was $12.4 million during 2015, compared to $6.2 million during 2014, representing an increase of $6.2 million. The increase in provision was primarily due to an increase in specific reserves of $5.6 million. The non 310-30 allowance was 1.09% of total non 310-30 loans compared to 0.90% in the prior year, increasing primarily due to the higher specific reserves and an increase in the general allowance as the originated portfolio becomes a larger component of non 310-30 loans. Net charge-offs on non 310-30 loans remained low at only 0.12% during 2015 compared to 0.06% during 2014.

 

Non-interest income was $21.4 million in 2015 compared to a negative $1.7 million in the prior year, representing an increase of $23.1 million. The increase was largely due to $21.1 million higher FDIC related income driven by $7.0 million less indemnification amortization, a $9.2 million increase in other FDIC loss-share income, and a $4.9 million gain on the termination of the FDIC loss-share agreements. Banking related non-interest income totaled $33.0 million during 2015, increasing $2.6 million, or 8.6%, as a result of increases in bank card fees, gain on sale of mortgages, mark-to-market adjustments related to fair value interest rate swaps on fixed-rate term loans, and bank-owned life insurance income, and were partially offset by a decrease in overdraft fees.

Total non-interest expense was $158.0 million in 2015, increasing $8.0 million from prior year. The increase was driven by lower year-over-year OREO gains of $7.0 million, one-time core system conversion-related expenses of $3.0 million, efficiency initiative expenses related to severance accruals and banking center consolidation expense accruals of $2.4 million, change in warrant liability fair value adjustments of $3.1 million primarily due to the change in our stock price, and $2.1 million related to the addition of Pine River. These increases were partially offset by other decreases driven by lower compensation costs, banking center consolidations and successful vendor contract negotiations and a $4.1 million contract termination expense in 2014. One-time non-interest expenses totaled $6.2 million during 2015.

 

Net Interest Income

 

We regularly review net interest income metrics to provide us with indicators of how the various components of net interest income are performing. We regularly review: (i) our loan mix and the yield on loans; (ii) the investment portfolio and the related yields; (iii) our deposit mix and the cost of deposits; and (iv) net interest income simulations for various forecast periods.

 

 

 

The following tables present the components of net interest income for the periods indicated. The tables include: (i) the average daily balances of interest earning assets and interest bearing liabilities; (ii) the average daily balances of non-interest earning assets and non-interest bearing liabilities; (iii) the total amount of interest income earned on interest earning assets on a fully taxable equivalent basis; (iv) the total amount of interest expense incurred on interest bearing liabilities; (v) the resultant average yields and rates; (vi) net interest spread; and (vii) net interest margin, which represents the difference between interest income and interest expense, expressed as a percentage of interest earning assets. The effects of trade-date accounting of investment securities for which the cash had not settled are not considered interest earning assets and are excluded from this presentation for time frames prior to their cash settlement, as are the market value adjustments on the investment securities available-for-sale.

 

64


 

Table of Contents

The table below presents the components of net interest income on a fully taxable equivalent basis for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the year ended 

 

For the year ended 

 

For the year ended

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

December 31, 2014

 

    

Average

    

 

 

    

Average

    

Average

    

 

 

    

Average

    

Average

    

 

 

    

Average

 

 

balance

 

Interest

 

rate

 

balance

 

Interest

 

rate

 

Balance

 

Interest

 

Rate

Interest earning assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ASC 310-30 loans

 

$

170,330

 

$

33,256

 

19.52%

 

$

237,453

 

$

47,255

 

19.90%

 

$

361,806

 

$

60,841

 

16.82%

Non 310-30 loans FTE (1)(2)(3)(4)(5)

 

 

2,545,643

 

 

100,142

 

3.93%

 

 

2,109,152

 

 

86,693

 

4.11%

 

 

1,691,253

 

 

74,565

 

4.41%

Investment securities available-for-sale

 

 

1,035,679

 

 

18,991

 

1.83%

 

 

1,327,245

 

 

26,398

 

1.99%

 

 

1,655,730

 

 

31,887

 

1.93%

Investment securities held-to-maturity

 

 

382,366

 

 

10,674

 

2.79%

 

 

476,924

 

 

11,747

 

2.46%

 

 

588,909

 

 

16,764

 

2.85%

Other securities

 

 

14,975

 

 

748

 

4.99%

 

 

25,865

 

 

1,210

 

4.68%

 

 

25,855

 

 

1,206

 

4.66%

Interest earning deposits and securities purchased under agreements to resell

 

 

141,178

 

 

718

 

0.51%

 

 

262,500

 

 

799

 

0.30%

 

 

123,350

 

 

329

 

0.27%

Total interest earning assets FTE (4)

 

$

4,290,171

 

$

164,529

 

3.84%

 

$

4,439,139

 

$

174,102

 

3.92%

 

$

4,446,903

 

$

185,592

 

4.17%

Cash and due from banks

 

 

63,513

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

59,526

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

57,763

 

 

 

 

 

Other assets

 

 

332,122

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

353,344

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

378,723

 

 

 

 

 

Allowance for loan losses

 

 

(33,853)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(20,939)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(15,460)

 

 

 

 

 

Total assets

 

$

4,651,953

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

4,831,070

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

4,867,929

 

 

 

 

 

Interest bearing liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest bearing demand, savings and money market deposits

 

$

1,865,225

 

$

4,985

 

0.27%

 

$

1,758,965

 

$

4,524

 

0.26%

 

$

1,701,344

 

$

4,323

 

0.25%

Time deposits

 

 

1,177,523

 

 

8,978

 

0.76%

 

 

1,281,171

 

 

9,085

 

0.71%

 

 

1,421,726

 

 

9,797

 

0.69%

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

 

 

109,246

 

 

152

 

0.14%

 

 

197,728

 

 

187

 

0.09%

 

 

99,057

 

 

129

 

0.13%

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

 

 

45,773

 

 

693

 

1.51%

 

 

40,000

 

 

666

 

1.67%

 

 

9,975

 

 

164

 

1.64%

Total interest bearing liabilities

 

$

3,197,767

 

$

14,808

 

0.46%

 

$

3,277,864

 

$

14,462

 

0.44%

 

$

3,232,102

 

$

14,413

 

0.45%

Demand deposits

 

 

818,901

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

782,431

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

700,809

 

 

 

 

 

Other liabilities

 

 

51,587

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

69,299

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

74,327

 

 

 

 

 

Total liabilities

 

 

4,068,255

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,129,594

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,007,238

 

 

 

 

 

Shareholders' equity

 

 

583,698

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

701,476

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

860,691

 

 

 

 

 

Total liabilities and shareholders' equity

 

$

4,651,953

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

4,831,070

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

4,867,929

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income

 

 

 

 

$

149,721

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

159,640

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

171,179

 

 

Interest rate spread FTE (4)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3.38%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3.48%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3.72%

Net interest earning assets

 

$

1,092,404

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

1,161,275

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

1,214,801

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest margin FTE (4)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3.49%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3.60%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3.85%

Ratio of average interest earning assets to average interest bearing liabilities

 

 

134.16%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

135.43%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

137.59%

 

 

 

 

 


 

 

 

(1)

    

Originated loans are net of deferred loan fees, less costs, which are included in interest income over the life of the loan.

(2)

    

Includes originated loans with average balances of $2,368,968, $1,893,792 and $1,421,332, interest income of $85,792, $70,569 and $58,373 and tax equivalent yields of 3.79%, 3.87% and 4.17% for the years ended 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

(3)

    

Non 310-30 loans include loans held-for-sale. Average balances during 2016, 2015 and 2014 were $15,179, $7,097 and $3,056, and interest income was $830, $589 and $267 for the same periods, respectively. Non-accrual and restructured loan balances are included in the average loan balances; however, the forgone interest on non-accrual and restructured loans is not included in the dollar amounts of interest earned.

(4)

    

Presented on a fully taxable equivalent basis using the statutory tax rate of 35%. The taxable equivalent adjustments included above are $4,081, $2,695 and $930 for the years ended 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

(5)

    

Loan fees included in interest income totaled $4,734, $4,253 and $4,172 during 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

 

65


 

Table of Contents

Net interest income totaled $145.6 million, $156.9 million, and $170.2 million for the years ended 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. On a fully taxable equivalent basis, net interest income totaled $149.7 million, $159.6 million and $171.2 million for the years ended 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Lower levels of higher-yielding 310-30 loans and investment portfolio paydowns decreased interest income $22.9 million and were partially offset by a $13.5 million increase in non 310-30 interest income from new loan originations in 2016 compared to 2015. Average earning assets totaled $4.3 billion during 2016 representing a decrease of $0.2 billion from 2015 as decreases in the higher-yielding 310-30 loan portfolio, investment portfolio paydowns and lower cash balances were partially offset by increases in the originated loan portfolio.  The continued resolution of the higher-yielding acquired loan portfolio and lower rates on the originated portfolio led to an 0.11% narrowing of the fully taxable equivalent net interest margin to 3.49% in 2016 from 3.60% in 2015.

 

Net interest income decreased $13.3 million in 2015 compared to 2014 primarily due to lower levels of higher-yielding 310-30 loans. Average earning assets remained consistent from 2014 to 2015 as increases in the originated loan portfolio offset a reduction in the investment portfolio and 310-30 loans. The continued resolution of the higher-yielding acquired loan portfolio and higher levels of lower-yielding short-term investments led to a 0.25% narrowing of the fully taxable equivalent net interest margin to 3.60% in 2015 from 3.85% in 2014.

 

Average loans comprised $2.7 billion, or 63.3%, of total average interest earning assets during 2016, compared to $2.3 billion, or 52.9%, during 2015 and $2.1 billion, or 46.2% during 2014. The continued resolution of the ASC 310-30 loan portfolio was more than offset by loan growth in the non 310-30 portfolio during 2016 and 2015. The yield on the ASC 310-30 loan portfolio was 19.52% during 2016, compared to 19.90% during 2015 and 16.82% during 2014. The decrease in yield during 2016 was driven by the continued resolution of the ASC 310-30 loans. The increase in yield from 2014 to 2015 was attributable to the effects of the favorable life-to-date and 2015 transfers of non-accretable difference to accretable yield that are being accreted to interest income over the remaining life of these loan pools.

 

Average investment securities comprised 33.1% of total interest earning assets during 2016, compared to 40.6% during 2015 and 50.5% during 2014. The decrease in the investment portfolio was a result of scheduled paydowns and reflects the re-mixing of the interest-earning assets as we have utilized the paydowns of the investment portfolio to fund loan originations. Short-term investments, comprised of the interest earning deposits and securities purchased under agreements to resell, decreased to 3.3% of interest earning assets during 2016, compared to 5.8% during 2015 and 2.8% during 2014, primarily due to increased cash from client repurchase agreements on deposit during 2015.

 

Average balances of interest bearing liabilities totaled $3.2 billion during 2016 representing a decrease of $80.1 million from $3.3 billion during 2015, largely driven by a $103.6 million decrease in time deposits and an $88.5 million decrease in securities sold under agreement to repurchase, offset by a $106.3 million increase in interest bearing demand, savings and money market deposits. During 2016, total interest expense related to interest bearing liabilities was $14.8 million, compared to $14.5 million during 2015 and $14.4 million during 2014. Average transaction deposits (defined as total deposits less time deposits) and client repurchase agreements as a percentage of average total deposits and client repurchase agreements totaled 70.3% during 2016 from 68.1% during 2015. The average rate of interest bearing liabilities increased two basis points to 0.46% during 2016 from 0.44% during 2015 due to higher rates on time deposits year-over-year.

 

66


 

Table of Contents

The following table summarizes the changes in net interest income on a taxable equivalent basis by major category of interest earning assets and interest bearing liabilities, identifying changes related to volume and changes related to rate for 2016, 2015 and 2014:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The year ended December 31, 2016

 

The year ended December 31, 2015

 

 

 

compared to

 

compared to

 

 

 

the year ended December 31, 2015

 

the year ended December 31, 2014

 

 

 

Increase (decrease) due to

 

Increase (decrease) due to

 

    

 

Volume

    

Rate

    

Net

    

Volume

    

Rate

    

Net

Interest income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ASC 310-30 loans

 

 

$

(13,105)

 

$

(894)

 

$

(13,999)

 

$

(24,747)

 

$

11,161

 

$

(13,586)

Non 310-30 loans FTE (1)(2)(3)

 

 

 

17,171

 

 

(3,722)

 

 

13,449

 

 

17,177

 

 

(5,049)

 

 

12,128

Investment securities available-for-sale

 

 

 

(5,346)

 

 

(2,061)

 

 

(7,407)

 

 

(6,533)

 

 

1,044

 

 

(5,489)

Investment securities held-to-maturity

 

 

 

(2,640)

 

 

1,567

 

 

(1,073)

 

 

(2,758)

 

 

(2,259)

 

 

(5,017)

Other securities

 

 

 

(544)

 

 

82

 

 

(462)

 

 

 —

 

 

4

 

 

4

Interest earning deposits and securities purchased under agreements to resell

 

 

 

(617)

 

 

536

 

 

(81)

 

 

424

 

 

46

 

 

470

Total interest income

 

 

$

(5,081)

 

$

(4,492)

 

$

(9,573)

 

$

(16,437)

 

$

4,947

 

$

(11,490)

Interest expense:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest bearing demand, savings and money market deposits

 

 

$

284

 

$

177

 

$

461

 

$

148

 

$

53

 

$

201

Time deposits

 

 

 

(790)

 

 

683

 

 

(107)

 

 

(997)

 

 

285

 

 

(712)

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

 

 

 

87

 

 

(60)

 

 

27

 

 

500

 

 

2

 

 

502

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

 

 

 

(123)

 

 

88

 

 

(35)

 

 

93

 

 

(35)

 

 

58

Total interest expense

 

 

 

(542)

 

 

888

 

 

346

 

 

(256)

 

 

305

 

 

49

Net change in net interest income

 

 

$

(4,539)

 

$

(5,380)

 

$

(9,919)

 

$

(16,181)

 

$

4,642

 

$

(11,539)

 

 

 

(1)

    

Originated loans are net of deferred loan fees, less costs, which are included in interest income over the life of the loan.

(2)

    

Non 310-30 loans include loans held-for-sale. Average balances during 2016, 2015 and 2014 were $15,179, $7,097 and $3,056 and interest income was $830, $589 and $267 for the same periods, respectively.

(3)

    

Presented on a fully taxable equivalent basis using the statutory tax rate of 35%.  The taxable equivalent adjustments included above are $4,081, $2,695 and $930 for the years ended 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

 

Below is a breakdown of deposits and the average rates paid during the periods indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the three months ended

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

September 30, 2016

 

June 30, 2016

 

March 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

Average

 

rate

 

Average

 

rate

 

Average

 

Rate

 

Average

 

rate

 

Average

 

rate

 

 

balance

    

paid

 

balance

    

paid

 

balance

    

Paid

 

balance

    

paid

 

balance

    

paid

Non-interest bearing demand

 

$

835,263

    

0.00%

 

$

824,848

    

0.00%

 

$

821,987

    

0.00%

 

$

793,264

    

0.00%

 

$

825,979

    

0.00%

Interest bearing demand

 

 

415,948

 

0.09%

 

 

413,446

 

0.09%

 

 

420,253

 

0.09%

 

 

426,769

 

0.09%

 

 

417,460

 

0.08%

Money market accounts

 

 

1,057,908

 

0.36%

 

 

1,001,658

 

0.33%

 

 

1,169,238

 

0.33%

 

 

1,037,376

 

0.33%

 

 

1,047,072

 

0.33%

Savings accounts

 

 

370,845

 

0.27%

 

 

383,981

 

0.28%

 

 

388,947

 

0.27%

 

 

375,481

 

0.25%

 

 

347,811

 

0.26%

Time deposits

 

 

1,169,325

 

0.80%

 

 

1,174,269

 

0.78%

 

 

1,180,496

 

0.75%

 

 

1,186,126

 

0.72%

 

 

1,222,829

 

0.70%

  Total average deposits

 

$

3,849,289

 

0.38%

 

$

3,798,202

 

0.36%

 

$

3,980,921

 

0.36%

 

$

3,819,016

 

0.35%

 

$

3,861,151

 

0.34%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

67


 

Table of Contents

Provision for Loan Losses

 

The provision for loan losses represents the amount of expense that is necessary to bring the ALL to a level that we deem appropriate to absorb probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio as of the balance sheet date. The ALL is in addition to the remaining purchase accounting marks of $3.2 million on acquired non 310-30 loans that were established at the time of acquisition. The determination of the ALL, and the resultant provision for loan losses, is subjective and involves significant estimates and assumptions. Below is a summary of the provision for loan losses recorded in the consolidated statements of operations for the periods indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 

 

 

2016

    

2015

    

2014

(Recoupment) provision for impairment loans accounted for under ASC 310-30

 

$

(805)

 

$

366

 

$

(520)

Provision for loan losses

 

 

24,456

 

 

12,078

 

 

6,729

Total provision for loan losses

 

$

23,651

 

$

12,444

 

$

6,209

 

Provision for loan loss expense was $23.7 million during 2016, compared to $12.4 million during 2015, an increase of $11.3 million primarily driven by 2016 energy sector provision of $18.9 million. Lower non-energy net charge-offs and lower provision attributable to net loan growth partially offset the increase in the energy sector provision in the year-over-year comparison. The non 310-30 allowance for loan losses was 1.07% of total non 310-30 loans at December 31, 2016 compared to 1.09% at December 31, 2015. Net charge-offs on non 310-30 loans totaled 0.85%, or excluding energy sector net charge-offs totaled 0.10% compared to net charge-offs of 0.12% in 2015.

 

Provision for loan loss expense was $12.4 million during 2015, compared to $6.2 million during 2014, an increase of $6.2 million. The increase in provision was primarily due to an increase in specific reserves of $5.6 million. The non 310-30 allowance for loan losses was 1.09% of total non 310-30 loans at December 31, 2015 compared to 0.90% at December 31, 2014, increasing primarily due to the higher specific reserves and an increase in the general allowance as the originated portfolio becomes a larger component of non 310-30 loans. Net charge-offs on non 310-30 loans remained low at only 0.12% during 2015 compared to 0.06% during 2014.

 

During 2016, 2015 and 2014 we recorded recoupments of $805 thousand, provision of $366 thousand and recoupments of $520 thousand, respectively, for loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 in connection with our re-measurements of expected cash flows. The decreases in expected future cash flows are reflected immediately in our financial statements through increased provisions for loan losses. Increases in expected future cash flows are reflected through an increase in accretable yield that is accreted to income in future periods once any previously recorded provision expense has been reversed.  

 

68


 

Table of Contents

Non-Interest Income

 

The table below details the components of non-interest income during 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 

 

2016 vs 2015

 

2015 vs 2014

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Increase (decrease)

 

Increase (decrease)

 

2016

    

2015

    

2014

 

Amount

 

% Change

 

Amount

 

% Change

Service charges

$

13,900

 

$

14,798

 

$

15,430

 

$

(898)

 

(6.1)%

 

$

(632)

 

(4.1)%

Bank card fees

 

11,429

 

 

10,898

 

 

10,123

 

 

531

 

4.9%

 

 

775

 

7.7%

Gain on sale of mortgages, net

 

2,881

 

 

1,963

 

 

1,000

 

 

918

 

46.8%

 

 

963

 

96.3%

Bank-owned life insurance income

 

1,861

 

 

1,614

 

 

442

 

 

247

 

15.3%

 

 

1,172

 

265.2%

Other non-interest income

 

7,708

 

 

4,301

 

 

4,105

 

 

3,407

 

79.2%

 

 

196

 

4.8%

OREO related write-ups and other income

 

2,248

 

 

2,379

 

 

3,807

 

 

(131)

 

(5.5)%

 

 

(1,428)

 

(37.5)%

Bargain purchase gain

 

 —

 

 

1,048

 

 

 —

 

 

(1,048)

 

(100.0)%

 

 

1,048

 

100.0%

FDIC loss-sharing related

 

 —

 

 

(15,553)

 

 

(36,603)

 

 

15,553

 

(100.0)%

 

 

21,050

 

(57.5)%

Total non-interest income

$

40,027

 

$

21,448

 

$

(1,696)

 

$

18,579

 

86.6%

 

$

23,144

 

(1,364.6)%

 

Non-interest income totaled $40.0 million, $21.4 million and $(1.7) million during 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The year-over-year increases were largely driven by negative FDIC loss-sharing income during 2015 and 2014. FDIC loss-sharing related represents the income (expense) recognized in connection with the actual reimbursement of costs/recoveries related to the resolution of covered assets by the FDIC.

 

Service charges, which represent various fees charged to clients for banking services, including fees such as non-sufficient (“NSF”) charges and service charges on deposit accounts, decreased $0.9 million, or 6.1%, during 2016 compared to $0.6 million, or 4.1%, during 2015, largely due to declines in overdraft charges. Bank card fees increased 4.9% and 7.7% from 2016 to 2015 and 2015 to 2014, respectively, and are comprised primarily of interchange fees on the debit cards that we have issued to our clients.

 

Gain on sale of mortgages, net represents gains of mortgage loans held-for-sale and mark-to-market adjustments on mortgage banking derivatives. Gain on sale of mortgages, net increased $0.9 million from 2015 and $1.0 million from 2014 to 2015 due to a higher level of originations.

 

OREO related write-ups and other income include rental income and insurance proceeds received on OREO properties and write-ups to the fair-value of collateral that exceed the loan balance at the time of foreclosure. During 2016, 2015 and 2014, this income totaled $2.2 million, $2.4 million, and $3.8 million, respectively. OREO rental income was higher during 2016 compared to 2015, but was more than offset by higher write-ups of $1.2 million during 2015 for one OREO property. Lower OREO rental income in 2015 was a result of property sales during 2015.

 

Other non-interest income increased $3.4 million during 2016, or 79.2%, largely due to a $1.8 million gain on sale of a building during the second quarter of 2016, net swap related income increase of $0.7 million and a $0.6 increase in gain on recoveries of acquired loans.

 

During 2015, the Company realized a bargain purchase gain of $1.0 million resulting from the acquisition of Pine River.

 

69


 

Table of Contents

Non-Interest Expense

 

The table below details non-interest expense for the periods presented:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31,

 

2016 vs 2015

 

2015 vs 2014

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Increase (decrease)

 

Increase (decrease)

 

2016

    

2015

    

2014

 

Amount

 

% Change

 

Amount

 

% Change

Salaries and benefits

$

79,765

 

$

83,018

 

$

82,834

 

$

(3,253)

 

3.9%

 

$

184

 

0.2%

Occupancy and equipment

 

22,904

 

 

24,490

 

 

25,101

 

 

(1,586)

 

6.5%

 

 

(611)

 

2.4%

Telecommunications and data processing

 

5,970

 

 

11,507

 

 

11,927

 

 

(5,537)

 

48.1%

 

 

(420)

 

3.5%

Marketing and business development

 

2,564

 

 

4,325

 

 

4,571

 

 

(1,761)

 

40.7%

 

 

(246)

 

5.4%

FDIC deposit insurance

 

3,236

 

 

3,922

 

 

4,130

 

 

(686)

 

17.5%

 

 

(208)

 

5.0%

Bank card expenses

 

4,440

 

 

3,701

 

 

3,079

 

 

739

 

20.0%

 

 

622

 

20.2%

Professional fees

 

3,496

 

 

4,495

 

 

3,257

 

 

(999)

 

22.2%

 

 

1,238

 

38.0%

Other non-interest expense

 

8,554

 

 

11,107

 

 

14,581

 

 

(2,553)

 

23.0%

 

 

(3,474)

 

23.8%

Problem asset workout

 

3,983

 

 

7,317

 

 

11,258

 

 

(3,334)

 

45.6%

 

 

(3,941)

 

35.0%

Gain on OREO sales, net

 

(4,383)

 

 

(2,776)

 

 

(13,126)

 

 

(1,607)

 

57.9%

 

 

10,350

 

78.9%

Intangible asset amortization

 

5,480

 

 

5,401

 

 

5,344

 

 

79

 

1.5%

 

 

57

 

1.1%

Loss (gain) from the change in fair value of warrant liability

 

 —

 

 

106

 

 

(2,953)

 

 

(106)

 

100.0%

 

 

3,059

 

103.6%

Banking center consolidation related expenses

 

 —

 

 

1,411

 

 

 —

 

 

(1,411)

 

100.0%

 

 

1,411

 

100.0%

Total non-interest expense

$

136,009

 

$

158,024

 

$

150,003

 

$

(22,015)

 

13.9%

 

$

8,021

 

5.3%

 

Non-interest expense totaled $136.0 million, $158.0 million and $150.0 million during 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Salaries and benefits is the largest component of non-interest expense totaling $79.8 million in 2016, representing a decrease of $3.3 million from 2015 due to lower staffing levels and decreases in stock compensation expense. Salaries and benefits were consistent between 2015 and 2014 as reduced health plan costs and lower incentive payments absorbed normal merit increases.

 

Occupancy and equipment expense decreased to $22.9 million in 2016 from $24.5 million and $25.1 million in 2015 and 2014, respectively. The decrease was primarily due to decreases in depreciation expense and benefits realized from successful vendor contract negotiations during 2015.

 

Telecommunications and data processing expense decreased to $6.0 million in 2016 from $11.5 million and $11.9 million in 2015 and 2014, respectively, benefitting from the core system conversion and favorable vendor contract negotiations during 2015.

 

  Marketing and business development expense decreased to $2.6 million in 2016 from $4.3 million and $4.6 million in 2015 and 2014, respectively, due to reduced levels of marketing campaigns in 2016.

 

Professional fees totaled $3.5 million, $4.5 million and $3.3 million during 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The increase in 2015 was partially due to one-time core system conversion related expenses completed during the fourth quarter of 2015.

 

Bank card expenses increased $0.7 million and $0.6 million during 2016 and 2015. The increase during 2016 was due to the issuance of bank cards with chip reader technology. The increase during 2015 was due to conversion costs related to a change in our third party vendor.

 

 

Problem asset workout expense is incurred in connection with the resolution process of our acquired problem loan portfolios and OREO expenses. During 2016, problem asset workout expense and gain on sale of OREO improved a combined $4.9 million, due to the sale of several larger assets during 2016. During 2015, problem asset workout expenses and gain on sale of OREO increased a combined $6.4 million due to lower year-over-year OREO gains. 

 

70


 

Table of Contents

The warrant agreements were amended during 2015 resulting in a reclassification from a liability to equity; therefore, the warrant agreements had no effect on non-interest expense in 2016. The year-over-year change from 2014 to 2015 was primarily due to the change in our stock price.

 

Other non-interest expense decreased $2.6 million and $3.5 million during 2016 and 2015, respectively. The decrease during 2016 was largely due to decreases in unfunded commitment reserves of $1.4 million and other net decreases of $1.2 million. The decrease during 2015 was largely due to contract termination expenses of $4.1 million in 2014, partially offset by other net increases of $0.6 million during 2015.

 

During 2016, the Company entered into definitive agreements for the sale of four banking centers expected to close during the second quarter of 2017. The sale includes buildings with an estimated fair value of $1.6 million, loans carried at $14.4 million and deposits carried at $103.0 million at December 31, 2016. The Company determined the buildings, loans and deposits are held-for-sale at December 31, 2016, and are included within property and equipment, loans receivable and deposits, respectively. The Company estimates it will realize a $3.0 million gain during the second quarter of 2017 as a result of these sales. Additionally, the Company will consolidate one banking center within the Community Banks of Colorado footprint during the first quarter of 2017.

 

During 2015 and 2016, the Company consolidated twelve banking centers in our Bank Midwest and Community Banks of Colorado footprint. The payback period on the consolidations is expected to be less than two years. Eight of the banking centers were owned and classified as held-for-sale, resulting in a fair value impairment charge of $1.1 million during the second quarter of 2015 and a fair value impairment charge of $0.3 million during the fourth quarter of 2015.

 

Income taxes

 

Income taxes are accounted for in accordance with ASC Topic 740, Income Taxes . Under this guidance, deferred income taxes are determined based on the estimated future tax effects of differences between the financial statement and tax basis of assets and liabilities given the provisions of enacted tax laws. ASC Topic 740 requires the establishment of a valuation allowance against the net deferred tax asset unless it is more-likely-than-not that the tax benefit of the deferred tax asset will be realized. For purposes of projecting whether the deferred tax asset will be realized, we consider tax regulations of the jurisdictions in which we operate, estimates of future taxable income, and available tax planning strategies. If tax regulations, operating results, or the ability to implement tax planning strategies varies, adjustments to the carrying value of the deferred tax assets may be required.  We believe that it is more likely than not that the results of future operations will generate sufficient taxable income to realize the deferred tax assets.

 

Certain of the Company’s stock-based compensation awards have market-based vesting/exercisability criteria. For restricted stock with market-based vesting, the target share prices of the Company's stock that is required for vesting range from $32.00 to $34.00 per share. The strike prices for options range from $18.09 to $23.75, with a large portion of the awards having strike prices of $20.00. Depending on the movement in our stock price, these stock-based compensation awards may create either an excess tax benefit or tax deficiency depending on the relationship between the fair value at the time of vesting or exercise and the estimated fair value recorded at the time of grant. The Company adopted ASU 2016-09 effective January 1, 2016, which results in recording the excess tax benefit or tax deficiency as a tax benefit or expense in the consolidated statements of operations. During 2016, we recorded an excess tax benefit of $2.1 million in income tax expense in the consolidated statements of operations related to the settlement of certain awards during the period. During 2015, we recorded a tax deficiency of $3.7 million income tax expense resulting from expired or exercised awards. As of December 31, 2016, we had $7.4 million of deferred tax assets related to stock-based compensation, $5.6 million of which is associated with executive officers still employed by the Company.

 

ASC Topic 740 also requires the projected realization of tax benefits related to uncertain tax positions to be evaluated based upon the likelihood of successfully defending those positions. For tax positions meeting the more likely than not threshold, the amount recognized in the financial statements is the largest benefit that has greater than 50 percent likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement with the relevant tax authority. Interest and penalties on uncertain tax positions are recognized as a component of other non-interest expense. If our assessment of whether a tax position meets or no longer meets the more likely than not threshold were to change, adjustments to income tax benefits may be required. As of December 31, 2016 and 2015, we have not identified any uncertain tax positions.

71


 

Table of Contents

 

Income tax expense totaled $3.0 million for 2016, as compared to $3.0 million for 2015, and $3.2 million for 2014. These amounts equate to effective tax rates of 11.3%, 38.4% and 25.6% for the respective periods.

 

The effective tax rate for 2016 was 11.3% and includes a $2.1 million benefit related to the early adoption of ASU 2016-09. Prior to this adoption, the realized tax benefit from stock compensation awards vested would have been recorded directly to capital. Without this $2.1 million benefit, tax expense would have been $5.1 million, an effective tax rate of 19.7%. The effective tax rate for 2015 was 38.4% and included $3.7 million of non-cash deferred tax asset write-offs in connection with former executive stock-based compensation agreements. Without this $3.7 million charge, we would have recorded a tax benefit resulting from the increased tax-exempt income sources compared to pre-tax income in 2015. When the impacts of the 2016 tax benefit and 2015 tax deficiency are removed, the tax rate in 2016 is higher than 2015 due to the increase in pre-tax income year-over-year. The difference in the 2016 effective tax rate compared to the statutory tax rate is primarily due to interest income from tax-exempt lending, bank-owned life insurance income, and the relationship of these items to pre-tax income.

 

The increase in the effective tax rate for 2015 compared to 2014 was primarily due to the aforementioned $3.7 million of non-cash deferred tax asset write-offs during 2015. Without this $3.7 million charge, we would have recorded a tax benefit resulting from the increased tax-exempt income sources compared to pre-tax income. The effective tax rate, without the non-cash deferred tax asset write-off, is lower than 2014 due to the increased tax-exempt income sources compared to pre-tax income in each period.

 

Our marginal tax rate (the rate we pay on each incremental dollar of earnings) is approximately 38%. However, our effective tax rate (income tax expense divided by income before income taxes) for a given period is driven largely by income and expense items that are non-taxable or non-deductible in the calculation of income tax expense.

 

Liquidity and Capital Resources

 

Liquidity is monitored and managed to ensure that sufficient funds are available to operate our business and pay our obligations to depositors and other creditors, while providing ample available funds for opportunistic and strategic investments. On-balance sheet liquidity is represented by our cash and cash equivalents and unencumbered investment securities, and is detailed in the table below as of December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

Cash and due from banks

 

$

152,736

 

$

155,985

Interest bearing bank deposits

 

 

 —

 

 

10,107

Unencumbered investment securities, at fair value

 

 

843,061

 

 

1,093,517

Total

 

$

995,797

 

$

1,259,609

 

Total on-balance sheet liquidity decreased $263.8 million from December 31, 2015 to December 31, 2016. The decrease was largely due to a planned reduction of $250.5 million in unencumbered available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities balances.

 

Our primary sources of funds are deposits, securities sold under agreements to repurchase, prepayments and maturities of loans and investment securities, the sale of investment securities, and funds provided from operations. We are also a party to a master repurchase agreement with a large financial institution and we anticipate that, through this agreement, we would have access to a significant amount of liquidity. We anticipate having access to other third party funding sources, including the ability to raise funds through the issuance of shares of our common stock or other equity or equity-related securities, incurrence of debt, and federal funds purchased, that may also be a source of liquidity. We anticipate that these sources of liquidity will provide adequate funding and liquidity for at least a 12-month period.

 

Our primary uses of funds are loan originations, investment security purchases, withdrawals of deposits, settlement of repurchase agreements, capital expenditures, operating expenses, and share repurchases. For additional information regarding our operating, investing and financing cash flows, see our consolidated statements of cash flows in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.

72


 

Table of Contents

 

Exclusive from the investing activities related to acquisitions, our primary investing activities are originations and pay-offs and pay downs of loans and purchases and sales of investment securities. At December 31, 2016, pledgeable investment securities represented our largest source of liquidity. Our available-for-sale investment securities are carried at fair value and our held-to-maturity securities are carried at amortized cost. Our collective investment securities portfolio totaled $1.2 billion at December 31, 2016, inclusive of pre-tax net unrealized losses of $10.5 million on the available-for-sale securities portfolio. Additionally, our held-to-maturity securities portfolio had $0.1 million of pre-tax net unrealized gains at December 31, 2016. The gross unrealized gains and losses are detailed in note 4 of our consolidated financial statements. As of December 31, 2016, our investment securities portfolio consisted primarily of mortgage-backed securities, all of which were issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises. The anticipated repayments and marketability of these securities offer substantial resources and flexibility to meet new loan demand, reinvest in the investment securities portfolio, or provide optionality for reductions in our deposit funding base.

 

At present, financing activities primarily consist of changes in deposits and repurchase agreements, and advances from the FHLB, in addition to the payment of dividends and the repurchase of our common stock. Maturing time deposits represent a potential use of funds. As of December 31, 2016, $788.8 million of time deposits were scheduled to mature within 12 months. Based on the current interest rate environment, market conditions, and our consumer banking strategy focusing on both lower cost transaction accounts and term deposits, our strategy is to replace a significant portion of those maturing time deposits with transaction deposits and market-rate time deposits.

 

As of December 31, 2016, we were a member of the FHLB of Topeka. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, we were a member of the FHLB of Des Moines. Through these relationships, we have pledged qualifying loans and investments securities allowing us to obtain additional liquidity through FHLB advances and lines of credit. FHLB advances and lines of credit available totaled $903.9 million of which $38.7 million was used at December 31, 2016. We can obtain additional liquidity through FHLB advances if required. The bank also has access to federal funds lines of credit with corresponding banks.

 

The new Basel III rules, effective January 1, 2015, changed the components of regulatory capital and changed the way in which risk ratings are assigned to various categories of bank assets. Also, a new Tier I common risk-based ratio was defined. Under the Basel III requirements, at December 31, 2016, the Company met all capital adequacy requirements and had regulatory capital ratios in excess of the levels established for well-capitalized institutions. For more information on regulatory capital, see note 13 in our consolidated financial statements.

 

Our shareholders' equity is impacted by the retention of earnings, changes in unrealized gains and losses on securities, net of tax, stock-based compensation activity, share repurchases and the payment of dividends. The Board of Directors has authorized multiple programs to repurchase shares of the Company’s common stock from time to time either in open market or in privately negotiated transactions in accordance with applicable regulations of the SEC. During 2016, we repurchased 4.5 million shares of our common stock at a weighted average price of $20.78, and all such shares are held as treasury shares. We believe that our repurchases could serve to offset any future share issuances for future acquisitions.

 

On August 5, 2016, the Company announced that its Board of Directors authorized a new program to repurchase up to an additional $50.0 million of the Company’s common stock. The remaining authorization under this program as of December 31, 2016 was $12.6 million.

 

On January 19, 2017, our Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend of $0.07 per common share, payable on March 15, 2017 to shareholders of record at the close of business on February 24, 2017.

 

Asset/Liability Management and Interest Rate Risk 

 

Management and the Board of Directors are responsible for managing interest rate risk and employing risk management policies that monitor and limit this exposure. Interest rate risk is measured using net interest income simulations and market value of portfolio equity analyses. These analyses use various assumptions, including the nature and timing of interest rate changes, yield curve shape, prepayments on loans and securities, deposit decay rates, pricing decisions on loans and deposits, and reinvestment/replacement of asset and liability cash flows.

73


 

Table of Contents

 

The principal objective of the Company's asset and liability management function is to evaluate the interest rate risk within the balance sheet and pursue a controlled assumption of interest rate risk while maximizing earnings and preserving adequate levels of liquidity and capital. The asset and liability management function is under the guidance of the Asset Liability Committee from direction of the Board of Directors. The Asset Liability Committee meets monthly to review, among other things, the sensitivity of the Company's assets and liabilities to interest rate changes, local and national market conditions and rates. The Asset Liability Committee also reviews the liquidity, capital, deposit mix, loan mix and investment positions of the Company.

 

Instantaneous parallel rate shift scenarios are modeled and utilized to evaluate risk and establish exposure limits for acceptable changes in net interest margin. These scenarios, known as rate shocks, simulate an instantaneous change in interest rates and use various assumptions, including, but not limited to, prepayments on loans and securities, deposit decay rates, pricing decisions on loans and deposits, reinvestment and replacement of asset and liability cash flows.

 

We also analyze the economic value of equity as a secondary measure of interest rate risk. This is a complementary measure to net interest income where the calculated value is the result of the market value of assets less the market value of liabilities. The economic value of equity is a longer term view of interest rate risk because it measures the present value of the future cash flows. The impact of changes in interest rates on this calculation is analyzed for the risk to our future earnings and is used in conjunction with the analyses on net interest income.

 

Our interest rate risk model indicated that the Company was asset sensitive in terms of interest rate sensitivity at December 31, 2016. During 2016, we increased our asset sensitivity as a result of the balance sheet mix towards more variable rate assets, even after adjusting our models for the excess capital deployment. The table below illustrates the impact of an immediate and sustained 200 and 100 basis point increase and a 50 basis point decrease in interest rates on net interest income based on the interest rate risk model at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Hypothetical

    

 

 

 

shift in interest

 

% change in projected net interest income

rates (in bps)

 

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

200

 

5.84%

 

5.81%

100

 

3.66%

 

3.13%

(50)

 

(2.49)%

 

(1.33)%

 

Many assumptions are used to calculate the impact of interest rate fluctuations. Actual results may be significantly different than our projections due to several factors, including the timing and frequency of rate changes, market conditions and the shape of the yield curve. The computations of interest rate risk shown above do not include actions that management may undertake to manage the risks in response to anticipated changes in interest rates and actual results may also differ due to any actions taken in response to the changing rates.

 

As part of the asset/liability management strategy to manage primary market risk exposures expected to be in effect in future reporting periods, management has emphasized the origination of shorter duration loans as well as variable rate loans to limit the negative exposure to a rate increase. The strategy with respect to liabilities has been to emphasize transaction accounts, particularly non-interest or low interest bearing non-maturing deposit accounts which are less sensitive to changes in interest rates. In response to this strategy, non-maturing deposit accounts have grown $49.8 million during 2016, and totaled 69.7% of total deposits at December 31, 2016 compared to 68.9% at December 31, 2015. We currently have no brokered time deposits and intend to continue to focus on our strategy of increasing non-interest or low-cost interest bearing non-maturing deposit accounts.

 

74


 

Table of Contents

Off-Balance Sheet Activities

 

In the normal course of business, we are a party to various contractual obligations, commitments and other off-balance sheet activities that contain credit, market, and operational risk that are not required to be reflected in our consolidated financial statements. The most significant of these are the loan commitments that we enter into to meet the financing needs of clients, including commitments to extend credit, commercial and consumer lines of credit and standby letters of credit. As of December 31, 2016 and 2015, we had loan commitments totaling $602.2 million and $627.2 million, respectively, and standby letters of credit that totaled $13.5 million and $9.8 million, respectively. Unused commitments do not necessarily represent future credit exposure or cash requirements, as commitments often expire without being drawn upon. We do not anticipate any material losses arising from commitments or contingent liabilities and we do not believe that there are any material commitments to extend credit that represent risks of an unusual nature. 

 

Contractual Obligations

 

In addition to the financing commitments detailed above under “Off-Balance Sheet Activities,” in the normal course of business, we enter into contractual obligations that require future cash settlement. The following table summarizes the contractual cash obligations as of December 31, 2016 and the expected timing of those payments:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

    

After one but

    

After three but

    

 

    

 

 

 

 

Within

 

within three

 

within five

 

After five

 

 

 

 

 

one year

 

years

 

years

 

years

 

Total

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

 

$

 —

 

$

10,000

 

$

15,000

 

$

 —

 

$

25,000

Operating lease obligations

 

 

3,328

 

 

6,210

 

 

5,969

 

 

15,322

 

 

30,829

Purchase obligations

 

 

6,175

 

 

8,287

 

 

6,811

 

 

3,071

 

 

24,344

Time deposits

 

 

788,781

 

 

321,000

 

 

58,224

 

 

4,041

 

 

1,172,046

Total

 

$

798,284

 

$

345,497

 

$

86,004

 

$

22,434

 

$

1,252,219

 

 

Impact of Inflation and Changing Prices

 

The primary impact of inflation on our operations is reflected in increasing operating costs and is reflected in non-interest expense. Unlike most industrial companies, virtually all of our assets and liabilities are monetary in nature. As a result, changes in interest rates have a more significant impact on our performance than do changes in the general rate of inflation and changes in prices. Interest rate changes do not necessarily move in the same direction, nor have the same magnitude, as changes in the prices of goods and services. Although not as critical to the banking industry as many other industries, inflationary factors may have some impact on our ability to grow, total assets, earnings, and capital levels. We do not expect inflation to be a significant factor in our financial results in the near future.

 

Item 7A.    QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK .

 

The information required by this item is set forth on pages 73-74 of Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.

75


 

Table of Contents

 

Item 8.       FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA .

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM 

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

The Board of Directors and Shareholders
National Bank Holdings Corporation:

We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial condition of National Bank Holdings Corporation and subsidiaries (the Company) as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss), changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three‑year period ended December 31, 2016. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of National Bank Holdings Corporation and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the three‑year period ended December 31, 2016, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), and our report dated February 24, 2017, expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

As discussed in note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company has changed its method of accounting for stock‑based compensation in the consolidated financial statements referred to above due to the adoption of FASB Accounting Standards Update (ASU) No. 2016‑09, Improvements to Employee Share‑Based Payment Accounting .

 

IMAGE - IMAGE2.JPEG

Kansas City, Missouri

February 24, 2017

 

76


 

Table of Contents

NATIONAL BANK HOLDINGS CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Financial Conditio n

December 31, 2016 and 2015

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and due from banks

 

$

152,736

 

$

155,985

Interest bearing bank deposits

 

 

 —

 

 

10,107

Cash and cash equivalents

 

 

152,736

 

 

166,092

Investment securities available-for-sale (at fair value)

 

 

884,232

 

 

1,157,246

Investment securities held-to-maturity (fair value of $332,573 and $428,585 at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively)

 

 

332,505

 

 

427,503

Non-marketable securities

 

 

14,949

 

 

22,529

Loans

 

 

2,860,921

 

 

2,587,673

Allowance for loan losses

 

 

(29,174)

 

 

(27,119)

Loans, net

 

 

2,831,747

 

 

2,560,554

Loans held for sale

 

 

24,187

 

 

13,292

Other real estate owned

 

 

15,662

 

 

20,814

Premises and equipment, net

 

 

95,671

 

 

103,103

Goodwill

 

 

59,630

 

 

59,630

Intangible assets, net

 

 

6,949

 

 

12,429

Other assets

 

 

154,778

 

 

140,716

Total assets

 

$

4,573,046

 

$

4,683,908

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deposits:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-interest bearing demand deposits

 

$

846,744

 

$

815,054

Interest bearing demand deposits

 

 

427,538

 

 

436,745

Savings and money market

 

 

1,422,321

 

 

1,394,995

Time deposits

 

 

1,172,046

 

 

1,193,883

Total deposits

 

 

3,868,649

 

 

3,840,677

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

 

 

92,011

 

 

136,523

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

 

 

38,665

 

 

40,000

Other liabilities

 

 

37,532

 

 

49,164

Total liabilities

 

 

4,036,857

 

 

4,066,364

Shareholders’ equity:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common stock, par value $0.01 per share: 400,000,000 shares authorized; 51,813,011 and 52,177,352 shares issued; 26,386,583 and 30,358,509 shares outstanding at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively

 

 

514

 

 

513

Additional paid-in capital

 

 

984,087

 

 

997,926

Retained earnings

 

 

55,454

 

 

38,670

Treasury stock of 24,927,157 and 20,982,812 shares at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively, at cost

 

 

(502,104)

 

 

(419,660)

Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income, net of tax

 

 

(1,762)

 

 

95

Total shareholders’ equity

 

 

536,189

 

 

617,544

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

 

$

4,573,046

 

$

4,683,908

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.

77


 

Table of Contents

NATIONAL BANK HOLDINGS CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Operation s

For the Years Ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2016

 

2015

 

2014

Interest and dividend income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest and fees on loans

 

$

129,317

 

$

131,253

 

$

134,476

Interest and dividends on investment securities

 

 

29,665

 

 

38,145

 

 

48,651

Dividends on non-marketable securities

 

 

748

 

 

1,210

 

 

1,206

Interest on interest-bearing bank deposits

 

 

718

 

 

799

 

 

329

Total interest and dividend income

 

 

160,448

 

 

171,407

 

 

184,662

Interest expense:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest on deposits

 

 

13,963

 

 

13,609

 

 

14,120

Interest on borrowings

 

 

845

 

 

853

 

 

293

Total interest expense

 

 

14,808

 

 

14,462

 

 

14,413

Net interest income before provision for loan losses

 

 

145,640

 

 

156,945

 

 

170,249

Provision for loan losses

 

 

23,651

 

 

12,444

 

 

6,209

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

 

 

121,989

 

 

144,501

 

 

164,040

Non-interest income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Service charges

 

 

13,900

 

 

14,798

 

 

15,430

Bank card fees

 

 

11,429

 

 

10,898

 

 

10,123

Gain on sale of mortgages, net

 

 

2,881

 

 

1,963

 

 

1,000

Bank-owned life insurance income

 

 

1,861

 

 

1,614

 

 

442

Other non-interest income

 

 

7,708

 

 

4,301

 

 

4,105

OREO related write-ups and other income

 

 

2,248

 

 

2,379

 

 

3,807

Bargain purchase gain

 

 

 —

 

 

1,048

 

 

 —

FDIC loss-sharing related

 

 

 —

 

 

(15,553)

 

 

(36,603)

Total non-interest income

 

 

40,027

 

 

21,448

 

 

(1,696)

Non-interest expense:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Salaries and benefits

 

 

79,765

 

 

83,018

 

 

82,834

Occupancy and equipment

 

 

22,904

 

 

24,490

 

 

25,101

Telecommunications and data processing

 

 

5,970

 

 

11,507

 

 

11,927

Marketing and business development

 

 

2,564

 

 

4,325

 

 

4,571

FDIC deposit insurance

 

 

3,236

 

 

3,922

 

 

4,130

Bank card expenses

 

 

4,440

 

 

3,701

 

 

3,079

Professional fees

 

 

3,496

 

 

4,495

 

 

3,257

Other non-interest expense

 

 

8,554

 

 

11,107

 

 

14,581

Problem asset workout

 

 

3,983

 

 

7,317

 

 

11,258

Gain on OREO sales, net

 

 

(4,383)

 

 

(2,776)

 

 

(13,126)

Intangible asset amortization

 

 

5,480

 

 

5,401

 

 

5,344

Loss (gain) from the change in fair value of warrant liability

 

 

 —

 

 

106

 

 

(2,953)

Banking center consolidation related expenses

 

 

 —

 

 

1,411

 

 

 —

Total non-interest expense

 

 

136,009

 

 

158,024

 

 

150,003

Income before income taxes

 

 

26,007

 

 

7,925

 

 

12,341

Income tax expense

 

 

2,947

 

 

3,044

 

 

3,165

Net income

 

$

23,060

 

$

4,881

 

$

9,176

Income per share—basic

 

$

0.81

 

$

0.14

 

$

0.22

Income per share—diluted

 

$

0.79

 

$

0.14

 

$

0.22

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

 

28,313,061

 

 

34,349,996

 

 

42,404,609

Diluted

 

 

29,091,343

 

 

34,363,487

 

 

42,421,014

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.

78


 

Table of Contents

NATIONAL BANK HOLDINGS CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

For the Years Ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014

(In thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2016

 

2015

 

2014

Net income

 

$

23,060

 

$

4,881

 

$

9,176

Other comprehensive (loss) income, net of tax:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Securities available-for-sale:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period, net of tax (expense) benefit of $(26), $2,015 and $(9,694) for the years ended 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively

 

 

42

 

 

(3,275)

 

 

15,765

Less: amortization of net unrealized holding gains to income, net of tax benefit of $1,166, $1,523 and $520 for the years ended 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively

 

 

(1,899)

 

 

(2,469)

 

 

(3,170)

Other comprehensive (loss) income

 

 

(1,857)

 

 

(5,744)

 

 

12,595

Comprehensive income (loss)

 

$

21,203

 

$

(863)

 

$

21,771

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.

79


 

Table of Contents

NATIONAL BANK HOLDINGS CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equit y

For the Years Ended 2016, 2015 and 2014

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Accumulated

    

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Additional

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

other

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common

 

paid-in

 

Retained

 

Treasury

 

comprehensive

 

 

 

 

 

 

stock

 

capital

 

earnings

 

stock

 

Income (loss), net

 

Total

 

Balance, December 31, 2013

 

$

512

 

$

990,216

 

$

39,966

 

$

(126,146)

 

$

(6,756)

 

$

897,792

 

Net Income

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

9,176

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

9,176

 

Stock-based compensation

 

 

 —

 

 

3,572

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

3,572

 

Issuance of stock under equity compensation plan, including tax benefit of $7

 

 

 —

 

 

(576)

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(576)

 

Repurchase of 6,076,558 shares

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(119,370)

 

 

 —

 

 

(119,370)

 

Cash dividends declared ($0.20 per share)

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(8,614)

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(8,614)

 

Other comprehensive income

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

12,595

 

 

12,595

 

Balance, December 31, 2014

 

$

512

 

$

993,212

 

$

40,528

 

$

(245,516)

 

$

5,839

 

$

794,575

 

Net income

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

4,881

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

4,881

 

Stock-based compensation

 

 

 —

 

 

3,349

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

3,349

 

Issuance of stock under equity compensation plans, including tax benefit of $24, gain on reissuance of treasury stock of $96

 

 

1

 

 

(1,701)

 

 

 —

 

 

904

 

 

 —

 

 

(796)

 

Repurchase of 8,645,836 shares

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(175,048)

 

 

 —

 

 

(175,048)

 

Cash dividends declared ($0.20 per share)

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(6,739)

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(6,739)

 

Warrant reclassification

 

 

 —

 

 

3,066

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

3,066

 

Other comprehensive loss

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(5,744)

 

 

(5,744)

 

Balance, December 31, 2015

 

$

513

 

$

997,926

 

$

38,670

 

$

(419,660)

 

$

95

 

$

617,544

 

Net income

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

23,060

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

23,060

 

Stock-based compensation

 

 

 —

 

 

3,492

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

3,492

 

Issuance of stock under equity compensation and ASPP plans, including gain on reissuance of treasury stock of $4,396

 

 

1

 

 

(13,790)

 

 

 —

 

 

7,588

 

 

 —

 

 

(6,201)

 

Repurchase of 4,500,936 shares

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(93,573)

 

 

 —

 

 

(93,573)

 

Cash dividends declared ($0.22 per share)

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(6,276)

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(6,276)

 

Warrant exercise

 

 

 —

 

 

(3,541)

 

 

 —

 

 

3,541

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

Other comprehensive loss

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(1,857)

 

 

(1,857)

 

Balance, December 31, 2016

 

$

514

 

$

984,087

 

$

55,454

 

$

(502,104)

 

$

(1,762)

 

$

536,189

 

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.

 

80


 

Table of Contents

NATIONAL BANK HOLDINGS CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flow s

For the Years Ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014

(In thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2016

 

2015

 

2014

Cash flows from operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

 

$

23,060

 

$

4,881

 

$

9,176

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash used in operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for loan losses

 

 

23,651

 

 

12,444

 

 

6,209

Depreciation and amortization

 

 

14,203

 

 

15,502

 

 

15,930

Current income tax receivable

 

 

4,176

 

 

(7,328)

 

 

10,807

Deferred income tax asset

 

 

(176)

 

 

(4,241)

 

 

(15,776)

Net excess tax (benefit) deficit on stock-based compensation

 

 

(2,078)

 

 

3,677

 

 

15

Discount accretion, net of premium amortization on securities

 

 

3,067

 

 

4,124

 

 

5,010

Loan accretion

 

 

(35,073)

 

 

(50,687)

 

 

(63,881)

Gain on sale of mortgages, net

 

 

(2,881)

 

 

(1,963)

 

 

(1,000)

Origination of loans held for sale, net of repayments

 

 

(114,397)

 

 

(99,246)

 

 

(44,490)

Proceeds from sales of loans held for sale

 

 

101,098

 

 

92,845

 

 

45,584

Bank-owned life insurance income

 

 

(1,861)

 

 

(1,614)

 

 

(442)

Amortization of indemnification asset

 

 

 —

 

 

15,878

 

 

27,741

Gain on the sale of other real estate owned, net

 

 

(4,383)

 

 

(2,776)

 

 

(13,126)

Impairment on other real estate owned

 

 

298

 

 

1,580

 

 

2,103

Impairment on fixed assets related to banking center consolidations

 

 

 —

 

 

1,411

 

 

Gain on sale of fixed assets

 

 

(1,981)

 

 

(28)

 

 

(123)

Bargain purchase gain

 

 

 —

 

 

(1,048)

 

 

 —

Stock-based compensation

 

 

3,492

 

 

3,349

 

 

3,572

Decrease in due to FDIC, net

 

 

 —

 

 

(37,138)

 

 

129

(Increase) decrease in other assets

 

 

(4,721)

 

 

4,871

 

 

3,179

(Decrease) increase in other liabilities

 

 

(9,430)

 

 

7,879

 

 

6,628

Net cash used in operating activities

 

 

(3,936)

 

 

(37,628)

 

 

(2,755)

Cash flows from investing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchase of FHLB stock

 

 

(5,544)

 

 

 —

 

 

(952)

Proceeds from redemption of FHLB stock

 

 

7,670

 

 

493

 

 

 —

Proceeds from redemption of FRB stock

 

 

4,964

 

 

5,320

 

 

5,570

Proceeds from maturities of investment securities held-to-maturity

 

 

91,376

 

 

104,683

 

 

105,594

Proceeds from maturities of investment securities available-for-sale

 

 

275,448

 

 

314,271

 

 

327,368

Proceeds from sales of investment securities available-for-sale

 

 

 —

 

 

29,747

 

 

 —

Proceeds from maturities of non-marketable securities

 

 

490

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Purchase of investment securities available-for-sale

 

 

(4,872)

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Purchase of investment securities held-to-maturity

 

 

 —

 

 

(6,225)

 

 

 —

Net increase in loans

 

 

(270,585)

 

 

(334,798)

 

 

(253,102)

Sales (purchases) of premises and equipment, net

 

 

690

 

 

(5,081)

 

 

(1,585)

Purchase of bank-owned life insurance

 

 

(10,344)

 

 

 —

 

 

(43,800)

Proceeds from sales of loans

 

 

9,231

 

 

17,204

 

 

3,607

Proceeds from sales of other real estate owned

 

 

16,105

 

 

15,566

 

 

56,519

Decrease (increase) in FDIC indemnification asset

 

 

 —

 

 

18,331

 

 

(2,376)

Net cash activity from acquisitions

 

 

 —

 

 

22,832

 

 

 —

Net cash provided by investing activities

 

 

114,629

 

 

182,343

 

 

196,843

Cash flows from financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in deposits

 

 

27,972

 

 

(55,654)

 

 

(72,121)

(Decrease) increase in repurchase agreements

 

 

(44,512)

 

 

2,971

 

 

34,005

Advances from FHLB

 

 

218,629

 

 

 —

 

 

40,000

FHLB payoffs

 

 

(219,964)

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Issuance of stock under purchase and equity compensation plans

 

 

(6,201)

 

 

(952)

 

 

(576)

Proceeds from exercise of stock options

 

 

 —

 

 

160

 

 

 —

Settlement of warrants

 

 

 —

 

 

(368)

 

 

 —

Payment of dividends

 

 

(6,400)

 

 

(6,711)

 

 

(8,507)

Repurchase of shares

 

 

(93,573)

 

 

(175,048)

 

 

(119,370)

Net cash used in financing activities

 

 

(124,049)

 

 

(235,602)

 

 

(126,569)

(Decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents

 

 

(13,356)

 

 

(90,887)

 

 

67,519

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of the year

 

 

166,092

 

 

256,979

 

 

189,460

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

 

$

152,736

 

$

166,092

 

$

256,979

Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information during the period:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash paid for interest

 

$

14,154

 

$

13,751

 

$

13,863

Net tax refunds (payments)

 

$

2,193

 

$

(7,420)

 

$

(8,119)

Supplemental schedule of non-cash investing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans transferred to other real estate owned at fair value

 

$

6,868

 

$

4,576

 

$

4,491

FDIC submissions transferred to other liabilities

 

$

 —

 

$

 —

 

$

(5,673)

Loans purchased but not settled

 

$

5,285

 

$

9,936

 

$

10,038

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.

 

81


 

 

NATIONAL BANK HOLDINGS CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014

Note 1 Basis of Presenta tion

 

National Bank Holdings Corporation ("NBHC" or the "Company") is a bank holding company that was incorporated in the State of Delaware in 2009 with the intent to acquire and operate financial services franchises and other complementary businesses in targeted markets.  The Company is headquartered immediately south of Denver, in Greenwood Village, Colorado, and its primary operations are conducted through its wholly owned subsidiary, NBH Bank, referred to as the "Bank" or NBH Bank, a Colorado state-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System. The Company provides a variety of banking products to both commercial and consumer clients through a network of 91 banking centers located in Colorado, the greater Kansas City area and Texas, and through online and mobile banking products and services.

 

The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its wholly owned subsidiary, NBH Bank. The accompanying consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) and where applicable, with general practices in the banking industry or guidelines prescribed by bank regulatory agencies. The consolidated financial statements reflect all adjustments which are, in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair statement of the results presented. All such adjustments are of a normal recurring nature. All significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. Certain reclassifications of prior years' amounts are made whenever necessary to conform to current period presentation. During the first quarter of 2016, the Company updated the loan classifications in its allowance for loan losses model. Certain loan classifications within the consolidated financial statement disclosures have been updated to reflect this change. Refer to note 7 for further discussion. The prior year presentations have been reclassified to conform to the current year presentation. All amounts are in thousands, except share data, or as otherwise noted.

 

The Company's significant accounting policies followed in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements are disclosed in note 2. GAAP requires management to make estimates that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses, and disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities. By their nature, estimates are based on judgment and available information. Management has made significant estimates in certain areas, such as the amount and timing of expected cash flows from assets, the valuation of other real estate owned (“OREO”), the fair value adjustments on assets acquired and liabilities assumed, the valuation of core deposit intangible assets, the evaluation of investment securities for other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”), the valuation of stock-based compensation, the fair values of financial instruments, the allowance for loan losses (“ALL”), and contingent liabilities. Because of the inherent uncertainties associated with any estimation process and future changes in market and economic conditions, it is possible that actual results could differ significantly from those estimates.

 

Note 2 Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

 

a) Acquisition activities —The Company accounts for business combinations under the acquisition method of accounting. Assets acquired and liabilities assumed are measured and recorded at fair value at the date of acquisition, including identifiable intangible assets. If the fair value of net assets acquired exceeds the fair value of consideration paid, a bargain purchase gain is recognized at the date of acquisition. Conversely, if the consideration paid exceeds the fair value of the net assets acquired, goodwill is recognized at the acquisition date. Fair values are subject to refinement for up to a maximum of one year after the closing date of an acquisition as information relative to closing date fair values becomes available. Adjustments recorded to the acquired assets and liabilities assumed are applied prospectively in accordance with Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2015-16, Simplifying the Accounting for Measurement-Period Adjustments . The determination of the fair value of loans acquired takes into account credit quality deterioration and probability of loss therefore, the related ALL is not carried forward at the time of acquisition.

 

Identifiable intangible assets are recognized separately if they arise from contractual or other legal rights or if they are separable (i.e., capable of being sold, transferred, licensed, rented, or exchanged separately from the entity). Deposit liabilities and the related depositor relationship intangible assets, known as the core deposit intangible assets, may be exchanged in observable exchange transactions. As a result, the core deposit intangible asset is considered identifiable, because the separability criterion has been met.

 

82


 

 

b) Cash and cash equivalents —Cash and cash equivalents include cash, cash items, amounts due from other banks, amounts due from the Federal Reserve Bank of Kansas City, federal funds sold, and interest-bearing bank deposits.

 

c) Investment securities —Investment securities may be classified in three categories: trading, available-for-sale and held-to-maturity. Management determines the appropriate classification at the time of purchase and reevaluates the classification at each reporting period. Any sales of available-for-sale securities are for the purpose of executing the Company’s asset/liability management strategy, reducing borrowings, funding loan growth, providing liquidity, or eliminating a perceived credit risk in a specific security. Held-to-maturity securities are carried at amortized cost and the available-for-sale securities are carried at estimated fair value. Unrealized gains or losses on securities available-for-sale are reported as accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) (“AOCI”), a component of shareholders’ equity, net of income tax. Gains and losses realized upon sales of securities are calculated using the specific identification method. Premiums and discounts are amortized to interest income over the estimated lives of the securities. Prepayment experience is periodically evaluated and a determination made regarding the appropriate estimate of the future rates of prepayment. When a change in a bond’s estimated remaining life is necessary, a corresponding adjustment is made in the related premium amortization or discount accretion. Purchases and sales of securities, including any corresponding gains or losses, are recognized on a trade-date basis and a receivable or payable is recognized for pending transaction settlements.

 

Management evaluates all investments for OTTI on a quarterly basis, and more frequently when economic or market conditions warrant such evaluation. Impairment is considered to be other-than-temporary if it is likely that all amounts contractually due will not be received for debt securities and when there is no positive evidence indicating that an investment’s carrying amount is recoverable in the near term for equity securities. When impairment is considered other-than-temporary, the cost basis of the security is written down to fair value, with the impairment charge related to credit included in earnings, while the impairment charge related to all other factors is recognized in OCI. If the Company has the intent to sell the security or it is more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security, the entire amount of the OTTI is recorded in earnings. In evaluating whether the impairment is temporary or other than temporary, the Company considers, among other things, the severity and duration of the unrealized loss position; adverse conditions specifically related to the security; changes in expected future cash flows; downgrades in the rating of the security by a rating agency; the failure of the issuer to make scheduled interest or principal payments; whether the Company has the intent to sell the security; and whether it is more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security.

 

d) Non-marketable securities —Non-marketable securities include Federal Reserve Bank ("FRB") stock, Federal Home Loan Bank ("FHLB") stock and non-negotiable certificates of deposit acquired in the acquisition of Pine River Bank Corporation, the parent company of Pine River Valley Bank (“Pine River”). These securities have been acquired for debt facility or regulatory purposes and are carried at cost.

 

e) Loans receivable— Loans receivable include loans originated by the Company and loans that are acquired through acquisitions. Loans originated by the Company are carried at the principal amount outstanding, net of premiums, discounts, unearned income, and deferred loan fees and costs. Loan fees and certain costs of originating loans are deferred and the net amount is amortized over the contractual life of the related loans. Acquired loans are initially recorded at fair value and are accounted for under either Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 310-30, Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with Deteriorated Credit Quality (see additional information below) or ASC Topic 310, Rece ivables . Non-refundable loan origination and commitment fees, net of direct costs of originating or acquiring loans, and fair value adjustments for acquired loans, are deferred and recognized over the remaining lives of the related loans in accordance with ASC 310-20.

 

Acquired loans are recorded at their estimated fair value at the time of acquisition and accounted for under either ASC 310-30 or ASC 310. Estimated fair values of acquired loans are based on a discounted cash flow methodology that considers various factors including the type of loan and related collateral, the expected timing of cash flows, classification status, fixed or variable interest rate, term of loan and whether or not the loan is amortizing, and a discount rate reflecting the Company’s assessment of risk inherent in the cash flow estimates. Acquired 310-30 loans are grouped together according to similar characteristics such as type of loan, loan purpose, geography, risk rating and underlying collateral and are treated as distinct pools when applying various valuation techniques and, in certain circumstances, for the ongoing monitoring of the credit quality and performance of the pools. Each pool is accounted for as a single loan for which the integrity is maintained throughout the life of the asset. Discounts created when the loans are recorded at their estimated fair values at acquisition are accreted over the remaining term of the loan as an adjustment to the related loan’s yield. Similar to originated loans described below, the accrual of interest income on acquired loans that are not accounted for under ASC 310-30 is discontinued when the collection of principal or interest, in whole or in part, is doubtful.

83


 

 

 

Interest income on acquired loans that are accounted for under ASC Topic 310 and interest income on loans originated by the Company is accrued and credited to income as it is earned using the interest method based on daily balances of the principal amount outstanding. However, interest is generally not accrued on loans 90 days or more past due, unless they are well secured and in the process of collection. Additionally, in certain situations, loans that are not contractually past due may be placed on non-accrual status due to the continued failure to adhere to contractual payment terms by the borrower coupled with other pertinent factors, such as insufficient collateral value or deficient primary and secondary sources of repayment. Accrued interest receivable is reversed when a loan is placed on non-accrual status and payments received generally reduce the carrying value of the loan. Interest is not accrued while a loan is on non-accrual status and interest income is generally recognized on a cash basis only after payment in full of the past due principal and collection of principal outstanding is reasonably assured. A loan may be placed back on accrual status if all contractual payments have been received, or sooner under certain conditions and collection of future principal and interest payments is no longer doubtful.

 

In the event of borrower default, the Company may seek recovery in compliance with state lending laws, the respective loan agreements, and credit monitoring and remediation procedures that may include modifying or restructuring a loan from its original terms, for economic or legal reasons, to provide a concession to the borrower from their original terms due to borrower financial difficulties in order to facilitate repayment. Such restructured loans are considered “troubled debt restructurings” and are identified in accordance with ASC 310-40, Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors . Under this guidance, modifications to loans that fall within the scope of ASC 310-30 are not considered troubled debt restructurings, regardless of otherwise meeting the definition of a troubled debt restructuring.

 

Loans receivable accounted for under ASC 310-30

 

The Company accounts for and evaluates acquired loans in accordance with the provisions of ASC 310-30, Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with Deteriorated Credit Quality . When loans exhibit evidence of credit deterioration since origination and it is probable at the date of acquisition that the Company will not collect all principal and interest payments in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement, the expected shortfall in future cash flows, as compared to the contractual amount due, is recognized as a non-accretable difference. Any excess of expected cash flows over the acquisition date fair value is known as the accretable yield, and is recognized as accretion income over the life of each pool. Contractual fees not expected to be collected are not included in ASC 310-30 contractual cash flows. Should fees be subsequently collected, the cash flows are accounted for as non 310-30 fee income in the period they are received. Loans that are accounted for under ASC 310-30 that meet the criteria for non-accrual of interest at the time of acquisition or subsequent to acquisition, may be considered performing, regardless of whether the client is contractually delinquent, if the   timing and expected cash flows on such loans can be reasonably estimated and if collection of the new carrying value of such loans is expected.

 

The expected cash flows of loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 are periodically remeasured utilizing the same cash flow methodology used at the time of acquisition and subsequent decreases to the expected cash flows will generally result in a provision for loan losses charge in the Company’s consolidated statements of operations. Any increases to the cash flow projections are recognized on a prospective basis through an increase to the pool’s accretion income over its remaining life once any previously recorded provision expense has been reversed. These cash flow evaluations are inherently subjective as they require material estimates, all of which may be susceptible to significant change.

 

f) Loans held for sale— Loans originated and intended for sale in the secondary market are carried at the lower of aggregate cost or estimated fair value. Net unrealized losses, if any, are recognized through a valuation allowance that is recorded as a charge to income. Deferred fees and costs related to these loans are not amortized, but are recognized as part of the cost basis of the loan at the time it is sold. Gains or losses are recognized upon sale and are included as a component of gain on sale of mortgages, net in the consolidated statements of operations. Loans held for sale have primarily been fixed rate single-family residential mortgage loans under contract to be sold in the secondary market. In most cases, loans in this category are sold within 45 days. These loans are generally sold with the mortgage servicing rights released. Under limited circumstances, buyers may have recourse to return a purchased loan to the Company. Recourse conditions may include early payment default, breach of representations or warranties, or documentation deficiencies.

 

84


 

 

The Company enters into commitments to originate residential mortgage loans whereby the interest rate on the loan is determined prior to funding (i.e. interest rate lock commitments). Such interest rate lock commitments on mortgage loans to be sold in the secondary market are considered to be derivatives. To protect against the price risk inherent in residential mortgage loan commitments, the Company utilizes both "best efforts" and "mandatory delivery" forward loan sale commitments to mitigate the risk of potential increases or decreases in the values of loans that would result from the change in market rates for such loans. The Company manages the interest rate risk on interest rate lock commitments by entering into forward sale contracts of mortgage backed securities. Such contracts are accounted for as derivatives and are recorded at fair value as derivative assets or liabilities. They are carried on the consolidated statements of financial condition within other assets or other liabilities and changes in fair value are recorded as a component of gain on sale of mortgages, net in the consolidated statements of operations. The gross gains on loan sales are recognized based on new loan commitments with adjustment for price and pair-off activity. Commission expenses on loans held for sale are recognized based on loans closed.

 

g) Allowance for loan losses —The allowance for loan losses represents management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in loans, including acquired loans to the extent necessary, as of the balance sheet date. The determination of the ALL takes into consideration, among other matters, the estimated fair value of the underlying collateral, economic conditions, historical net loan losses, the estimated loss emergence period, estimated default rates, any declines in cash flow assumptions from acquisition, loan structures, growth factors and other elements that warrant recognition. In addition, various regulatory agencies, as an integral part of the examination process, periodically review the ALL. Such agencies may require the Company to recognize additions to the ALL or increases to adversely graded classified loans based on their judgments about information available to them at the time of their examinations.

 

The Company uses an internal risk rating system to indicate credit quality in the loan portfolio. The risk rating system is applied to all loans and uses a series of grades, which reflect management’s assessment of the risk attributable to loans based on an analysis of the borrower’s financial condition and ability to meet contractual debt service requirements. Loans that management perceives to have acceptable risk are categorized as “Pass” loans. The “Special Mention” loans represent loans that have potential credit weaknesses that deserve management’s close attention. Special mention loans include borrowers that have potential weaknesses or unwarranted risks that, unless corrected, may threaten the borrower’s ability to meet debt requirements. However, these borrowers are still believed to have the ability to respond to and resolve the financial issues that threaten their financial situation. Loans classified as “Substandard” are inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any. Substandard loans have a distinct possibility of loss if the deficiencies are not corrected. “Doubtful” loans are loans that management believes the collection of payments in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement is highly questionable and improbable. Loans accounted for under ASC 310-30, despite being 90 days or more past due or internally adversely classified, may be classified as performing upon and subsequent to acquisition, regardless of whether the client is contractually delinquent, if the timing and expected cash flows on such loans can be reasonably estimated and if collection of the carrying value of such loans is expected. Interest accrual is discontinued on doubtful loans and certain substandard loans that are excluded from ASC 310-30, as is more fully discussed in note 7.

 

The Company routinely evaluates adversely risk-rated credits for impairment. Impairment, if any, is typically measured for each loan based on a thorough analysis of the most probable source of repayment, including the present value of the loan’s expected future cash flows, the loan’s estimated fair value, or the estimated fair value of the underlying collateral less costs of disposition for collateral dependent loans. General allowances are established for loans with similar characteristics. In this process, general allowance factors are based on an analysis of historical loss and recovery experience, if any, related to originated and acquired loans, as well as certain industry experience, with adjustments made for qualitative or environmental factors that are likely to cause estimated credit losses to differ from historical experience. To the extent that the data supporting such factors has limitations, management’s judgment and experience play a key role in determining the allowance estimates.

 

Additions to the ALL are made by provisions for loan losses that are charged to operations. The allowance is decreased by charge-offs due to losses and is increased by provisions for loan losses and recoveries. When it is determined that specific loans, or portions thereof, are uncollectible, these amounts are charged off against the ALL. If repayment of the loan is collateral dependent, the fair value of the collateral, less cost to sell, is used to determine charge-off amounts.

 

85


 

 

The Company maintains an ALL for loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 as a result of impairment to loan pools arising from the periodic re-measurement of these loans. Any impairment in the individual pool is generally recognized in the current period as provision for loan losses. Any improvement in the estimated cash flows, is generally not recognized immediately, but is instead reflected as an adjustment to the related loan pools yield on a prospective basis once any previously recorded impairment has been recaptured.

 

h) Premises and equipment —With the exception of premises and equipment acquired through business combinations, which are initially measured and recorded at fair value, purchased land is stated at cost, and buildings and equipment are carried at cost, including capitalized interest when appropriate, less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is computed using the straight-line method over the estimated useful life of the asset. The Company generally assigns depreciable lives of 39 years for buildings, 7 to 15 years for building improvements, and 3 to 7 years for equipment. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of their estimated useful lives or remaining lease terms. Maintenance and repairs are charged to non-interest expense as incurred. The Company reviews premises and equipment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of the asset may not be recoverable. An impairment loss is recognized when the sum of the undiscounted future net cash flows expected to result from the use of the asset and its eventual disposal is less than its carrying amount. In the case of a property that is subject to an operating lease that the Company no longer expects to use, a liability is recorded equal to the remaining lease rentals, adjusted for the effects of any prepaid or deferred items recognized under the lease, and reduced by estimated sublease rentals that could be reasonably obtained for the property, even if the entity does not intend to enter into a sublease. A ratable portion of the sublease allocation is then expensed until the property is subleased. Property and equipment that meet the held-for-sale criteria is recorded at the lower of its carrying amount or fair value less cost to sell and depreciation is ceased.

 

i) Goodwill and intangible assets —Goodwill is established and recorded if the consideration given during an acquisition transaction exceeds the fair value of the net assets received. Goodwill has an indefinite useful life and is not amortized, but is evaluated annually for potential impairment, or when events or circumstances indicate a potential impairment. Such events or circumstances may include deterioration in general economic conditions, deterioration in industry or market conditions, an increased competitive environment, a decline in market-dependent multiples or metrics, declining financial performance, entity-specific events or circumstances or a sustained decrease in share price (either in absolute terms or relative to peers). The Company first evaluates potential impairment of goodwill by comparing the fair value of the reporting unit to its carrying amount. Any excess of carrying value over fair value would indicate a potential impairment and the Company would proceed to perform an additional test to determine whether goodwill has been impaired and calculate the amount of that impairment. Intangible assets that have finite useful lives, such as core deposit intangibles, are amortized over their estimated useful lives. The Company’s core deposit intangible assets represent the value of the anticipated future cost savings that will result from the acquired core deposit relationships versus an alternative source of funding.

 

Judgment may be used in assessing goodwill and intangible assets for impairment. Estimates of fair value are based on projections of revenues, operating costs and cash flows of the reporting unit considering historical and anticipated future results, general economic and market conditions, as well as the impact of planned business or operational strategies. The valuations use a combination of present value techniques to measure fair value and consider market factors. Additionally, judgment is used in determining the useful lives of finite-lived intangible assets. Adverse changes in the economic environment, operations of the reporting unit, or changes in judgments and projections could result in a significantly different estimate of the fair value of the reporting unit and could result in an impairment of goodwill and/or intangible assets.

 

j) Other real estate owned —OREO consists of property that has been foreclosed on or repossessed by deed in lieu of foreclosure. The assets are initially recorded at the fair value of the collateral less estimated costs to sell, with any initial valuation adjustments charged to the ALL. Subsequent downward valuation adjustments, if any, in addition to gains and losses realized on sales and net operating expenses, are recorded in other non-interest expense, while any subsequent write-ups are recorded in non-interest income. Costs associated with maintaining property, such as utilities and maintenance, are charged to expense in the period in which they occur, while costs relating to the development and improvement of property are capitalized to the extent the balance does not exceed fair value. All OREO acquired through acquisition is recorded at fair value, less cost to sell, at the date of acquisition.

 

k)  Bank-owned life insurance —The Company purchased or acquired bank-owned life insurance ("BOLI") policies on certain associates of the Company. The Company is the owner and beneficiary of these policies. The BOLI is carried at net realizable value with changes in net realizable value recorded in non-interest income.

 

86


 

 

l) Securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities sold under agreements to repurchase —The Company periodically enters into purchases or sales of securities under agreements to resell or repurchase as of a specified future date. The securities purchased under agreements to resell are accounted for as collateralized financing transactions and are reflected as an asset in the consolidated statements of financial condition. The securities pledged by the counterparties are held by a third party custodian and valued daily. The Company may require additional collateral to ensure full collateralization for these transactions. The repurchase agreements are considered financing agreements and the obligation to repurchase assets sold is reflected as a liability in the consolidated statements of financial condition of the Company. The repurchase agreements are collateralized by debt securities that are under the control of the Company.

 

m) Stock-based compensation —The Company accounts for stock-based compensation in accordance with ASC Topic

718, Compensation—Stock Compensation as amended by ASU 2016-09, Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting . The Company grants stock-based awards including stock options, restricted stock and performance stock units. Stock option grants are for a fixed number of common shares and are issued to associates and directors at exercise prices which are not less than the fair value of a share of stock at the date of grant. The options vest over a time period stated in each option agreement and may be subject to other performance vesting conditions, which require the related compensation expense to be recorded ratably over the requisite service period starting when such conditions become probable. Restricted stock is granted for a fixed number of shares, the transferability of which is restricted until such shares become vested according to the terms in the award agreement. Restricted shares may have multiple vesting qualifications which can include time vesting of a set portion of the restricted shares, performance criterion, such as market criteria that are tied to specified market conditions of the Company’s common stock price.

 

The fair value of stock options and market-based awards is measured using either a Black-Scholes model or a Monte Carlo simulation model, depending on the vesting requirement of each grant. The fair value of time-based restricted stock awards is based on the Company’s stock price on the date of grant. Compensation expense for the portion of the awards that contain a market vesting condition is recognized over the derived service period based on the fair value of the awards on the grant date. Compensation expense for the portion of the awards that contain performance and service vesting conditions is recognized over the requisite service period based on the fair value of the awards on the grant date. The amortization of stock-based compensation reflects any estimated forfeitures and the expense realized in subsequent periods may be adjusted to reflect the actual forfeitures realized. The outstanding stock options carry a maximum contractual term of ten years and the market vesting restricted shares carry contractual terms that range from 7-10 years, with certain awards having no defined contractual term. To the extent that any award is forfeited, surrendered, terminated, expires, or lapses without being exercised, the shares of stock subject to such award not delivered as a result thereof are again made available for awards under the Plan.

 

In the fourth quarter of 2016, the Company early adopted ASU 2016-09, with an effective date of January 1, 2016. The ASU requires all excess tax benefits and tax deficiencies (including tax benefits of dividends on share-based payment awards) be recognized in the consolidated statements of operations as a component of income tax expense or benefit. The tax effects of exercised, expired or vested awards are treated as discrete items in the reporting period in which they occur and may result in increased volatility in our effective tax rate. As part of the adoption of this standard, the Company made an accounting election to continue to estimate forfeitures when determining amortization expense of stock-based compensation. Additionally, the Company applied the retrospective transition method for the presentation of “Net tax (benefit) deficit on stock-based compensation” from a financing activity to an operating activity in the Company’s consolidated statements of cash flows. Cash paid by the Company when directly withholding shares for tax withholding purposes is classified as a financing activity in the consolidated statements of cash flows. For the year ended December 31, 2016, the impact of adopting all provisions of the ASU to the Company’s consolidated statements of operations was a $2.1 million decrease to income tax expense from excess tax benefits realized in the fourth quarter of 2016.

 

Prior to 2016, excess tax benefits were recognized in additional paid-in capital and tax deficiencies were recognized either as an offset to accumulated excess tax benefits, if any, or in the consolidated statements of operations. Excess tax benefits were not recognized until the deduction reduces taxes payable. Additionally, excess tax benefits from stock-based compensation was included in operating and financing activities within the Company’s consolidated statements of cash flows.

 

87


 

 

n) Warrants —The Company issued warrants to certain lead investors in 2009 and 2010. The warrants are for a fixed number of shares and had original expirations of ten years from the date of issuance. If exercised, the Company must settle the warrants in its own stock. Historically, the exercise price and the number of warrants were subject to certain down-round provisions, whereby certain subsequent equity issuances at a price below the existing exercise price would result in a downward adjustment to the exercise price and an increase in the number of warrants, and as a result, the warrants were historically classified as a liability in the Company’s consolidated statements of financial condition with changes in the fair value each period reported in the statements of operations as non-interest expense. During 2015, the outstanding warrant contracts were modified, terminating the down-round provisions and extending the contractual life an additional six months from the original expiration. As a result, the warrant contracts were recorded at fair value as of the modification date using a Black-Scholes model with the change in fair value reported in the statement of operations as non-interest expense, and were reclassified to shareholders’ equity as of December 31, 2015.

 

o) Income taxes —The Company and its subsidiaries file U.S. federal and certain state income tax returns on a consolidated basis. Additionally, the Company and its subsidiaries file separate state income tax returns with various state jurisdictions. The provision for income taxes includes the income tax balances of the Company and all of its subsidiaries.

 

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for temporary differences between the financial reporting basis and the tax basis of the Company’s assets and liabilities at enacted tax rates expected to be in effect when such amounts are realized or settled. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted for the effects of changes in tax rates in the period of change. The Company establishes a valuation allowance when management believes, based on the weight of available evidence, it is more likely than not that some portion of the deferred tax assets will not be realized.

 

The Company recognizes and measures income tax benefits based upon a two-step model: 1) a tax position must be more likely than not to be sustained based solely on its technical merits in order to be recognized; and 2) the benefit is measured as the largest dollar amount of that position that is more likely than not to be sustained upon settlement. The difference between the benefit recognized for a position in this model and the tax benefit claimed on a tax return is treated as an unrecognized tax benefit. The Company recognizes income tax related interest and penalties in other non-interest expense.

 

p) Income per share —The Company applies the two-class method of computing income per share as certain of the Company's restricted shares are entitled to non-forfeitable dividends and are therefore considered to be a class of participating securities. The two-class method allocates income according to dividends declared and participation rights in undistributed income. Basic income per share is computed by dividing income allocated to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during each period. Diluted income per common share is computed by dividing income allocated to common shareholders by the weighted average common shares outstanding during the period, plus amounts representing the dilutive effect of stock options outstanding, certain unvested restricted shares, warrants to issue common stock, or other contracts to issue common shares (“common stock equivalents”) using the treasury stock method. Common stock equivalents are excluded from the computation of diluted earnings per common share in periods in which they have an anti-dilutive effect.

 

q) Interest Rate Swap Derivatives —The Company carries all derivatives on the statement of financial condition at fair value. All derivative instruments are recognized as either assets or liabilities depending on the rights or obligations under the contracts. All gains and losses on the derivatives due to changes in fair value are recognized in earnings each period.

 

The Company offers interest rate swap products to certain of its clients to manage potential changes in interest rates. Each contract between the Company and a client is offset with a contract between the Company and an institutional counterparty, thus minimizing the Company's exposure to rate changes. The Company's portfolio consists of a “matched book,” and as such, changes in fair value of the swap pairs will largely offset in earnings. In accordance with applicable accounting guidance, if certain conditions are met, a derivative may be designated as (1) a hedge of the exposure to changes in the fair value of a recognized asset or liability, or of an unrecognized firm commitment, that are attributable to a particular risk (referred to as a fair value hedge) or (2) a hedge of the exposure to variability in the cash flows of a recognized asset or liability, or of a forecasted transaction, that is attributable to a particular risk (referred to as a cash flow hedge). The Company documents all hedging relationships at the inception of each hedging relationship and uses industry accepted methodologies and ranges to determine the effectiveness of each hedge. The fair value of the hedged item is calculated using the estimated future cash flows of the hedged item and applying discount rates equal to the market interest rate for the hedged item at the inception of the hedging relationship (inception benchmark interest rate plus an inception credit spread), adjusted for changes in the designated benchmark interest rate thereafter.

88


 

 

 

r) Treasury stock —When the Company acquires treasury stock, the sum of the consideration paid and direct transaction costs after tax is recognized as a deduction from equity. The cost basis for the reissuance of treasury stock is determined using a first-in, first-out basis. To the extent that the reissuance price is more than the cost basis (gain), the excess is recorded as an increase to additional paid-in capital in the consolidated statements of financial condition. If the reissuance price is less than the cost basis (loss), the difference is recorded to additional paid-in capital to the extent there is a cumulative treasury stock paid-in capital balance. Any loss in excess of the cumulative treasury stock paid-in capital balance is charged to retained earnings.  

 

Note 3 Recent Accounting Pronouncements

 

Revenue from Contracts with Customers —In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers . This update supersedes revenue recognition requirements in ASC Topic 605, Revenue Recognition , including most industry-specific revenue recognition guidance in the FASB Accounting Standards Codification. The new guidance stipulates that an entity should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services. The guidance provides specific steps that entities should apply in order to achieve this principle. The amendments are effective for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2017, with early application permitted for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2016. ASU No. 2014-09 allows for either full retrospective or modified retrospective adoption. The Company is in the process of evaluating the impact of the ASU's adoption on the Company's consolidated financial statements, if any. The Company will adopt ASU 2014-09 in the first quarter of 2018 and expects to apply the modified retrospective approach.

 

Leases —In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-02, Leases. The guidance in ASU 2016-02 supersedes the lease recognition requirements in ASC Topic 840, Leases . The new standard establishes a right-of-use (ROU) model that requires a lessee to record a ROU asset and lease liability on the balance sheet for all leases with terms longer than 12 months. Leases will be classified as either finance or operating, with classification affecting the pattern of expense recognition in the income statements. The new standard is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2018, including interim periods within those fiscal years, with early adoption permitted. A modified retrospective transition approach is required for lessees for capital and operating leases existing at, or entered into after, the beginning of the earliest comparative period presented in the financial statements. Early adoption of the amendments in the update is permitted. The Company will adopt ASU 2016-02 in the first quarter of 2019 and is currently in the process of evaluating the impact of the ASU's adoption on the Company's consolidated financial statements .  

 

Financial Instruments - Credit Losses —In June 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-13, Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments . This update replaces the current incurred loss methodology for recognizing credit losses with a current expected credit loss model, which requires the measurement of all expected credit losses for financial assets held at the reporting date based on historical experience, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. This amendment broadens the information that an entity must consider in developing its expected credit loss estimates. Additionally, the update amends the accounting for credit losses for available-for-sale debt securities and purchased financial assets with a more-than-insignificant amount of credit deterioration since origination. This update requires enhanced disclosures to help investors and other financial statement users better understand significant estimates and judgments used in estimating credit losses, as well as the credit quality and underwriting standards of a company’s loan portfolio. The amendments in this update are effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2019, including interim periods within those fiscal years. Early adoption in fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2018 is permitted. The amendment requires the use of the modified retrospective approach for adoption. The Company is in the process of evaluating the impact of the ASU’s adoption on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

The Company reviewed ASU 2016-01, Financial Instruments - Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities (Topic 825), ASU 2016-15, Statement of Cash Flows: Classification of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payment s and ASU 2017-04, Intangibles - Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): Simplifying the Test for Goodwill Impairment and does not expect the adoption of these pronouncements to have a material impact on its financial statements.

 

 

89


 

 

Note 4 Investment Securities

 

The Company’s investment securities portfolio is comprised of available-for-sale and held-to-maturity investment securities. These investment securities totaled $1.2 billion at December 31, 2016 and were comprised of $0.9 billion of available-for-sale securities and $0.3 billion of held-to-maturity securities. At December 31, 2015, investment securities totaled $1.6 billion and included $1.2 billion of available-for-sale securities and $0.4 billion of held-to-maturity securities.

 

Available-for-sale

 

At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Company held $0.9 billion and $1.2 billion of available-for-sale investment securities, respectively. Available-for-sale securities are summarized as follows as of the dates indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

    

Amortized

    

Gross

    

Gross

    

 

 

 

 

cost

 

unrealized gains

 

unrealized losses

 

Fair value

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

223,781

 

$

3,909

 

$

(530)

 

$

227,160

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

666,616

 

 

2,124

 

 

(16,001)

 

 

652,739

Municipal securities

 

 

3,921

 

 

 —

 

 

(7)

 

 

3,914

Other securities

 

 

419

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

419

Total investment securities available-for-sale

 

$

894,737

 

$

6,033

 

$

(16,538)

 

$

884,232

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

    

Amortized

    

Gross

    

Gross

    

 

 

 

 

cost

 

unrealized gains

 

unrealized losses

 

Fair value

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

305,773

 

$

5,721

 

$

(516)

 

$

310,978

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

861,321

 

 

3,638

 

 

(19,416)

 

 

845,543

Municipal securities

 

 

306

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

306

Other securities

 

 

419

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

419

Total investment securities available-for-sale

 

$

1,167,819

 

$

9,359

 

$

(19,932)

 

$

1,157,246

 

At December 31, 2016 and 2015, mortgage-backed securities represented primarily all of the Company’s available-for-sale investment portfolio and all mortgage-backed securities were backed by government sponsored enterprises (“GSE”) collateral such as Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (“FHLMC”) and Federal National Mortgage Association (“FNMA”), and the government sponsored agency Government National Mortgage Association (“GNMA”).

 

90


 

 

The table below summarizes the available-for-sale investment securities with unrealized losses as of the dates shown, along with the length of the impairment period:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

 

Less than 12 months

 

12 months or more

 

Total

 

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

 

 

value

 

losses

 

value

 

losses

 

value

 

losses

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

100,898

 

$

(530)

 

$

 —

 

$

 —

 

$

100,898

 

$

(530)

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

137,576

 

 

(2,976)

 

 

385,707

 

 

(13,025)

 

 

523,283

 

 

(16,001)

Municipal securities

 

 

3,058

 

 

(7)

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

3,058

 

 

(7)

Total

 

$

241,532

 

$

(3,513)

 

$

385,707

 

$

(13,025)

 

$

627,239

 

$

(16,538)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

Less than 12 months

 

12 months or more

 

Total

 

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

 

 

value

 

losses

 

value

 

losses

 

value

 

losses

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

109,182

 

$

(516)

 

$

 —

 

$

 —

 

$

109,182

 

$

(516)

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

67,527

 

 

(404)

 

 

575,954

 

 

(19,012)

 

 

643,481

 

 

(19,416)

Total

 

$

176,709

 

$

(920)

 

$

575,954

 

$

(19,012)

 

$

752,663

 

$

(19,932)

 

Management evaluated all of the available-for-sale securities in an unrealized loss position and concluded that no OTTI existed at December 31, 2016 or December 31, 2015. The unrealized losses in the Company's investments issued or guaranteed by U.S. government agencies or sponsored enterprises at December 31, 2016 were caused by changes in interest rates. The portfolio included 61 securities, having an aggregate fair value of $627.2 million, which were in an unrealized loss position at December 31, 2016, compared to 66 securities, with an aggregate fair value of $752.7 million at December 31, 2015. The Company has no intention to sell these securities before recovery of their amortized cost and believes it will not be required to sell the securities before the recovery of their amortized cost.

 

Certain securities are pledged as collateral for public deposits, securities sold under agreements to repurchase and to secure borrowing capacity at the Federal Reserve Bank, and the Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”), if needed. The fair value of available-for-sale investment securities pledged as collateral totaled $373.7 million and $335.8 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. The increase in pledged available-for-sale investment securities was primarily attributable to an increase in average deposit account balances and client repurchase account balances during 2016. Certain investment securities may also be pledged as collateral for the line of credit at the FHLB of Topeka; however, no investment securities were pledged for this purpose at December 31, 2016 or December 31, 2015.

 

Mortgage-backed securities do not have a single maturity date and actual maturities may differ from contractual maturities depending on the repayment characteristics and experience of the underlying financial instruments. The estimated weighted average life of the available-for-sale mortgage-backed securities portfolio was 3.4 years and 3.6 years at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. This estimate is based on assumptions and actual results may differ. At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the duration of the total available-for-sale investment portfolio was 3.2 years and 3.4 years, respectively.

 

As of December 31, 2016, municipal securities with an amortized cost and fair value of $3.3 million were due after one year through five years, while municipal securities with an amortized cost and fair value of $0.6 million were due after five years through ten years. Other securities of $0.4 million as of December 31, 2016, have no stated contractual maturity date.

 

91


 

 

Held-to-maturity

 

At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Company held $332.5 million and $427.5 million of held-to-maturity investment securities, respectively. Held-to-maturity investment securities are summarized as follows as of the dates indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

    

 

 

    

Gross

    

Gross

    

 

 

 

 

Amortized

 

unrealized

 

unrealized

 

 

 

 

 

cost

 

gains

 

losses

 

Fair value

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

263,411

 

$

1,685

 

$

(234)

 

$

264,862

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

69,094

 

 

16

 

 

(1,399)

 

 

67,711

Total investment securities held-to-maturity

 

$

332,505

 

$

1,701

 

$

(1,633)

 

$

332,573

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

    

 

 

    

Gross

    

Gross

    

 

 

 

 

Amortized

 

unrealized

 

unrealized

 

 

 

 

 

cost

 

gains

 

losses

 

Fair value

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

340,131

 

$

2,911

 

$

(230)

 

$

342,812

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

87,372

 

 

35

 

 

(1,634)

 

 

85,773

Total investment securities held-to-maturity

 

$

427,503

 

$

2,946

 

$

(1,864)

 

$

428,585

 

The table below summarizes the held-to-maturity investment securities with unrealized losses as of the dates shown, along with the length of the impairment period:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

 

Less than 12 months

 

12 months or more

 

Total

 

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

 

 

Value

 

Losses

 

Value

 

Losses

 

Value

 

Losses

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

27,799

 

$

(234)

 

$

 —

 

$

 —

 

$

27,799

 

$

(234)

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

26,992

 

 

(357)

 

 

32,146

 

 

(1,042)

 

 

59,138

 

 

(1,399)

Total

 

$

54,791

 

$

(591)

 

$

32,146

 

$

(1,042)

 

$

86,937

 

$

(1,633)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

Less than 12 months

 

12 months or more

 

Total

 

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

    

Fair

    

Unrealized

 

 

Value

 

Losses

 

Value

 

Losses

 

Value

 

Losses

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

34,641

 

$

(205)

 

$

853

 

$

(25)

 

$

35,494

 

$

(230)

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

28,490

 

 

(180)

 

 

45,872

 

 

(1,454)

 

 

74,362

 

 

(1,634)

Total

 

$

63,131

 

$

(385)

 

$

46,725

 

$

(1,479)

 

$

109,856

 

$

(1,864)

 

92


 

 

The held-to-maturity portfolio included 15 securities, having an aggregate fair value of $86.9 million, which were in an unrealized loss position at December 31, 2016, compared to 16 securities, with a fair value of $109.9 million, at December 31, 2015.

 

Management evaluated all of the held-to-maturity securities in an unrealized loss position and concluded that no OTTI existed at December 31, 2016 or December 31, 2015. The unrealized losses in the Company's investments issued or guaranteed by U.S. government agencies or sponsored enterprises at December 31, 2016, were caused by changes in interest rates.  The Company has no intention to sell these securities before recovery of their amortized cost and believes it will not be required to sell the securities before the recovery of their amortized cost.

 

The carrying value of held-to-maturity investment securities pledged as collateral totaled $119.2 million and $156.5 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. 

 

Actual maturities of mortgage-backed securities may differ from scheduled maturities depending on the repayment characteristics and experience of the underlying financial instruments. The estimated weighted average expected life of the held-to-maturity mortgage-backed securities portfolio as of December 31, 2016 and 2015 was 3.5 years and 3.7 years, respectively. This estimate is based on assumptions and actual results may differ. The duration of the total held-to-maturity investment portfolio was 3.2 years and 3.4 years as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

 

Note 5 Non-marketable Securities

 

Non-marketable securities include Federal Reserve Bank stock, FHLB stock and non-negotiable certificates of deposit. At December 31, 2016, the Company held $9.2 million of Federal Reserve Bank stock, $5.2 million of FHLB stock for regulatory or debt facility purposes and $0.5 million of non-negotiable certificates of deposit acquired as part of the Pine River acquisition. At December 31, 2015, the Company held $14.1 million of Federal Reserve Bank stock, $7.4 million of FHLB stock and $1.0 million of non-negotiable certificates of deposit acquired from the Pine River acquisition.

 

These are restricted securities which, lacking a market, are carried at cost. There have been no identified events or changes in circumstances that may have an adverse effect on the investments carried at cost. Management evaluated all of the non-marketable securities and concluded that no OTTI existed at December 31, 2016 or December 31, 2015.

 

Note 6 Loans

 

The loan portfolio is comprised of loans originated by the Company and loans that were acquired in connection with the Company’s acquisitions.

 

The table below shows the loan portfolio composition including carrying value by segment of loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 and loans not accounted for under this guidance, which includes our originated loans. The carrying value of loans is net of discounts on loans excluded from ASC 310-30, and fees and costs of $6.3 million and $8.1 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. At December 31, 2016, $14.4 million of non 310-30 loans were held-for-sale, most of which were in the residential real estate segment.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

    

ASC 310-30 loans

    

Non 310-30 loans

    

Total loans

    

% of total

Commercial

 

$

39,280

 

$

1,521,150

 

$

1,560,430

 

54.6%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

89,150

 

 

437,642

 

 

526,792

 

18.4%

Residential real estate

 

 

16,524

 

 

728,361

 

 

744,885

 

26.0%

Consumer

 

 

898

 

 

27,916

 

 

28,814

 

1.0%

Total

 

$

145,852

 

$

2,715,069

 

$

2,860,921

 

100.0%

 

 

93


 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

    

ASC 310-30 loans

    

Non 310-30 loans

    

Total loans

    

% of total

Commercial

 

$

57,474

 

$

1,369,946

 

$

1,427,420

 

55.2%

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

121,173

 

 

321,712

 

 

442,885

 

17.1%

Residential real estate

 

 

21,452

 

 

662,550

 

 

684,002

 

26.4%

Consumer

 

 

2,731

 

 

30,635

 

 

33,366

 

1.3%

Total

 

$

202,830

 

$

2,384,843

 

$

2,587,673

 

100.0%

 

Delinquency for loans excluded from ASC 310-30 is shown in the following tables at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Greater

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

Loans > 90

 

 

 

 

 

30-59

 

60-89

 

than 90

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

non

 

days past

 

 

 

 

 

days  past

 

days past

 

days past

 

Total  past

 

 

 

 

310-30

 

due and

 

Non-

 

 

due

 

due

 

due

 

due

 

Current

 

loans

 

still accruing

 

accrual

Loans excluded from ASC 310-30:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

3,134

 

$

4,009

 

$

1,078

 

$

8,221

 

$

1,066,475

 

$

1,074,696

 

$

 —

 

$

8,688

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

583

 

 

216

 

 

56

 

 

855

 

 

220,689

 

 

221,544

 

 

 —

 

 

2,056

Agriculture

 

 

501

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

501

 

 

134,136

 

 

134,637

 

 

 —

 

 

1,905

Energy

 

 

2

 

 

 —

 

 

6,548

 

 

6,550

 

 

83,723

 

 

90,273

 

 

 —

 

 

12,645

Total Commercial

 

 

4,220

 

 

4,225

 

 

7,682

 

 

16,127

 

 

1,505,023

 

 

1,521,150

 

 

 —

 

 

25,294

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

90,314

 

 

90,314

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Acquisition/development

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

13,306

 

 

13,306

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Multifamily

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

24,954

 

 

24,954

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Non-owner occupied

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

28

 

 

28

 

 

309,040

 

 

309,068

 

 

 —

 

 

66

Total commercial real estate

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

28

 

 

28

 

 

437,614

 

 

437,642

 

 

 —

 

 

66

Residential real estate:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Senior lien

 

 

888

 

 

645

 

 

1,458

 

 

2,991

 

 

672,699

 

 

675,690

 

 

 —

 

 

4,522

Junior lien

 

 

115

 

 

61

 

 

22

 

 

198

 

 

52,473

 

 

52,671

 

 

 —

 

 

654

Total residential real estate

 

 

1,003

 

 

706

 

 

1,480

 

 

3,189

 

 

725,172

 

 

728,361

 

 

 —

 

 

5,176

Consumer

 

 

83

 

 

8

 

 

 —

 

 

91

 

 

27,825

 

 

27,916

 

 

 —

 

 

181

Total loans excluded from ASC 310-30

 

$

5,306

 

$

4,939

 

$

9,190

 

$

19,435

 

$

2,695,634

 

$

2,715,069

 

$

 —

 

$

30,717

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Greater

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

Loans > 90

 

 

 

 

 

30-59

 

60-89

 

than 90

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

non

 

days past

 

 

 

 

 

days past

 

days past

 

days past

 

Total  past

 

 

 

 

310-30

 

due and

 

Non-

 

 

due

 

due

 

due

 

due

 

Current

 

loans

 

still accruing

 

accrual

Loans excluded from ASC 310-30:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

2,252

 

$

238

 

$

49

 

$

2,539

 

$

890,350

 

$

892,889

 

$

 —

 

$

4,830

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

370

 

 

111

 

 

66

 

 

547

 

 

184,072

 

 

184,619

 

 

 —

 

 

1,273

Agriculture

 

 

441

 

 

58

 

 

1,222

 

 

1,721

 

 

143,837

 

 

145,558

 

 

 —

 

 

1,984

Energy

 

 

23

 

 

5,781

 

 

 —

 

 

5,804

 

 

141,076

 

 

146,880

 

 

 —

 

 

12,008

Total Commercial

 

 

3,086

 

 

6,188

 

 

1,337

 

 

10,611

 

 

1,359,335

 

 

1,369,946

 

 

 —

 

 

20,095

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction

 

 

359

 

 

188

 

 

 —

 

 

547

 

 

29,596

 

 

30,143

 

 

 —

 

 

188

Acquisition/development

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

5,575

 

 

5,575

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Multifamily

 

 

 —

 

 

38

 

 

22

 

 

60

 

 

9,813

 

 

9,873

 

 

 —

 

 

22

Non-owner occupied

 

 

2,340

 

 

182

 

 

968

 

 

3,490

 

 

272,631

 

 

276,121

 

 

 —

 

 

1,013

Total commercial real estate

 

 

2,699

 

 

408

 

 

990

 

 

4,097

 

 

317,615

 

 

321,712

 

 

 —

 

 

1,223

Residential real estate:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Senior lien

 

 

1,909

 

 

911

 

 

1,481

 

 

4,301

 

 

610,192

 

 

614,493

 

 

124

 

 

3,713

Junior lien

 

 

299

 

 

237

 

 

194

 

 

730

 

 

47,327

 

 

48,057

 

 

6

 

 

584

Total residential real estate

 

 

2,208

 

 

1,148

 

 

1,675

 

 

5,031

 

 

657,519

 

 

662,550

 

 

130

 

 

4,297

Consumer

 

 

239

 

 

26

 

 

38

 

 

303

 

 

30,332

 

 

30,635

 

 

36

 

 

32

Total loans excluded from ASC 310-30

 

$

8,232

 

$

7,770

 

$

4,040

 

$

20,042

 

$

2,364,801

 

$

2,384,843

 

$

166

 

$

25,647

 

 

94


 

 

Loans are considered past due or delinquent when the contractual principal or interest due in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement remains unpaid after the due date of the scheduled payment. Pooled loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 that are 90 days or more past due and still accreting are generally considered to be performing and are included in loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing. Non-accrual loans include troubled debt restructurings on non-accrual status.

 

Non-accrual loans excluded from the scope of ASC 310-30 totaled $30.7 million at December 31, 2016, representing an increase of $5.1 million, or 19.8%, from December 31, 2015. The increase was driven by activity within the commercial and industrial and energy sectors. Non-performing loans within the commercial and industrial sector increased $3.9 million from December 31, 2015, largely due to two loan relationships totaling $6.6 million at December 31, 2016, offset by charge-offs throughout the year. Non-performing energy loans totaled $12.6 million at December 31, 2016, representing an increase of $0.6 million from December 31, 2015. The increase was due to three energy loan relationships totaling $12.6 million at December 31, 2016 that were placed on non-accrual during 2016, mostly offset by two loan relationships resolved and charged-off during 2016.

 

Credit exposure for all loans as determined by the Company’s internal risk rating system was as follows at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

    

 

 

    

Special

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

Pass

 

mention

 

Substandard

 

Doubtful

 

Total

Loans excluded from ASC 310-30:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

1,041,326

 

$

7,243

 

$

25,636

 

$

491

 

$

1,074,696

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

202,036

 

 

9,371

 

 

10,137

 

 

 —

 

 

221,544

Agriculture

 

 

123,809

 

 

8,922

 

 

1,906

 

 

 —

 

 

134,637

Energy

 

 

77,619

 

 

 —

 

 

7,811

 

 

4,843

 

 

90,273

Total Commercial

 

 

1,444,790

 

 

25,536

 

 

45,490

 

 

5,334

 

 

1,521,150

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction

 

 

90,099

 

 

 —

 

 

215

 

 

 —

 

 

90,314

Acquisition/development

 

 

10,758

 

 

2,548

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

13,306

Multifamily

 

 

22,495

 

 

238

 

 

2,221

 

 

 —

 

 

24,954

Non-owner occupied

 

 

300,922

 

 

5,895

 

 

2,251

 

 

 —

 

 

309,068

Total commercial real estate

 

 

424,274

 

 

8,681

 

 

4,687

 

 

 —

 

 

437,642

Residential real estate:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Senior lien

 

 

669,148

 

 

1,215

 

 

5,316

 

 

11

 

 

675,690

Junior lien

 

 

51,250

 

 

178

 

 

1,243

 

 

 —

 

 

52,671

Total residential real estate

 

 

720,398

 

 

1,393

 

 

6,559

 

 

11

 

 

728,361

Consumer

 

 

27,669

 

 

59

 

 

188

 

 

 —

 

 

27,916

Total loans excluded from ASC 310-30

 

$

2,617,131

 

$

35,669

 

$

56,924

 

$

5,345

 

$

2,715,069

Loans accounted for under ASC 310-30:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

$

27,436

 

$

610

 

$

11,234

 

$

 —

 

$

39,280

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

38,895

 

 

967

 

 

45,520

 

 

3,768

 

 

89,150

Residential real estate

 

 

12,477

 

 

1,327

 

 

2,720

 

 

 —

 

 

16,524

Consumer

 

 

721

 

 

17

 

 

160

 

 

 —

 

 

898

Total loans accounted for under ASC 310-30

 

$

79,529

 

$

2,921

 

$

59,634

 

$

3,768

 

$

145,852

Total loans

 

$

2,696,660

 

$

38,590

 

$

116,558

 

$

9,113

 

$

2,860,921

 

 

95


 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

    

 

 

    

Special

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

Pass

 

mention

 

Substandard

 

Doubtful

 

Total

Loans excluded from ASC 310-30:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

865,840

 

$

8,363

 

$

16,769

 

$

1,917

 

$

892,889

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

174,108

 

 

5,595

 

 

4,916

 

 

 —

 

 

184,619

Agriculture

 

 

132,450

 

 

2,440

 

 

10,668

 

 

 —

 

 

145,558

Energy

 

 

92,152

 

 

36,503

 

 

16,098

 

 

2,127

 

 

146,880

Total Commercial

 

 

1,264,550

 

 

52,901

 

 

48,451

 

 

4,044

 

 

1,369,946

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction

 

 

24,686

 

 

4,882

 

 

575

 

 

 —

 

 

30,143

Acquisition/development

 

 

5,066

 

 

509

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

5,575

Multifamily

 

 

9,851

 

 

 —

 

 

22

 

 

 —

 

 

9,873

Non-owner occupied

 

 

262,035

 

 

8,091

 

 

5,722

 

 

273

 

 

276,121

Total commercial real estate

 

 

301,638

 

 

13,482

 

 

6,319

 

 

273

 

 

321,712

Residential real estate:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Senior lien

 

 

609,196

 

 

349

 

 

4,921

 

 

27

 

 

614,493

Junior lien

 

 

46,437

 

 

252

 

 

1,368

 

 

 —

 

 

48,057

Total residential real estate

 

 

655,633

 

 

601

 

 

6,289

 

 

27

 

 

662,550

Consumer

 

 

30,483

 

 

67

 

 

85

 

 

 —

 

 

30,635

Total loans excluded from ASC 310-30

 

$

2,252,304

 

$

67,051

 

$

61,144

 

$

4,344

 

$

2,384,843

Loans accounted for under ASC 310-30:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

$

35,384

 

$

787

 

$

21,303

 

$

 —

 

$

57,474

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

49,817

 

 

352

 

 

67,235

 

 

3,769

 

 

121,173

Residential real estate

 

 

16,960

 

 

1,604

 

 

2,888

 

 

 —

 

 

21,452

Consumer

 

 

2,296

 

 

94

 

 

341

 

 

 —

 

 

2,731

Total loans accounted for under ASC 310-30

 

$

104,457

 

$

2,837

 

$

91,767

 

$

3,769

 

$

202,830

Total loans

 

$

2,356,761

 

$

69,888

 

$

152,911

 

$

8,113

 

$

2,587,673

 

The Company’s substandard energy loans excluded from ASC 310-30 decreased $8.3 million from December 31, 2015, due to charge-offs of $9.9 million from two loan relationships in 2016, partially offset by one energy loan relationship totaling $3.2 million that was downgraded from special mention during 2016. Non 310-30 substandard loans within the commercial and industrial sector increased $8.9 million from December 31, 2015, primarily due to downgrades of two loan relationships totaling $7.7 million during 2016. Non 310-30 substandard loans within the agriculture sector decreased $8.8 million from December 31, 2015, due to a pay-off of one loan relationship totaling $8.4 million during 2016. Non 310-30 special mention loans within the owner occupied commercial real estate sector increased $3.8 million from December 31, 2015, due to a downgrade of one loan relationship totaling $4.3 million during 2016, partially offset by other net decreases of $0.5 million. Non 310-30 special mention loans within the agriculture sector increased $6.5 million from December 31, 2015, due to one loan relationship totaling $8.9 million downgraded to special mention during 2016, partially offset by a downgrade to substandard of one loan relationship totaling $1.6 million at December 31, 2015 and other decreases of $0.9 million during 2016.

 

Impaired Loans

 

Loans are considered to be impaired when it is probable that the Company will not be able to collect all amounts due in accordance with the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Impaired loans are comprised of loans excluded from ASC 310-30 on non-accrual status, loans in bankruptcy, and troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”) described below. If a specific allowance is warranted based on the borrower’s overall financial condition, the specific allowance is calculated based on discounted cash flows using the loan’s initial contractual effective interest rate or the fair value of the collateral less selling costs for collateral dependent loans. At December 31, 2016, the Company measured $28.2 million of impaired loans based on the fair value of the collateral less selling costs and $2.3 million of impaired loans using discounted cash flows and the loan’s initial contractual effective interest rate. Impaired loans totaling $7.8 million that individually were less than $250 thousand each, were measured through our general ALL reserves due to their relatively small size.

 

At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Company’s recorded investment in impaired loans was $38.3 million and $37.4 million, respectively. Impaired loans at December 31, 2016 were primarily comprised of eight relationships totaling $25.3 million. Four of the relationships were in the commercial and industrial sector, three of the relationships were in the energy sector and one relationship was in the agriculture sector. Impaired loans had a collective related allowance for loan losses allocated to them of $2.4 million and $4.4 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

 

96


 

 

Additional information regarding impaired loans at December 31, 2016 and 2015 is set forth in the table below:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

    

 

 

 

 

 

    

Allowance

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Allowance

 

 

Unpaid

 

 

 

 

for loan

 

Unpaid

 

 

 

 

for loan

 

 

principal

 

Recorded

 

losses

 

principal

 

Recorded

 

losses

 

 

balance

 

investment

 

allocated

 

balance

 

investment

 

allocated

With no related allowance recorded:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

8,671

 

$

7,495

 

$

 —

 

$

4,997

 

$

4,995

 

$

 —

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

3,350

 

 

3,197

 

 

 —

 

 

2,218

 

 

2,150

 

 

 —

Agriculture

 

 

2,044

 

 

1,987

 

 

 —

 

 

1,877

 

 

1,878

 

 

 —

Energy

 

 

17,142

 

 

6,105

 

 

 —

 

 

5,815

 

 

5,749

 

 

 —

Total commercial

 

 

31,207

 

 

18,784

 

 

 —

 

 

14,907

 

 

14,772

 

 

 —

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

190

 

 

188

 

 

 —

Acquisition/development

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Multifamily

 

 

33

 

 

33

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Non-owner occupied

 

 

394

 

 

343

 

 

 —

 

 

154

 

 

153

 

 

 —

Total commercial real estate

 

 

427

 

 

376

 

 

 —

 

 

344

 

 

341

 

 

 —

Residential real estate:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Senior lien

 

 

1,551

 

 

1,426

 

 

 —

 

 

947

 

 

941

 

 

 —

Junior lien

 

 

54

 

 

51

 

 

 —

 

 

113

 

 

112

 

 

 —

Total residential real estate

 

 

1,605

 

 

1,477

 

 

 —

 

 

1,060

 

 

1,052

 

 

 —

Consumer

 

 

4

 

 

4

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Total impaired loans with no related allowance recorded

 

$

33,243

 

$

20,641

 

$

 —

 

$

16,311

 

$

16,165

 

$

 —

With a related allowance recorded:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

3,495

 

$

3,464

 

$

492

 

$

4,537

 

$

4,503

 

$

1,918

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

957

 

 

642

 

 

2

 

 

1,272

 

 

1,117

 

 

2

Agriculture

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

254

 

 

248

 

 

1

Energy

 

 

11,216

 

 

6,548

 

 

1,866

 

 

6,279

 

 

6,260

 

 

2,127

Total commercial

 

 

15,668

 

 

10,654

 

 

2,360

 

 

12,342

 

 

12,128

 

 

4,048

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Acquisition/development

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Multifamily

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

61

 

 

59

 

 

 —

Non-owner occupied

 

 

261

 

 

255

 

 

1

 

 

1,642

 

 

1,630

 

 

274

Total commercial real estate

 

 

261

 

 

255

 

 

1

 

 

1,703

 

 

1,689

 

 

274

Residential real estate:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Senior lien

 

 

5,646

 

 

5,016

 

 

31

 

 

5,827

 

 

5,701

 

 

54

Junior lien

 

 

1,781

 

 

1,532

 

 

14

 

 

1,800

 

 

1,593

 

 

11

Total residential real estate

 

 

7,427

 

 

6,548

 

 

45

 

 

7,627

 

 

7,294

 

 

65

Consumer

 

 

188

 

 

184

 

 

2

 

 

86

 

 

86

 

 

1

Total impaired loans with a related allowance recorded

 

$

23,544

 

$

17,641

 

$

2,408

 

$

21,758

 

$

21,198

 

$

4,388

Total impaired loans

 

$

56,787

 

$

38,282

 

$

2,408

 

$

38,069

 

$

37,363

 

$

4,388

 

97


 

 

The table below shows additional information regarding the average recorded investment and interest income recognized on impaired loans for the periods presented:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the years ended

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

December 31, 2014

 

 

Average
recorded
investment

    

Interest
income
recognized

    

Average
recorded
investment

    

Interest
income
recognized

 

Average
recorded
investment

    

Interest
income
recognized

With no related allowance recorded:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

7,909

 

$

252

 

$

5,049

 

$

266

 

$

21,827

 

$

414

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

3,249

 

 

92

 

 

2,221

 

 

83

 

 

1,018

 

 

51

Agriculture

 

 

1,830

 

 

 —

 

 

1,961

 

 

 —

 

 

3,458

 

 

126

Energy

 

 

12,565

 

 

 —

 

 

5,679

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Total Commercial

 

 

25,553

 

 

344

 

 

14,910

 

 

349

 

 

26,303

 

 

591

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

188

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Acquisition/development

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Multifamily

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Non-owner occupied

 

 

368

 

 

22

 

 

157

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Total commercial real estate

 

 

368

 

 

22

 

 

345

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Residential real estate:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Senior lien

 

 

1,466

 

 

19

 

 

956

 

 

15

 

 

605

 

 

7

Junior lien

 

 

54

 

 

2

 

 

113

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Total residential real estate

 

 

1,520

 

 

21

 

 

1,069

 

 

15

 

 

605

 

 

7

Consumer

 

 

4

 

 

 —

 

 

 

 

 —

 

 

 

 

 —

Total impaired loans with no related allowance recorded

 

$

27,445

 

$

387

 

$

16,324

 

$

363

 

$

26,908

 

$

598

With a related allowance recorded:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

$

3,545

 

$

198

 

$

6,273

 

$

1

 

$

893

 

$

7

Owner occupied commercial real estate

 

 

703

 

 

20

 

 

1,230

 

 

27

 

 

1,166

 

 

40

Agriculture

 

 

162

 

 

5

 

 

276

 

 

4

 

 

158

 

 

 —

Energy

 

 

10,008

 

 

 —

 

 

3,092

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Total Commercial

 

 

14,418

 

 

223

 

 

10,871

 

 

32

 

 

2,217

 

 

47

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Construction

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Acquisition/development

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Multifamily

 

 

34

 

 

2

 

 

60

 

 

1

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Non-owner occupied

 

 

268

 

 

13

 

 

1,667

 

 

48

 

 

1,095

 

 

56

Total commercial real estate

 

 

302

 

 

15

 

 

1,727

 

 

49

 

 

1,095

 

 

56

Residential real estate:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Senior lien

 

 

5,200

 

 

88

 

 

5,911

 

 

119

 

 

6,594

 

 

101

Junior lien

 

 

1,600

 

 

56

 

 

1,725

 

 

51

 

 

1,568

 

 

60

Total residential real estate

 

 

6,800

 

 

144

 

 

7,636

 

 

170

 

 

8,162

 

 

161

Consumer

 

 

196

 

 

 —

 

 

92

 

 

1

 

 

265

 

 

1

Total impaired loans with a related allowance recorded

 

$

21,716

 

$

382

 

$

20,326

 

$

252

 

$

11,739

 

$

265

Total impaired loans

 

$

49,161

 

$

769

 

$

36,650

 

$

615

 

$

38,647

 

$

863

 

Interest income recognized on impaired loans noted in the table above, primarily represents interest earned on accruing troubled debt restructurings. Interest income recognized on impaired loans using the cash-basis method of accounting during the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 was immaterial. 

98


 

 

 

Troubled debt restructurings

 

It is the Company’s policy to review each prospective credit in order to determine the appropriateness and the adequacy of security or collateral prior to making a loan. In the event of borrower default, the Company seeks recovery in compliance with lending laws, the respective loan agreements, and credit monitoring and remediation procedures that may include restructuring a loan to provide a concession by the Company to the borrower from their original terms due to borrower financial difficulties in order to facilitate repayment. Additionally, if a borrower’s repayment obligation has been discharged by a court, and that debt has not been reaffirmed by the borrower, regardless of past due status, the loan is considered to be a TDR. At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Company had $5.8 million and $8.4 million, respectively, of accruing TDRs that had been restructured from the original terms in order to facilitate repayment.

 

Non-accruing TDRs at December 31, 2016 and 2015 totaled $16.7 million and $17.8 million, respectively.

 

During 2016, the Company restructured 17 loans with a recorded investment of $ 12.3 million at December 31, 2016 to facilitate repayment. Substantially all of the loan modifications were a reduction of the principal payment, a reduction in interest rate, or an extension of term. Loan modifications to loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 are not considered TDRs. The table below provides additional information related to accruing TDRs at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

 

Recorded

 

Average year-to-date

 

Unpaid

 

Unfunded commitments

 

 

investment

 

recorded investments

 

principal balance

 

to fund TDRs

Commercial

 

$

3,302

 

$

3,440

 

$

3,464

 

$

100

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

538

 

 

572

 

 

590

 

 

 —

Residential real estate

 

 

1,920

 

 

1,996

 

 

1,969

 

 

2

Consumer

 

 

7

 

 

9

 

 

7

 

 

 —

Total

 

$

5,767

 

$

6,017

 

$

6,030

 

$

102

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

Recorded

 

Average year-to-date

 

Unpaid

 

Unfunded commitments

 

 

investment

 

recorded investments

 

principal balance

 

to fund TDRs

Commercial

 

$

5,874

 

$

5,951

 

$

5,918

 

$

163

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

388

 

 

394

 

 

389

 

 

 —

Residential real estate

 

 

2,162

 

 

2,234

 

 

2,166

 

 

2

Consumer

 

 

12

 

 

15

 

 

12

 

 

 —

Total

 

$

8,436

 

$

8,594

 

$

8,485

 

$

165

 

The following table summarizes the Company’s carrying value of non-accrual TDRs as of December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

Commercial

    

$

15,265

    

$

16,297

Commercial real estate non-owner occupied

 

 

 —

 

 

816

Residential real estate

 

 

1,301

 

 

678

Consumer

 

 

142

 

 

2

Total non-accruing TDRs

 

$

16,708

 

$

17,793

 

Accrual of interest is resumed on loans that were on non-accrual only after the loan has performed sufficiently. The Company had five TDRs that were modified within the past twelve months and had defaulted on their restructured terms. The defaulted TDRs consisted of two commercial loans totaling $6.4 million, and three residential totaling loans $0.4 million. The allowance for loan losses related to troubled debt restructurings on non-accrual status is determined by individual evaluation, including collateral adequacy, using the same process as loans on non-accrual status which are not classified as troubled debt restructurings. 

 

During 2015, the Company had five TDRs that were modified within the past 12 months and had defaulted on their restructured terms. The defaulted TDRs consisted of two commercial loans totaling $9.7 million and three consumer residential loans totaling $103 thousand. For purposes of this disclosure, the Company considers “default” to mean 90 days or more past due on principal or interest.

 

99


 

 

Loans accounted for under ASC 310-30

 

Loan pools accounted for under ASC Topic 310-30 are periodically re-measured to determine expected future cash flows. In determining the expected cash flows, the timing of cash flows and prepayment assumptions for smaller homogeneous loans are based on statistical models that take into account factors such as the loan interest rate, credit profile of the borrowers, the years in which the loans were originated, and whether the loans are fixed or variable rate loans. Prepayments may be assumed on loans if circumstances specific to that loan warrant a prepayment assumption. The re-measurement of loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 resulted in the following changes in the carrying amount of accretable yield during 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

Accretable yield beginning balance

 

$

84,194

 

$

113,463

Reclassification from non-accretable difference

 

 

14,316

 

 

22,392

Reclassification to non-accretable difference

 

 

(4,778)

 

 

(4,387)

Accretion

 

 

(33,256)

 

 

(47,274)

Accretable yield ending balance

 

$

60,476

 

$

84,194

 

Below is the composition of the net book value for loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

Contractual cash flows

 

$

537,611

 

$

627,843

Non-accretable difference

 

 

(331,283)

 

 

(340,819)

Accretable yield

 

 

(60,476)

 

 

(84,194)

Loans accounted for under ASC 310-30

 

$

145,852

 

$

202,830

 

 

100


 

 

Note 7 Allowance for Loan Losses

 

The tables below detail the Company’s allowance for loan losses (“ALL”) and recorded investment in loans as of and for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2016

 

    

 

 

    

Non-owner

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

occupied

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

commercial

 

Residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

real estate

 

real estate

 

Consumer

 

Total

Beginning balance

 

$

17,261

 

$

4,166

 

$

5,281

 

$

411

 

$

27,119

Non 310-30 beginning balance

 

 

16,473

 

 

3,939

 

 

5,245

 

 

385

 

 

26,042

Charge-offs

 

 

(20,684)

 

 

(280)

 

 

(408)

 

 

(771)

 

 

(22,143)

Recoveries

 

 

89

 

 

123

 

 

108

 

 

274

 

 

594

Provision

 

 

22,943

 

 

1,640

 

 

(558)

 

 

431

 

 

24,456

Non 310-30 ending balance

 

 

18,821

 

 

5,422

 

 

4,387

 

 

319

 

 

28,949

ASC 310-30 beginning balance

 

 

788

 

 

227

 

 

36

 

 

26

 

 

1,077

Charge-offs

 

 

 —

 

 

(41)

 

 

 —

 

 

(6)

 

 

(47)

Recoveries

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

(Recoupment) provision

 

 

(788)

 

 

34

 

 

(36)

 

 

(15)

 

 

(805)

ASC 310-30 ending balance

 

 

 —

 

 

220

 

 

 —

 

 

5

 

 

225

Ending balance

 

$

18,821

 

$

5,642

 

$

4,387

 

$

324

 

$

29,174

Ending allowance balance attributable to:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non 310-30 loans individually evaluated for impairment

 

$

2,360

 

$

1

 

$

46

 

$

2

 

$

2,409

Non 310-30 loans collectively evaluated for impairment

 

 

16,461

 

 

5,421

 

 

4,341

 

 

317

 

 

26,540

ASC 310-30 loans

 

 

 —

 

 

220

 

 

 —

 

 

5

 

 

225

Total ending allowance balance

 

$

18,821

 

$

5,642

 

$

4,387

 

$

324

 

$

29,174

Loans:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non 310-30 individually evaluated for impairment

 

$

29,411

 

$

631

 

$

7,346

 

$

188

 

$

37,576

Non 310-30 collectively evaluated for impairment

 

 

1,491,739

 

 

437,011

 

 

721,015

 

 

27,728

 

 

2,677,493

ASC 310-30 loans

 

 

39,280

 

 

89,150

 

 

16,524

 

 

898

 

 

145,852

Total loans

 

$

1,560,430

 

$

526,792

 

$

744,885

 

$

28,814

 

$

2,860,921

 

 

101


 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2015

 

    

 

 

    

Non-owner

    

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

occupied

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

commercial

 

Residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

real estate

 

real estate

 

Consumer

 

Total

Beginning balance

 

$

10,384

 

$

3,042

 

$

3,771

 

$

416

 

$

17,613

Non 310-30 beginning balance

 

 

9,916

 

 

2,820

 

 

3,743

 

 

413

 

 

16,892

Charge-offs

 

 

(1,911)

 

 

(222)

 

 

(208)

 

 

(1,196)

 

 

(3,537)

Recoveries

 

 

98

 

 

141

 

 

140

 

 

230

 

 

609

Provision

 

 

8,370

 

 

1,200

 

 

1,570

 

 

938

 

 

12,078

Non 310-30 ending balance

 

 

16,473

 

 

3,939

 

 

5,245

 

 

385

 

 

26,042

ASC 310-30 beginning balance

 

 

468

 

 

222

 

 

28

 

 

3

 

 

721

Charge-offs

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

(10)

 

 

(10)

Recoveries

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Provision (recoupment)

 

 

320

 

 

5

 

 

8

 

 

33

 

 

366

ASC 310-30 ending balance

 

 

788

 

 

227

 

 

36

 

 

26

 

 

1,077

Ending balance

 

$

17,261

 

$

4,166

 

$

5,281

 

$

411

 

$

27,119

Ending allowance balance attributable to:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non 310-30 loans individually evaluated for impairment

 

$

4,048

 

$

275

 

$

65

 

$

1

 

$

4,389

Non 310-30 loans collectively evaluated for impairment

 

 

12,425

 

 

3,664

 

 

5,180

 

 

384

 

 

21,653

ASC 310-30 loans

 

 

788

 

 

227

 

 

36

 

 

26

 

 

1,077

Total ending allowance balance

 

$

17,261

 

$

4,166

 

$

5,281

 

$

411

 

$

27,119

Loans:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non 310-30 individually evaluated for impairment

 

$

26,299

 

$

1,690

 

$

7,593

 

$

86

 

$

35,668

Non 310-30 collectively evaluated for impairment

 

 

1,343,647

 

 

320,022

 

 

654,957

 

 

30,549

 

 

2,349,175

ASC 310-30 loans

 

 

57,474

 

 

121,173

 

 

21,452

 

 

2,731

 

 

202,830

Total loans

 

$

1,427,420

 

$

442,885

 

$

684,002

 

$

33,366

 

$

2,587,673

 

In evaluating the loan portfolio for an appropriate ALL level, non-impaired loans that were not accounted for under ASC 310-30 were grouped into segments based on broad characteristics such as primary use and underlying collateral. Within the segments, the portfolio was further disaggregated into classes of loans with similar attributes and risk characteristics for purposes of applying loss ratios and determining applicable subjective adjustments to the ALL. The application of subjective adjustments was based upon qualitative risk factors, including economic trends and conditions, industry conditions, asset quality, loss trends, lending management, portfolio growth and loan review/internal audit results. During the first quarter of 2016, the Company updated the loan classifications in its allowance for loan losses model to include owner occupied commercial real estate and agriculture within the commercial loan segment and present energy as its own loan class within the commercial segment. The prior year presentation has been reclassified to conform to the current year presentation.

 

The Company had $21.6 million of net charge-offs on non 310-30 loans during 2016, of which $19.1 million were from the energy portfolio. Management’s evaluation of credit quality resulted in a provision for loan losses on non 310-30 loans of $24.5 million during 2016, of which $18.9 million was from the energy portfolio. During 2015, The Company had $2.9 million of net charge-offs on non ASC 310-30 loans and recorded a provision for loan losses on non 310-30 loans of $12.1 million.

 

During 2016 and 2015, the Company re-measured the expected cash flows of the loan pools accounted for under ASC 310-30. The re-measurement in 2016 resulted in a net recoupment of $805 thousand, which was comprised primarily of a $788 thousand recoupment in the commercial segment. The re-measurement in 2015 resulted in a provision of $366 thousand, which was comprised primarily of a $320 thousand commercial segment provision.

 

102


 

 

Note 8 Premises and Equipment

 

Premises and equipment consisted of the following at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

Land

 

$

29,864

 

$

29,991

Buildings and improvements

 

 

69,980

 

 

71,908

Equipment

 

 

42,067

 

 

39,382

Total premises and equipment, at cost

 

 

141,911

 

 

141,281

Less: accumulated depreciation and amortization

 

 

(46,240)

 

 

(38,178)

Premises and equipment, net

 

$

95,671

 

$

103,103

 

The Company incurred $8.7 million, $10.1 million and $10.6 million of depreciation expense during 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively, as a component of occupancy and equipment expense in the consolidated statements of operations. The Company disposed of $3.5 million, $0.1 million and $1.0 million of premises and equipment, net, during 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

 

During 2015, the Company consolidated three banking centers in the Bank Midwest network. During the first quarter of 2016, the Company announced the consolidation of seven banking centers in the Community Banks of Colorado network. The banking center consolidations resulted in certain buildings to be classified as held-for-sale, which were adjusted to the lower of the carrying amount or fair value less cost to sell. The adjustment totaled $1.4 million and is included in the consolidated statements of operations. At December 31, 2016, the Company held one building related to these consolidations.

 

During 2016, the Company entered into definitive agreements for the sale of four banking centers expected to close during the second quarter of 2017. The sale includes buildings classified as held-for-sale with an estimated fair value of $1.6 million at December 31, 2016.

 

Space in certain facilities is leased under operating leases. Below is a summary of future minimum lease payments for the years following 2016:

 

 

 

 

 

2017

    

$

3,328

2018

 

 

3,161

2019

 

 

3,050

2020

 

 

2,942

2021

 

 

3,027

Thereafter

 

 

15,322

Total

 

$

30,830

 

 

Note 9 Other Real Estate Owned

 

A summary of the activity in the OREO balances during 2016 and 2015 is as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 

 

 

2016

 

2015

Beginning balance

    

$

20,814

    

$

29,120

Purchases through acquisition, at fair value

 

 

 —

 

 

1,488

Transfers from loan portfolio, at fair value

 

 

6,868

 

 

4,576

Impairments

 

 

(298)

 

 

(1,580)

Sales, net

 

 

(11,722)

 

 

(12,790)

Ending balance

 

$

15,662

 

$

20,814

 

The OREO balances exclude $1.6 million and $5.5 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively, of the Company’s minority interests in OREO, which are held by outside banks where the Company was not the lead bank and does not have a controlling interest. The Company maintains a receivable in other assets for these minority interests. Included in Sales, net are net gains of $4.4 million and $2.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

103


 

 

 

Note 10 Goodwill and Intangible Assets

 

In connection with our acquisitions, the Company recorded core deposit intangible assets of $38.4 million. The Company is amortizing the core deposit intangibles on a straight line basis over 7 years from the date of the respective acquisitions, which represents the expected useful life of the assets. The Company recognized core deposit intangible amortization expense of $5.5 million, $5.4 million and $5.3 million during 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The following table shows the estimated future amortization expenses.

 

 

 

 

2017

$

5,480

2018

 

1,122

2019

 

135

2020

 

135

2021

 

135

 

The accumulated amortization of the core deposit intangible assets was $31.5 million and $25.8 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

 

The Company had goodwill of $59.6 million at December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014. The goodwill is measured as the excess of the fair value of consideration paid over the fair value of assets acquired. No goodwill impairment was recorded during 2016, 2015 or 2014.

 

Note 11 Deposits

 

Total deposits were $3.9 billion and $3.8 billion at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. Time deposits were $1.2 billion at both December 31, 2016 and 2015. At December 31, 2016, deposits totaling $103.0 million were held-for-sale, including $51.6 million of time deposits. The following table summarizes the Company’s time deposits, based upon contractual maturity, at December 31, 2016 and 2015, by remaining maturity:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

December 31, 2015

 

    

 

 

    

Weighted

    

 

 

    

Weighted

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

Balance

 

Rate

 

Balance

 

 Rate

Three months or less

 

$

200,054

 

0.59%

 

$

214,724

 

0.53%

Over 3 months through 6 months

 

 

205,875

 

0.70%

 

 

200,771

 

0.52%

Over 6 months through 12 months

 

 

382,852

 

0.76%

 

 

391,750

 

0.68%

Over 12 months through 24 months

 

 

244,135

 

0.90%

 

 

271,353

 

0.81%

Over 24 months through 36 months

 

 

76,865

 

1.32%

 

 

65,306

 

1.25%

Over 36 months through 48 months

 

 

50,921

 

1.44%

 

 

36,955

 

1.39%

Over 48 months through 60 months

 

 

7,303

 

1.32%

 

 

7,942

 

1.08%

Thereafter

 

 

4,041

 

1.19%

 

 

5,082

 

1.48%

Total time deposits

 

$

1,172,046

 

0.82%

 

$

1,193,883

 

0.72%

 

The Company incurred interest expense on deposits as follows during the periods indicated:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 

 

    

2016

    

2015

    

2014

Interest bearing demand deposits

 

$

369

 

$

315

 

$

317

Money market accounts

 

 

3,600

 

 

3,372

 

 

3,467

Savings accounts

 

 

1,016

 

 

837

 

 

539

Time deposits

 

 

8,978

 

 

9,085

 

 

9,797

Total

 

$

13,963

 

$

13,609

 

$

14,120

 

104


 

 

The Federal Reserve System requires cash balances to be maintained at the Federal Reserve Bank based on certain deposit levels. There was no minimum reserve requirement for the Bank at December 31, 2016. The aggregate amount of certificates of deposit in denominations that meet or exceed the FDIC insurance limit was $119.7 million and $86.9 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

 

Note 12 Borrowings

 

The following table sets forth selected information regarding repurchase agreements during 2016, 2015 and 2014:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As of and for the years ended December 31,

 

    

2016

    

2015

    

2014

Maximum amount of outstanding agreements at any month end during the period

 

$

154,404

 

$

288,591

 

$

133,552

Average amount outstanding during the period

 

$

109,246

 

$

197,726

 

$

99,057

Weighted average interest rate for the period

 

 

0.14%

 

 

0.09%

 

 

0.13%

 

As of December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, the Company had pledged mortgage-backed securities with a fair value of approximately $99.1 million, $205.7 million and $152.4 million, respectively, for securities sold under agreements to repurchase. Additionally, there was $7.0 million, $68.1 million and $18.8 million of excess collateral pledged for repurchase agreements at December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

 

The vast majority of the Company’s repurchase agreements are overnight transactions with clients that mature the day after the transaction. During 2016, 2015 and 2014, the overnight agreements had a weighted average interest rate of 0.17%, 0.18% and 0.13%, respectively. At December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 none of the Company’s repurchase agreements were for periods longer than one day. The repurchase agreements are subject to a master netting arrangement; however, the Company has not offset any of the amounts shown in the consolidated financial statements.

 

As a member of the FHLB of Topeka, the Bank has access to a line of credit and term financing from the FHLB with available credit of $903.9 million at December 31, 2016. Total advances under the line of credit at December 31, 2016 were $13.7 million with an interest rate of 0.72%, and had certain loans pledged as collateral. The Bank had no outstanding advances at December 31, 2015 and 2014.

 

At December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, the Bank had $25.0 million in term advances from the FHLB of Des Moines. All of the outstanding advances have fixed interest rates of 1.81% - 2.33%, with maturity dates of 2018 - 2020. The Bank had investment securities pledges as collateral for FHLB of Des Moines advances in the amount of $28.8 million, $41.7 million and $0.0 million at December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Interest expense related to FHLB advances totaled $693 thousand, $666 thousand and $164 thousand for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

 

 

 

 

 

 

Note 13 Regulatory Capital 

 

As a bank holding company, the Company is subject to the regulatory capital adequacy requirements implemented by the Federal Reserve. The federal banking agencies have risk-based capital adequacy regulations intended to provide a measure of capital adequacy that reflects the degree of risk associated with a banking organization’s operations. Under these regulations, assets are assigned to one of several risk categories, and nominal dollar amounts of assets and credit equivalent amounts of off-balance-sheet items are multiplied by a risk adjustment percentage for the category. 

 

The new Basel III rules, effective January 1, 2015, changed the components of regulatory capital and changed the way in which risk ratings are assigned to various categories of bank assets. Also, a new Tier 1 common risk-based ratio was defined. Under the Basel III requirements, at December 31, 2016, the Company and the Bank met all capital requirements and the Bank had regulatory capital ratios in excess of the levels established for well-capitalized institutions.

 

In February 2016, the Bank received approval from the Colorado Division of Banking and the Federal Reserve Bank of Kansas City to permanently reduce the Bank's capital by $140.0 million. As a result, the Bank distributed $140.0 million in cash to the Company in February 2016.

 

105


 

 

At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Bank met the requirements to be considered “well capitalized” under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action. To be categorized as “well capitalized”, the Bank must maintain capital ratios as set forth in the table below. The following table sets forth the capital ratios of the Company and the Bank at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Required to be

 

Required to be

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

well capitalized under

 

considered

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

prompt corrective

 

 adequately

 

 

Actual

 

action provisions

 

 capitalized

 

    

Ratio

    

Amount

    

Ratio

    

Amount

    

Ratio

    

Amount

Tier 1 leverage ratio:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

10.4%

 

$

470,259

 

N/A

 

 

N/A

 

4.0%

 

$

181,019

NBH Bank

 

8.6%

 

 

389,189

 

4.5%

 

$

202,903

 

4.0%

 

 

180,358

Common equity tier 1 risk-based capital:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

14.2%

 

$

470,259

 

N/A

 

 

N/A

 

4.5%

 

$

203,647

NBH Bank

 

11.8%

 

 

389,189

 

6.5%

 

$

293,082

 

4.5%

 

 

202,903

Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

14.2%

 

$

470,259

 

N/A

 

 

N/A

 

6.0%

 

$

199,467

NBH Bank

 

11.8%

 

 

389,189

 

8.0%

 

$

264,596

 

6.0%

 

 

198,447

Total risk-based capital ratio:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

15.0%

 

$

499,759

 

N/A

 

 

N/A

 

8.0%

 

$

265,955

NBH Bank

 

12.7%

 

 

418,689

 

10.0%

 

$

330,745

 

8.0%

 

 

264,596

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Required to be

 

Required to be

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

well capitalized under

 

considered

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

prompt corrective

 

 adequately

 

 

Actual

 

action provisions

 

 capitalized

 

    

Ratio

    

Amount

    

Ratio

    

Amount

    

Ratio

    

Amount

Tier 1 leverage ratio:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

11.8%

 

$

550,368

 

N/A

 

 

N/A

 

4.0%

 

$

187,325

NBH Bank

 

11.2%

 

 

519,766

 

5.0%

 

$

464,078

 

4.0%

 

 

185,631

Common equity tier 1 risk-based capital:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

17.5%

 

$

550,368

 

N/A

 

 

N/A

 

4.5%

 

$

210,741

NBH Bank

 

16.6%

 

 

519,766

 

6.5%

 

$

301,651

 

4.5%

 

 

208,835

Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

17.5%

 

$

550,368

 

N/A

 

 

N/A

 

6.0%

 

$

189,101

NBH Bank

 

16.6%

 

 

519,766

 

8.0%

 

$

344,989

 

6.0%

 

 

188,176

Total risk-based capital ratio:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

18.4%

 

$

578,448

 

N/A

 

 

N/A

 

8.0%

 

$

252,134

NBH Bank

 

17.5%

 

 

547,846

 

10.0%

 

$

376,352

 

8.0%

 

 

250,901

 

 

 

Note 14 FDIC Loss-Sharing Related

 

During the fourth quarter of 2015, the Bank entered into an early termination agreement with the FDIC, terminating its loss-share agreements with the FDIC. The Bank paid consideration of $15.1 million to the FDIC for the termination of the agreements. Additionally, the Bank recorded a pre-tax gain of $4.9 million in the fourth quarter of 2015, which was recorded in FDIC loss-sharing related income in the consolidated statements of operations. FDIC related income was $0, $(15.6) million and $(36.6) million for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.  The amounts in 2015 and 2014 were mostly driven by the FDIC indemnification asset amortization.

106


 

 

Note 15 Stock-based Compensation and Benefits

 

The Company provides stock-based compensation in accordance with shareholder-approved plans. During the second quarter of 2014, shareholders approved the 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the "2014 Plan"). The 2014 Plan replaces the NBH Holdings Corp. 2009 Equity Incentive Plan (the "Prior Plan"), pursuant to which the Company granted equity awards prior to the approval of the 2014 Plan. Pursuant to the 2014 Plan, the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors has the authority to grant, from time to time, awards of options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units, performance units, other stock-based awards, or any combination thereof to eligible persons.

 

As of December 31, 2016, the aggregate number of Class A common stock available for issuance under the 2014 Plan is 5,588,905 shares. Any shares that are subject to stock options or stock appreciation rights under the 2014 Plan will be counted against the amount available for issuance as one share for every one share granted, and any shares that are subject to awards under the 2014 Plan other than stock options or stock appreciation rights will be counted against the amount available for issuance as 3.25 shares for every one share granted. The 2014 Plan provides for recycling of shares from both the Prior Plan and the 2014 Plan, the terms of which are further described in the Company's Proxy Statement for its 2014 Annual Meeting of Shareholders. Upon an option exercise, it is the Company’s policy to issue shares from treasury stock.

 

To date, the Company has issued stock options, restricted stock and performance stock units under the plans. The Compensation Committee sets the option exercise price at the time of grant, but in no case is the exercise price less than the fair market value of a share of stock at the date of grant.

 

Stock options

 

The Company issued stock options during 2016, 2015 and 2014 which are primarily time-vesting with 1/3 vesting on each of the first, second and third anniversary of the date of grant or date of hire.

 

The expense associated with the awarded stock options was measured at fair value using a Black-Scholes option-pricing model. The outstanding option awards vest on a graded basis over 1-4 years of continuous service and have 7-10 year contractual terms.

 

Below are the weighted average assumptions used in the Black-Scholes option pricing model to determine fair value of the Company’s stock options granted in 2016, 2015 and 2014:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2016

    

2015

    

2014

Weighted average fair value

$

4.24

 

$

4.37

 

$

6.08

Weighted average risk-free interest rate (1)

 

1.47%

 

 

1.59%

 

 

2.02%

Expected volatility (2)

 

22.47%

 

 

23.87%

 

 

33.94%

Expected term (years) (3)

 

6.09

 

 

6.01

 

 

6.01

Dividend yield (4)

 

1.02%

 

 

1.05%

 

 

1.06%

(1)

    

The risk-free rate for the expected term of the options was based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve at the date of grant and based on the expected term.

(2)

    

Expected volatility was calculated using a time-based weighted migration of the Company’s own stock price volatility coupled with those of a peer group of eight comparable publicly traded companies for a period commensurate with the expected term of the options.

(3)

    

The expected term was estimated to be the average of the contractual vesting term and time to expiration.

(4)

    

The dividend yield was assumed to be zero for grants made prior to the initial public offering and for subsequent grants was assumed to be $0.05 per share per quarter and $0.07 per share per quarter after October 18, 2016 in accordance with the Company’s dividend policy at the time of grant.

 

107


 

 

The Company issued stock options in accordance with the 2014 Plan during 2016. The following table summarizes stock option activity for 2016:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

    

 

 

    

Weighted

    

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

average

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 remaining

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

average

 

contractual

 

Aggregate

 

 

 

 

 

 exercise 

 

 term in 

 

intrinsic 

 

 

 

Options

 

price

 

years

 

value

 

Outstanding at December 31, 2015

 

2,596,251

 

$

19.84

 

4.77

 

$

3,968

 

Granted

 

175,693

 

 

19.74

 

 

 

 

 

 

Forfeited

 

(39,768)

 

 

19.25

 

 

 

 

 

 

Surrendered

 

(451,766)

 

 

19.98

 

 

 

 

 

 

Exercised

 

(83,004)

 

 

19.91

 

 

 

 

 

 

Expired

 

(11,484)

 

 

19.68

 

 

 

 

 

 

Outstanding at December 31, 2016

 

2,185,922

 

$

19.81

 

4.85

 

$

7,753

 

Options exercisable at December 31, 2016

 

1,851,858

 

$

19.91

 

3.46

 

$

6,060

 

Options expected to vest

 

313,403

 

$

19.34

 

8.32

 

$

1,266

 

 

Stock option expense is a component of salaries and benefits in the consolidated statements of operations and totaled $0.7 million, $0.7 million and $1.2 million for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. At December 31, 2016, there was $0.6 million of total unrecognized compensation cost related to non-vested stock options granted under the plans. The cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.9 years.

 

The following table summarizes the Company’s outstanding stock options:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Options outstanding

 

Options exercisable

 

 

 

 

    

 

    

Weighted average

    

 

 

    

 

    

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Number

 

 remaining contractual

 

Weighted average

 

Number

 

Weighted average

Range of exercise price

 

outstanding

 

 life (years)

 

 exercise price

 

exercisable

 

exercise price

$

18.00

-

18.99

 

162,815

 

6.72

 

$

18.51

 

91,978

 

$

18.57

$

19.00

-

19.99

 

279,718

 

8.77

 

$

19.38

 

40,515

 

$

19.17

$

20.00 and above

 

1,743,389

 

3.32

 

$

20.02

 

1,719,365

 

$

20.00

 

Restricted stock awards

 

The Company issued time based restricted stock during 2016, 2015 and 2014. The restricted stock awards vest over a range of a 1 – 3 year period. Restricted stock with time-based vesting was valued at the fair value of the shares on the date of grant as they are assumed to be held beyond the vesting period. Restricted stock awards with market vesting components (granted in 2010, 2011 and 2012) were valued using a Monte Carlo Simulation with 100,000 simulation paths to assess the expected percentage of vested shares. A Geometric Brownian Motion was used for simulating the equity prices for a period of ten years and if the restricted stock were not vested during the ten-year period, it was assumed they were forfeited.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2016, the Company granted market-based stock awards of 26,594 shares in accordance with the 2014 Plan. These shares have a five-year performance period. The restricted stock shares vest upon the later of the Company’s stock price achieving an established price goal during the performance period, and the third anniversary of the date of grant. The fair value of these awards was determined using a Monte Carlo Simulation at grant date. The grant date fair value of these awards was $11.28. As of December 31, 2016, the market-based performance condition had been met for these awards and the total unrecognized compensation cost related to these non-vested awards totaled $0.3 million, and is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of approximately 2.2 years.

 

108


 

 

Performance stock units

 

During the year ended December 31, 2016, the Company granted 91,342 performance stock units in accordance with the 2014 Plan. These performance stock units granted represent initial target awards and do not reflect potential increases or decreases resulting from the final performance results, which are to be determined at the end of the three-year performance period (vesting date). The actual number of shares to be awarded at the end of the performance period will range from 0% - 150% of the initial target awards. 60% of the award is based on the Company’s cumulative earnings per share (EPS target) during the performance period, and 40% of the award is based on the Company’s cumulative total shareholder return (TSR target), or TSR, during the performance period. On the vesting date, the Company’s TSR will be compared to the respective TSRs of the companies comprising the KBW Regional Index at the grant date to determine the shares awarded. The fair value of the EPS target portion of the award was determined based on the closing stock price of the Company’s common stock on the grant date. The fair value of the TSR target portion of the award was determined using a Monte Carlo Simulation at the grant date. The weighted-average grant date fair value per unit of the EPS target portion and the TSR target portion was $19.56 and $16.52, respectively. As of December 31, 2016, the total unrecognized compensation cost related to these non-vested units totaled $1.0 million, and is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of approximately 2.4 years.

 

The following table summarizes restricted stock activity during 2016:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

    

Weighted

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 Restricted

 

average grant-

 

Performance

 

 

average grant-

 

 

 shares

 

date fair value

 

stock units

 

 

date fair value

Unvested at December 31, 2015

 

836,031

 

$

15.42

 

 —

 

$

 —

Vested

 

(249,766)

 

 

15.99

 

 —

 

 

 —

Granted

 

122,992

 

 

19.15

 

91,342

 

 

18.22

Forfeited

 

(28,597)

 

 

18.95

 

(6,047)

 

 

18.22

Surrendered

 

(181,389)

 

 

15.50

 

 —

 

 

 —

Unvested at December 31, 2016

 

499,271

 

$

15.82

 

85,295

 

$

18.22

 

Expense related to non-vested restricted awards and units totaled $2.6 million, $2.6 million and $2.3 million during 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively, and is a component of salaries and benefits in the Company’s consolidated statements of operations.

 

Employee Stock Purchase Plan

 

The 2014 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (“ESPP”) is intended to be a qualified plan within the meaning of Section 423 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and allows eligible employees to purchase shares of common stock through payroll deductions up to a limit of $25,000 per calendar year and 2,000 shares per offering period. The price an employee pays for shares is 90.0% of the fair market value of Company common stock on the last day of the offering period. The offering periods is the six-month period commencing on March 1 and September 1 of each year and ending on August 31 and February 28 (or February 29 in the case of a leap year) of each year. There is no vesting or other restrictions on the stock purchased by employees under the ESPP. Under the ESPP, the total number of shares of common stock reserved for issuance totaled 400,000 shares, of which 366,337 was available for issuance.

 

Under the ESPP, employees purchased 19,178 shares during 2016.

 

Note 16 Warrants

 

The Company had 250,750 and 725,750 outstanding warrants to purchase Company stock as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. The warrants were granted to certain lead investors of the Company at the time of the Company’s initial capital raise (2009-2010), all with an exercise price of $20.00 per share. During 2016, 475,000 warrants were exercised in non-cash transactions. The modified term of the warrants outstanding at December 31, 2016 is for ten years and six months from the date of grant and expires on September 15, 2020.

 

109


 

 

During 2015, the Company modified its remaining warrant agreements resulting in the reclassification of $3.1 million to additional paid-in capital included in the consolidated statements of financial condition as of December 31, 2015. Prior to the warrants reclassification to additional paid-in-capital during 2015, the warrants were revalued each reporting period. The Company recorded an expense of $0.1 million in 2015 and a benefit of $3.0 million in 2014, in the consolidated statements of operations, resulting from the change in fair value of the warrant liability.

 

Note 17 Common Stock

 

During 2016, the Company repurchased 4,500,936 shares for $93.6 million.

 

On August 5, 2016, the Board of Directors authorized a new share repurchase program for up to $50.0 million from time to time in either the open market or through privately negotiated transactions. The remaining authorization under this program at December 31, 2016 was $12.6 million. 

 

The Company had 26,386,583 and 30,358,509 shares of Class A common stock outstanding at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. Additionally, the Company had 499,271 and 836,031 shares outstanding at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively, of restricted Class A common stock issued but not yet vested under the 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan and the Prior Plan that are not included in shares outstanding until such time that they are vested; however, these shares do have voting and certain dividend rights during the vesting period.

 

Note 18 Income Per Share

 

The Company calculates income per share under the two-class method, as certain non-vested share awards contain non-forfeitable rights to dividends. As such, these awards are considered securities that participate in the earnings of the Company. Non-vested shares are discussed further in note 15.

 

The Company had 26,386,583 and 30,358,509 shares outstanding (inclusive of Class A and B) as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively, exclusive of issued non-vested restricted shares. Certain stock options and non-vested restricted shares are potentially dilutive securities, but are not included in the calculation of diluted income per share because to do so would have been anti-dilutive for 2016, 2015 and 2014.

 

The following table illustrates the computation of basic and diluted income per share for 2016, 2015 and 2014:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31,

 

    

 

2016

    

2015

    

2014

Net income

 

 

$

23,060

 

$

4,881

 

$

9,176

Less: income allocated to participating securities

 

 

 

(52)

 

 

(53)

 

 

(38)

Income allocated to common shareholders

 

 

$

23,008

 

$

4,828

 

$

9,138

Weighted average shares outstanding for basic income per common share

 

 

 

28,313,061

 

 

34,349,996

 

 

42,404,609

Dilutive effect of equity awards

 

 

 

704,831

 

 

9,321

 

 

16,405

Dilutive effect of warrants

 

 

 

73,451

 

 

4,170

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding for diluted income per common share

 

 

 

29,091,343

 

 

34,363,487

 

 

42,421,014

Basic income per share

 

 

$

0.81

 

$

0.14

 

$

0.22

Diluted income per share

 

 

$

0.79

 

$

0.14

 

$

0.22

 

The Company had 2,185,922, 2,596,251 and 3,597,111 outstanding stock options to purchase common stock at weighted average exercise prices of $19.81, $19.84 and $19.90 per share at December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively, which have time-vesting criteria, and as such, any dilution is derived only for the time frame in which the vesting criteria had been met and where the inclusion of those stock options is dilutive. Additionally, the Company had outstanding warrants to purchase the Company’s common stock totaling 250,750, 725,750 and 830,750 as of December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The warrants have an exercise price of $20.00, which had a dilutive effect of 73,451 and 4,170 shares during 2016 and 2015, respectively, and were out-of-the-money for purposes of dilution calculations during 2014. The Company had 499,271, 836,031 and 955,398 unvested restricted shares outstanding as of December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively, which have performance, market and/or time-vesting criteria, and as such, any dilution is derived only for the time frame in which the vesting criteria had been met and where the inclusion of those restricted shares is dilutive.

110


 

 

 

Note 19 Income Taxes

 

(a) Income taxes

 

Total income taxes for 2016, 2015 and 2014 were allocated as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 

 

    

2016

    

2015

    

2014

Current expense:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

U.S. federal

 

$

1,868

 

$

3,536

 

$

17,032

State and local

 

 

117

 

 

311

 

 

1,909

Total current income tax expense

 

 

1,985

 

 

3,847

 

 

18,941

Deferred expense (benefit):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

U.S. federal

 

 

626

 

 

(710)

 

 

(13,830)

State and local

 

 

336

 

 

(93)

 

 

(1,946)

Total deferred income tax expense (benefit)

 

 

962

 

 

(803)

 

 

(15,776)

Income tax expense

 

$

2,947

 

$

3,044

 

$

3,165

 

(b) Tax Rate Reconciliation

 

Income tax expense attributable to income before taxes was $3.0 million, $3.0 million and $3.2 million for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively, and differed from the amounts computed by applying the U.S. federal income tax rate to pretax income as a result of the following:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 

 

    

2016

    

2015

    

2014

Income tax at federal statutory rate (35%)

 

$

9,103

 

$

2,774

 

$

4,319

State income taxes, net of federal benefits

 

 

295

 

 

142

 

 

(24)

Tax-exempt loan interest income

 

 

(3,798)

 

 

(2,568)

 

 

(889)

Bank-owned life insurance income

 

 

(724)

 

 

(576)

 

 

(177)

Stock-based compensation

 

 

(2,002)

 

 

3,520

 

 

930

Warrant valuation

 

 

 —

 

 

37

 

 

(1,034)

Bargain purchase gain

 

 

 —

 

 

(367)

 

 

 —

Other

 

 

73

 

 

82

 

 

40

Income tax expense

 

$

2,947

 

$

3,044

 

$

3,165

 

111


 

 

(c) Significant Components of Deferred Taxes

 

The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of the deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities at December 31, 2016 and 2015 are presented below:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

Deferred tax assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Excess tax basis of acquired loans over carrying value

 

$

5,865

 

$

3,477

Allowance for loan losses

 

 

11,063

 

 

10,315

Intangible assets

 

 

12,279

 

 

14,284

Other real estate owned

 

 

 —

 

 

2,103

Accrued stock-based compensation

 

 

7,429

 

 

9,795

Accrued compensation

 

 

3,296

 

 

3,112

Capitalized start-up costs

 

 

4,554

 

 

5,076

Accrued expenses

 

 

2,218

 

 

2,550

Net deferred loan fees

 

 

1,198

 

 

1,191

Net operating loss

 

 

2,177

 

 

1,424

Federal tax credits

 

 

1,888

 

 

504

Net unrealized losses on investment securities

 

 

1,082

 

 

 —

Other

 

 

1,526

 

 

1,354

Total deferred tax assets

 

 

54,575

 

 

55,185

Deferred tax liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net unrealized gains on investment securities

 

 

 —

 

 

(57)

Premises and equipment

 

 

(937)

 

 

(2,133)

Other real estate owned

 

 

(426)

 

 

 —

Prepaid expenses

 

 

(402)

 

 

(362)

Total deferred tax liabilities

 

 

(1,765)

 

 

(2,552)

Net deferred tax asset

 

$

52,810

 

$

52,633

 

At December 31, 2016, the Company has federal and state net operating loss carryovers (NOLs) of $5.6 million and $5.9 million, respectively, which are available to offset future taxable income. The federal NOLs expire in varying amounts through 2036, and the state NOLs expire in varying amounts between 2026 and 2036. The Company also has a minimum tax credit carryover of $1.9 million that does not expire. The minimum tax credit is available to reduce income tax obligations in future periods to the extent they exceed the calculated alternative minimum tax. The Company does not expect any tax attribute carryovers to expire before they are utilized.

 

In assessing the realizability of deferred tax assets, management considers whether it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will be realized. The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income during the periods in which those temporary differences become deductible. Management considers the scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities, if any (including the impact of available carryforward periods), projected future taxable income, and tax-planning strategies in making this assessment. For the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, management believes a valuation allowance on the deferred tax asset is not necessary based on the current and future projected earnings of the Company. The Company has no ASC 740-10 unrecognized tax benefits recorded as of December 31, 2016 and 2015 and does not expect the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits to significantly increase within the next 12 months. The Company and its subsidiary bank are subject to income tax by federal, state and local government taxing authorities. The Company’s tax returns for the years ended December 31, 2013 through 2016 remain subject to examination for U.S. federal income tax authorities. The years open to examination by state and local government authorities vary by jurisdiction.

 

112


 

 

Certain stock-based compensation awards granted by the Company have market-based vesting/exercisability criteria. For restricted stock with market-based vesting, the target share prices of the Company's stock that is required for vesting range from $32.00 to $34.00 per share. The strike prices for options range from $18.09 to $23.75, with a large portion of the awards having strike prices of $20.00. Depending on the movement in our stock price, these stock-based compensation awards may create either an excess tax benefit or tax deficiency depending on the relationship between the fair value at the time of vesting or exercise and the estimated fair value recorded at the time of grant. The Company adopted ASU 2016-09 effective January 1, 2016, which results in recording the excess tax benefit or tax deficiency as a component of tax benefit or expense in the consolidated statements of operations. During 2016, the Company recorded $2.1 million of excess tax benefit related to the settlement of certain awards during the period as a component of income tax expense in the consolidated statements of operations. During 2015, the Company recorded a tax deficiency of $3.7 million in income tax expense resulting from expired or exercised awards. As of December 31, 2016, the Company had a $7.4 million deferred tax asset related to stock-based compensation, $5.6 million of which is associated with executive officers still employed by the Company.

 

Note 20 Derivatives

 

Risk management objective of using derivatives

 

The Company is exposed to certain risks arising from both its business operations and economic conditions. The Company has established policies that neither carrying value nor fair value at risk should exceed established guidelines. The Company has designed strategies to confine these risks within the established limits and identify appropriate trade-offs in the financial structure of its balance sheet. These strategies include the use of derivative financial instruments to help achieve the desired balance sheet repricing structure while meeting the desired objectives of its clients. Currently the Company employs certain interest rate swaps that are designated as fair value hedges as well as economic hedges. The Company manages a matched book with respect to its derivative instruments in order to minimize its net risk exposure resulting from such transactions.

 

Fair values of derivative instruments on the balance sheet

 

The table below presents the fair value of the Company’s derivative financial instruments as well as their classification in the consolidated statements of financial condition as of December 31, 2016 and 2015.

 

Information about the valuation methods used to measure fair value is provided in note 22.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asset derivatives fair value

 

 

 

Liability derivatives fair value

 

 

Balance sheet

 

December 31, 

 

December 31, 

 

Balance sheet

 

December 31, 

 

December 31, 

 

 

location

    

2016

    

2015

    

location

    

2016

    

2015

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rate products

 

Other assets

 

$

9,528

 

$

388

 

Other liabilities

 

$

1,381

 

$

6,232

Total derivatives designated as hedging instruments

 

 

 

$

9,528

 

$

388

 

 

 

$

1,381

 

$

6,232

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rate products

 

Other assets

 

$

1,900

 

$

1,959

 

Other liabilities

 

$

1,898

 

$

2,083

Interest rate lock commitments

 

Other assets

 

 

149

 

 

 —

 

Other liabilities

 

 

6

 

 

 —

Forward contracts

 

Other assets

 

 

138

 

 

 —

 

Other liabilities

 

 

20

 

 

 —

Forward loan sales agreements

 

Loans held for sale

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

Loans held for sale

 

 

161

 

 

 —

Total derivatives not designated as hedging instruments

 

 

 

$

2,187

 

$

1,959

 

 

 

$

2,085

 

$

2,083

 

113


 

 

Fair value hedges

 

Interest rate swaps designated as fair value hedges involve the receipt of variable-rate amounts from a counterparty in exchange for the Company making fixed-rate payments over the life of the agreements without the exchange of the underlying notional amount. As of December 31, 2016, the Company had 42 interest rate swaps with a notional amount of $313.0 million that were designated as fair value hedges of interest rate risk associated with the Company’s fixed-rate loans. The Company had 31 outstanding interest rate swaps with a notional amount of $273.3 million that were designated as fair value hedges as of December 31, 2015.

 

For derivatives designated and that qualify as fair value hedges, the gain or loss on the derivative as well as the offsetting loss or gain on the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk are recognized in earnings. The Company includes the gain or loss on the hedged items in the same line item as the offsetting loss or gain on the related derivatives. During 2016, the Company recognized a net gain of $293 thousand in non-interest income related to hedge ineffectiveness. During 2015, the Company recognized a net loss of $198 thousand in non-interest income related to hedge ineffectiveness.

 

Non-designated hedges

 

Derivatives not designated as hedges are not speculative and consist of interest rate swaps with commercial banking clients that facilitate their respective risk management strategies. Interest rate swaps are simultaneously hedged by offsetting interest rate swaps that the Company executes with a third party, such that the Company minimizes its net risk exposure resulting from such transactions. As the interest rate swaps associated with this program do not meet the strict hedge accounting requirements, changes in the fair value of both the client swaps and the offsetting swaps are recognized directly in earnings. As of December 31, 2016, the Company had 36 matched interest rate swap transactions with an aggregate notional amount of $132.6 million related to this program. As of December 31, 2015, the Company had 20 matched interest rate swap transactions with an aggregate notional amount of $68.1 million related to this program. 

 

As part of its mortgage banking activities, the Company enters into interest rate lock commitments, which are commitments to originate loans where the interest rate on the loan is determined prior to funding and the customers have locked into that interest rate. The Company then locks in the loan and interest rate with an investor and commits to deliver the loan if settlement occurs ("best efforts") or commits to deliver the locked loan in a binding ("mandatory") delivery program with an investor. Fair value changes of certain loans under interest rate lock commitments are hedged with forward sales contracts of MBS. Forward sales contracts of MBS are recorded at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in non-interest income. Interest rate lock commitments and commitments to deliver loans to investors are considered derivatives. The market value of interest rate lock commitments and best efforts contracts are not readily ascertainable with precision because they are not actively traded in stand-alone markets. The Company determines the fair value of interest rate lock commitments and delivery contracts by measuring the fair value of the underlying asset, which is impacted by current interest rates, taking into consideration the probability that the interest rate lock commitments will close or will be funded.

 

Certain additional risks arise from these forward delivery contracts in that the counterparties to the contracts may not be able to meet the terms of the contracts. The Company does not expect any counterparty to any MBS contract to fail to meet its obligation. Additional risks inherent in mandatory delivery programs include the risk that, if the Company fails to deliver the loans subject to interest rate risk lock commitments, it will still be obligated to “pair off” MBS to the counterparty under the forward sales agreement. Should this be required, the Company could incur significant costs in acquiring replacement loans and such costs could have an adverse effect on the consolidated financial statements.

 

The fair value of the mortgage banking derivative is recorded as a freestanding asset or liability with the change in value being recognized in current earnings during the period of change.

 

The Company had 78 interest rate lock commitments with a notional value of $13.8 million and 11 forward contracts with a notional value of $11.8 million at December 31, 2016. The Company had 70 forward loan sales commitments with a notional value of $12.0 million at December 31, 2016. At December 31, 2015, the Company had no mandatory delivery interest rate lock commitments, forward sale contracts or forward loan sales commitments, and the best efforts mortgage banking derivatives were immaterial to the consolidated financial statements.  

 

114


 

 

Effect of derivative instruments on the consolidated statements of operations

 

The tables below present the effect of the Company’s derivative financial instruments in the consolidated statements of operations for 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Location of gain (loss)

 

 

Amount of gain or (loss) recognized in income on derivatives

Derivatives in fair value

 

recognized in income on

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 

hedging relationships

    

derivatives

    

 

2016

    

2015

Interest rate products

 

Other non-interest income

 

 

$

8,183

 

$

(2,648)

Total

 

 

 

 

$

8,183

 

$

(2,648)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Location of gain (loss)

 

 

Amount of gain or (loss) recognized in income on hedged items

 

 

recognized in income on

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 

Hedged items

    

hedged items

    

 

2016

    

2015

Interest rate products

 

Other non-interest income

 

 

$

(7,890)

 

$

2,450

Total

 

 

 

 

$

(7,890)

 

$

2,450

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Location of gain (loss)

 

 

Amount of gain or (loss) recognized in income on derivatives

Derivatives not designated

 

recognized in income on

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 

as hedging instruments

    

derivatives

    

 

2016

    

2015

Interest rate products

 

Other non-interest expense

 

 

$

129

 

$

43

Interest rate lock commitments

 

Gain on sale of mortgages, net

 

 

 

142

 

 

 —

Forward contracts

 

Gain on sale of mortgages, net

 

 

 

118

 

 

 —

Forward loan sales agreements

 

Gain on sale of mortgages, net

 

 

 

(161)

 

 

 —

Total

 

 

 

 

$

228

 

$

43

 

Credit-risk-related contingent features

 

The Company has agreements with its derivative counterparties that contain a provision where if the Company defaults on any of its indebtedness for reasons other than an error or omission of an administrative or operational nature, including default where repayment of the indebtedness has not been accelerated by the lender, then the Company could also be declared in default on its derivative obligations.

 

The Company also has agreements with certain of its derivative counterparties that contain a provision where if the Company fails to maintain its status as a well/adequately capitalized institution, then the counterparty has the right to terminate the derivative positions and the Company would be required to settle its obligations under the agreements.

 

As of December 31, 2016, the termination value of derivatives in a net liability position related to these agreements was $1.3 million, which includes accrued interest but excludes any adjustment for nonperformance risk. The Company has minimum collateral posting thresholds with certain of its derivative counterparties and as of December 31, 2016, the Company had posted $0.8 million in eligible collateral. If the Company had breached any of these provisions at December 31, 2016, it could have been required to settle its obligations under the agreements at the termination value.

 

Note 21 Commitments and Contingencies

 

In the normal course of business, the Company enters into various off-balance sheet commitments to help meet the financing needs of clients. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit, commercial and consumer lines of credit and standby letters of credit. The same credit policies are applied to these commitments as the loans in the consolidated statements of financial condition; however, these commitments involve varying degrees of credit risk in excess of the amount recognized in the consolidated statements of financial condition. At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Company had loan commitments totaling $602.2 million and $627.2 million, respectively, and standby letters of credit that totaled $13.5 million and $9.8 million, respectively. The total amounts of unused commitments do not necessarily represent future credit exposure or cash requirements, as commitments often expire without being drawn upon. However, the contractual amount of these commitments, offset by any additional collateral pledged, represents the Company’s potential credit loss exposure.

 

115


 

 

Total unfunded commitments at December 31, 2016 and 2015 were as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

Commitments to fund loans

 

$

149,391

 

$

261,004

Credit card lines of credit

 

 

 —

 

 

18,418

Unfunded commitments under lines of credit

 

 

452,851

 

 

347,822

Commercial and standby letters of credit

 

 

13,532

 

 

9,770

Total unfunded commitments

 

$

615,774

 

$

637,014

 

Commitments to fund loans —Commitments to fund loans are legally binding agreements to lend to clients in accordance with predetermined contractual provisions providing there have been no violations of any conditions specified in the contract. These commitments are generally at variable interest rates and are for specific periods or contain termination clauses and may require the payment of a fee. The total amounts of unused commitments are not necessarily representative of future credit exposure or cash requirements, as commitments often expire without being drawn upon.

 

Credit card lines of credit —The Company extends lines of credit to clients through the use of credit cards issued by the Bank. These lines of credit represent the maximum amounts allowed to be funded, many of which will not exhaust the established limits, and as such, these amounts are not necessarily representations of future cash requirements or credit exposure. During the first quarter of 2016, the Company sold its credit card lines of credit and entered into a joint marketing agreement with an unrelated third-party. As a result of this action, the Company will be able to better provide small business and consumer clients with access to a more competitive suite of products and services.

 

Unfunded commitments under lines of credit —In the ordinary course of business, the Company extends revolving credit to its clients. These arrangements may require the payment of a fee.

 

Commercial and standby letters of credit —As a provider of financial services, the Company routinely issues commercial and standby letters of credit, which may be financial standby letters of credit or performance standby letters of credit. These are various forms of “back-up” commitments to guarantee the performance of a client to a third party. While these arrangements represent a potential cash outlay for the Company, the majority of these letters of credit will expire without being drawn upon. Letters of credit are subject to the same underwriting and credit approval process as traditional loans, and as such, many of them have various forms of collateral securing the commitment, which may include real estate, personal property, receivables or marketable securities.

 

Contingencies

 

In the ordinary course of business, the Company and the Bank may be subject to litigation. Based upon the available information and advice from the Company’s legal counsel, management does not believe that any potential, threatened or pending litigation to which it is a party will have a material adverse effect on the Company’s liquidity, financial condition or results of operations.

 

Note 22 Fair Value Measurements

 

The Company uses fair value measurements to record fair value adjustments to certain assets and liabilities and to disclose the fair value of its financial instruments. Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. For disclosure purposes, the Company groups its financial and non-financial assets and liabilities into three different levels based on the nature of the instrument and the availability and reliability of the information that is used to determine fair value. The three levels are defined as follows:

 

·

Level 1—Includes assets or liabilities in which the inputs to the valuation methodologies are based on unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.

 

·

Level 2—Includes assets or liabilities in which the inputs to the valuation methodologies are based on similar assets or liabilities in inactive markets, quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in inactive markets, and inputs other than quoted prices that are observable, such as interest rates, yield curves, volatilities, prepayment speeds, and other inputs obtained from observable market input.

116


 

 

 

·

Level 3—Includes assets or liabilities in which the inputs to the valuation methodology are based on at least one significant assumption that is not observable in the marketplace. These valuations may rely on management’s judgment and may include internally-developed model-based valuation techniques.

 

Level 1 inputs are considered to be the most transparent and reliable and level 3 inputs are considered to be the least transparent and reliable. The Company assumes the use of the principal market to conduct a transaction of each particular asset or liability being measured and then considers the assumptions that market participants would use when pricing the asset or liability. Whenever possible, the Company first looks for quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in active markets (level 1 inputs) to value each asset or liability. However, when inputs from identical assets or liabilities on active markets are not available, the Company utilizes market observable data for similar assets and liabilities. The Company maximizes the use of observable inputs and limits the use of unobservable inputs to occasions when observable inputs are not available. The need to use unobservable inputs generally results from the lack of market liquidity of the actual financial instrument or of the underlying collateral. Although, in some instances, third party price indications may be available, limited trading activity can challenge the observability of these quotations.

 

Changes in the valuation inputs used for measuring the fair value of financial instruments may occur due to changes in current market conditions or other factors. Such changes may necessitate a transfer of the financial instruments to another level in the hierarchy based on the new inputs used. The Company recognizes these transfers at the end of the reporting period that the transfer occurs. During 2016 and 2015, there were no transfers of financial instruments between the hierarchy levels.

 

The following is a description of the valuation methodologies used for assets and liabilities measured at fair value, as well as the general classification of each instrument under the valuation hierarchy:

 

Fair Value of Financial Instruments Measured on a Recurring Basis

 

Investment securities available-for-sale —Investment securities available-for-sale are carried at fair value on a recurring basis. To the extent possible, observable quoted prices in an active market are used to determine fair value and, as such, these securities are classified as level 1. At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Company did not hold any level 1 securities. When quoted market prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities are not available, quoted prices of securities with similar characteristics, discounted cash flows or other pricing characteristics are used to estimate fair values and the securities are then classified as level 2.

 

Interest rate swap derivatives —The Company's derivative instruments are limited to interest rate swaps that may be accounted for as fair value hedges or non-designated hedges. The fair values of the swaps incorporate credit valuation adjustments in order to appropriately reflect nonperformance risk in the fair value measurements. The credit valuation adjustment is the dollar amount of the fair value adjustment related to credit risk and utilizes a probability weighted calculation to quantify the potential loss over the life of the trade. The credit valuation adjustments are calculated by determining the total expected exposure of the derivatives (which incorporates both the current and potential future exposure) and then applying the respective counterparties’ credit spreads to the exposure offset by marketable collateral posted, if any. Certain derivative transactions are executed with counterparties who are large financial institutions ("dealers"). International Swaps and Derivative Association Master Agreements ("ISDA") and Credit Support Annexes ("CSA") are employed for all contracts with dealers. These contracts contain bilateral collateral arrangements. The fair value inputs of these financial instruments are determined using discounted cash flow analysis through the use of third-party models whose significant inputs are readily observable market parameters, primarily yield curves, with appropriate adjustments for liquidity and credit risk, and are classified as level 2.

 

117


 

 

Mortgage banking derivatives —The Company relies on a third-party pricing service to value its mortgage banking derivative financial assets and liabilities, which the Company classifies as a level 3 valuation. The external valuation model to estimate the fair value of its interest rate lock commitments to originate residential mortgage loans held for sale includes grouping the interest rate lock commitments by interest rate and terms, applying an estimated pull-through rate based on historical experience, and then multiplying by quoted investor prices determined to be reasonably applicable to the loan commitment groups based on interest rate, terms, and rate lock expiration dates of the loan commitment groups. The Company also relies on an external valuation model to estimate the fair value of its forward commitments to sell residential mortgage loans (i.e., an estimate of what the Company would receive or pay to terminate the forward delivery contract based on market prices for similar financial instruments), which includes matching specific terms and maturities of the forward commitments against applicable investor pricing.

 

The tables below present the financial instruments measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, in the consolidated statements of financial condition utilizing the hierarchy structure described above:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

 

Level 1

 

Level 2

 

Level 3

 

Total

Assets:

    

 

    

    

 

    

    

 

    

    

 

    

Investment securities available-for-sale:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

 —

 

$

227,160

 

$

 —

 

$

227,160

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

652,739

 

 

 

 

652,739

Municipal securities

 

 

 —

 

 

3,648

 

 

 —

 

 

3,648

Interest rate swap derivatives

 

 

 

 

11,428

 

 

 

 

11,428

Mortgage banking derivatives

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

287

 

 

287

Total assets at fair value

 

$

 —

 

$

894,975

 

$

287

 

$

895,262

Liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rate swap derivatives

 

$

 

$

3,279

 

$

 

$

3,279

Mortgage banking derivatives

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

 

187

 

 

187

Total liabilities at fair value

 

$

 —

 

$

3,279

 

$

187

 

$

3,466

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

    

Level 1

    

Level 2

    

Level 3

    

Total

Assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investment securities available-for-sale:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

$

 —

 

$

310,978

 

$

 —

 

$

310,978

Other residential MBS issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises

 

 

 

 

845,543

 

 

 

 

845,543

Interest rate swap derivatives

 

 

 

 

2,347

 

 

 

 

2,347

Total assets at fair value

 

$

 —

 

$

1,158,868

 

$

 —

 

$

1,158,868

Liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rate swap derivatives

 

$

 

$

8,315

 

$

 

$

8,315

Total liabilities at fair value

 

$

 —

 

$

8,315

 

$

 —

 

$

8,315

 

118


 

 

The table below details the changes in level 3 financial instruments during 2016:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mortgage banking

 

 

 

derivatives, net

Balance at December 31, 2015

 

$

 —

Gain included in earnings, net

 

 

100

Balance at December 31, 2016

 

$

100

 

Fair Value of Financial Instruments Measured on a Non-recurring Basis

 

Certain assets may be recorded at fair value on a non-recurring basis as conditions warrant. These non-recurring fair value measurements typically result from the application of lower of cost or fair value accounting or a write-down occurring during the period.

 

The Company records collateral dependent loans that are considered to be impaired at their estimated fair value. A loan is considered impaired when it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect all contractual amounts due in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement. Collateral dependent impaired loans are measured based on the fair value of the collateral. The Company relies on third-party appraisals and internal assessments in determining the estimated fair values of these loans. The inputs used to determine the fair values of loans are considered level 3 inputs in the fair value hierarchy. At December 31, 2016, the Company measured three loans not accounted for under ASC 310-30 at fair value on a non-recurring basis with a carrying balance of $10.5 million and specific reserve balance of $2.4 million. At December 31, 2015, the Company measured six loans not accounted for under ASC 310-30 at fair value on a non-recurring basis with a carrying balance of $11.9 million and specific reserve balance of $4.3 million.

 

The Company may be required to record fair value adjustments on loans held-for-sale on a non-recurring basis. The non-recurring fair value adjustments could involve lower of cost or fair value accounting and may include write-downs.

 

OREO is recorded at the lower of the cost basis or the fair value of the collateral less estimated selling costs. The estimated fair values of OREO are updated periodically and further write-downs may be taken to reflect a new basis. The Company recognized $0.3 million and $1.6 million of OREO impairments in the consolidated statements of operations during 2016 and 2015, respectively. The fair values of OREO are derived from third party price opinions or appraisals that generally use an income approach or a market value approach. If reasonable comparable appraisals are not available, then the Company may use internally developed models to determine fair values. The inputs used to determine the fair values of OREO are considered level 3 inputs in the fair value hierarchy.

 

Premises and equipment held-for-sale are written down to estimated fair value less costs to sell in the period in which the held-for-sale criteria are met. Fair value is estimated in a process which considers current local commercial real estate market conditions and the judgment of the sales agent and often invoices obtaining third party appraisals from certified real estate appraisers. These fair value measurements are classified as level 3. Unobservable inputs to these measurements, which include estimates and judgments often used in conjunction with appraisals, are not readily quantifiable. The Company recognized $1.4 million of impairments in the consolidated statements of operations related to banking centers classified as held-for-sale during the year ended December 31, 2015.

 

The table below provides information regarding the assets recorded at fair value on a non-recurring basis at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

 

Total

 

Losses from fair value changes

Other real estate owned

 

$

15,662

    

$

154

Impaired loans

 

 

38,282

 

 

15,200

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

 

Total

 

Losses from fair value changes

Other real estate owned

 

$

20,814

    

$

1,580

Impaired loans

 

 

37,363

 

 

1,424

Premises and Equipment

 

 

2,101

 

 

1,411

 

119


 

 

The Company did not record any liabilities for which the fair value was made on a non-recurring basis during 2016 and 2015.

 

The following table provides information about the valuation techniques and unobservable inputs used in the valuation of financial instruments classified as level 3 of the fair value hierarchy as of December 31, 2016. The table below excludes non-recurring fair value measurements of collateral value used for impairment measures for OREO and premises and equipment. These valuations utilize third party appraisal or broker price opinions, and are classified as level 3 due to the significant judgment involved:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair value at

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

Valuation Technique

 

Unobservable Input

 

Qualitative Measures

Other available-for-sale securities

    

$

419

    

Par value

    

Par value

    

 

Municipal securities

 

 

265

 

Par value

 

Par value

 

 

Impaired loans

 

 

38,282

 

Appraised value

 

Appraised values

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Discount rate

 

0% - 25%

 

 

120


 

 

Note 23 Fair Value of Financial Instruments

 

The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount that would be exchanged between willing parties, other than in a forced liquidation. Fair value is determined based upon quoted market prices to the extent possible; however, in many instances, there are no quoted market prices for the Company’s various financial instruments. In cases where quoted market prices are not available, fair values are based on estimates using present value or other valuation techniques that may be significantly impacted by the assumptions used, including the discount rate and estimates of future cash flows. Changes in any of these assumptions could significantly affect the fair value estimates. The fair value of the financial instruments listed below does not reflect a premium or discount that could result from offering all of the Company’s holdings of financial instruments at one time, nor does it reflect the underlying value of the Company, as ASC Topic 825 excludes certain financial instruments and all non-financial instruments from its disclosure requirements.

 

The fair value of financial instruments at December 31, 2016 and 2015, including methods and assumptions utilized for determining fair value of financial instruments, are set forth below:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

Level in fair value

    

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

 

 

measurement 

 

Carrying

 

Estimated

 

Carrying

 

Estimated

 

 

hierarchy

 

amount

    

fair value

    

amount

    

fair value

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

 

Level 1

 

$

152,736

 

$

152,736

 

$

166,092

 

$

166,092

Mortgage-backed securities—residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises available-for-sale

 

Level 2

 

 

227,160

 

 

227,160

 

 

310,978

 

 

310,978

Mortgage-backed securities—other residential mortgage-backed securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises available-for-sale

 

Level 2

 

 

652,739

 

 

652,739

 

 

845,543

 

 

845,543

Municipal securities

 

Level 2

 

 

3,648

 

 

3,648

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Municipal securities

 

Level 3

 

 

265

 

 

265

 

 

306

 

 

306

Other available-for-sale securities

 

Level 3

 

 

419

 

 

419

 

 

419

 

 

419

Mortgage-backed securities—residential mortgage pass-through securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises held-to-maturity

 

Level 2

 

 

263,411

 

 

264,862

 

 

340,131

 

 

342,812

Mortgage-backed securities—other residential mortgage-backed securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies or sponsored enterprises held-to-maturity

 

Level 2

 

 

69,094

 

 

67,711

 

 

87,372

 

 

85,773

Non-marketable securities

 

Level 2

 

 

14,949

 

 

14,949

 

 

22,529

 

 

22,529

Loans receivable

 

Level 3

 

 

2,860,921

 

 

2,879,860

 

 

2,587,673

 

 

2,613,381

Loans held-for-sale

 

Level 2

 

 

24,187

 

 

24,187

 

 

13,292

 

 

13,292

Accrued interest receivable

 

Level 2

 

 

12,562

 

 

12,562

 

 

12,190

 

 

12,190

Interest rate swap derivatives

 

Level 2

 

 

11,428

 

 

11,428

 

 

2,347

 

 

2,347

Mortgage banking derivatives

 

Level 3

 

 

287

 

 

287

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

LIABILITIES

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deposit transaction accounts

 

Level 2

 

 

2,696,603

 

 

2,696,603

 

 

2,646,794

 

 

2,646,794

Time deposits

 

Level 2

 

 

1,172,046

 

 

1,172,046

 

 

1,193,883

 

 

1,193,883

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

 

Level 2

 

 

92,011

 

 

92,011

 

 

136,523

 

 

136,523

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

 

Level 2

 

 

38,665

 

 

39,324

 

 

40,000

 

 

40,919

Accrued interest payable

 

Level 2

 

 

4,973

 

 

4,973

 

 

4,319

 

 

4,319

Interest rate swap derivatives

 

Level 2

 

 

3,279

 

 

3,279

 

 

8,315

 

 

8,315

Mortgage banking derivatives

 

Level 3

 

 

187

 

 

187

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

 

Cash and cash equivalents

 

Cash and cash equivalents have a short-term nature and the estimated fair value is equal to the carrying value.

 

121


 

 

Investment securities

 

The estimated fair value of investment securities is based on quoted market prices or bid quotations received from securities dealers. Other investment securities, including securities that are held for regulatory purposes are carried at cost, less any other than temporary impairment.

 

Loans receivable

 

The estimated fair value of the loan portfolio is estimated using a discounted cash flow analysis using a discount rate based on interest rates offered at the respective measurement dates for loans with similar terms to borrowers of similar credit quality. The allowance for loan losses is considered a reasonable estimate of any required adjustment to fair value to reflect the impact of credit risk. The estimates of fair value do not incorporate the exit-price concept prescribed by ASC Topic 820, Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures .

 

Loans held-for-sale

 

Loans held-for-sale are carried at the lower of aggregate cost or estimated fair value. The portfolio consists primarily of fixed rate residential mortgage loans that are sold within 45 days. The estimated fair value is based on quoted market prices for similar loans in the secondary market and are classified as level 2.

 

Accrued interest receivable

 

Accrued interest receivable has a short-term nature and the estimated fair value is equal to the carrying value.

 

Deposits

 

The estimated fair value of deposits with no stated maturity, such as non-interest bearing demand deposits, savings, NOW accounts, and money market accounts, is equal to the amount payable on demand. The fair value of interest-bearing time deposits is based on the discounted value of contractual cash flows of such deposits, taking into account the option for early withdrawal. The discount rate is estimated using the rates offered by the Company, at the respective measurement dates, for deposits of similar remaining maturities. The fair value of time deposits has a floor equal to the carrying value as the amount payable on demand would approximate the carrying value.

 

Derivative assets and liabilities

 

Fair values for derivative assets and liabilities are fully described in note 20.

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

 

The vast majority of the Company’s repurchase agreements are overnight transactions that mature the day after the transaction, and as a result of this short-term nature, the estimated fair value is equal to the carrying value.

 

Accrued interest payable

 

Accrued interest payable has a short-term nature and the estimated fair value is equal to the carrying value.

 

122


 

 

Note 24 Parent Company Only Financial Statements

 

Parent company only financial information for National Bank Holdings Corporation is summarized as follows:

 

Condensed Statements of Financial Condition

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

December 31, 2016

    

December 31, 2015

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

 

$

64,691

 

$

15,739

Investment in subsidiaries

 

 

455,120

 

 

586,942

Other assets

 

 

16,996

 

 

15,415

Total assets

 

$

536,807

 

$

618,096

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other liabilities

 

$

618

 

$

552

Total liabilities

 

 

618

 

 

552

Stockholders’ equity

 

 

536,189

 

 

617,544

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

 

$

536,807

 

$

618,096

 

Condensed Statements of Operations

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 

 

    

2016

    

2015

    

2014

Income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest income

 

$

24

 

$

 —

 

$

2

Undistributed equity from subsidiaries

 

 

(129,956)

 

 

(74,131)

 

 

11,712

Distributions from subsidiaries

 

 

155,353

 

 

86,000

 

 

Other income

 

 

 —

 

 

1,048

 

 

Total income

 

 

25,421

 

 

12,917

 

 

11,714

Expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Salaries and benefits

 

 

3,529

 

 

3,349

 

 

3,572

Other expenses

 

 

3,578

 

 

3,597

 

 

751

Total expenses

 

 

7,107

 

 

6,946

 

 

4,323

Income before income taxes

 

 

18,314

 

 

5,971

 

 

7,391

Income tax (benefit) expense

 

 

(4,746)

 

 

1,090

 

 

(1,785)

Net income

 

$

23,060

 

$

4,881

 

$

9,176

 

123


 

 

Condensed Statements of Cash Flows

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 

 

    

2016

    

2015

    

2014

Cash flows from operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

 

$

23,060

 

$

4,881

 

$

9,176

Undistributed equity from subsidiaries

 

 

(25,388)

 

 

(11,869)

 

 

(11,712)

Stock-based compensation expense

 

 

3,492

 

 

3,349

 

 

3,572

Net excess tax (benefit) deficit on stock-based compensation

 

 

(2,078)

 

 

3,677

 

 

15

Other

 

 

418

 

 

(1,042)

 

 

(2,333)

Net cash used in operating activities

 

 

(496)

 

 

(1,004)

 

 

(1,282)

Cash flows from investing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Outlay for business combinations

 

 

 —

 

 

(9,482)

 

 

 —

Dividend payment from subsidiary equity

 

 

15,353

 

 

 —

 

 

 —

Return of capital from investments in subsidiaries

 

 

140,000

 

 

86,000

 

 

 —

Net cash provided by investing activities

 

 

155,353

 

 

76,518

 

 

 —

Cash flows from financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Issuance of stock under purchase and equity compensation plans

 

 

(6,201)

 

 

(952)

 

 

(576)

Proceeds from exercise of stock options

 

 

 —

 

 

160

 

 

 —

Settlement of warrants

 

 

 —

 

 

(368)

 

 

 —

Payment of dividends

 

 

(6,131)

 

 

(6,711)

 

 

(8,476)

Repurchase of shares

 

 

(93,573)

 

 

(175,048)

 

 

(119,370)

Net cash used in financing activities

 

 

(105,905)

 

 

(182,919)

 

 

(128,422)

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

 

 

48,952

 

 

(107,405)

 

 

(129,704)

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of the year

 

 

15,739

 

 

123,144

 

 

252,848

Cash and cash equivalents at end of the year

 

$

64,691

 

$

15,739

 

$

123,144

 

 

 

Note 25 Quarterly Results of Operations (unaudited)

 

The following is a summary of quarterly results:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

 

    

Fourth

    

Third

    

Second

    

First

    

 

 

 

 

quarter

 

quarter

 

quarter

 

quarter

 

Total

Interest and dividend income

 

$

39,658

 

$

40,764

 

$

38,472

 

$

41,554

 

$

160,448

Interest expense

 

 

3,873

 

 

3,700

 

 

3,719

 

 

3,516

 

 

14,808

Net interest income before provision for loan losses

 

 

35,785

 

 

37,064

 

 

34,753

 

 

38,038

 

 

145,640

Provision for loan losses

 

 

1,282

 

 

5,293

 

 

6,457

 

 

10,619

 

 

23,651

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

 

 

34,503

 

 

31,771

 

 

28,296

 

 

27,419

 

 

121,989

Non-interest income

 

 

9,992

 

 

11,608

 

 

10,504

 

 

7,923

 

 

40,027

Non-interest expense

 

 

34,423

 

 

33,370

 

 

33,314

 

 

34,902

 

 

136,009

Income before income taxes

 

 

10,072

 

 

10,009

 

 

5,486

 

 

440

 

 

26,007

Income tax expense

 

 

81

 

 

1,695

 

 

982

 

 

189

 

 

2,947

Net income

 

$

9,991

 

$

8,314

 

$

4,504

 

$

251

 

$

23,060

Income per share-basic

 

$

0.38

 

$

0.30

 

$

0.15

 

$

0.01

 

$

0.81

Income per share-diluted

 

$

0.36

 

$

0.30

 

$

0.15

 

$

0.01

 

$

0.79

 

 

124


 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

 

    

Fourth

    

Third

    

Second

    

First

    

 

 

 

 

quarter

 

quarter

 

quarter

 

quarter

 

Total

Interest and dividend income

 

$

43,492

 

$

42,311

 

$

42,517

 

$

43,087

 

$

171,407

Interest expense

 

 

3,563

 

 

3,629

 

 

3,662

 

 

3,608

 

 

14,462

Net interest income before provision for loan losses

 

 

39,929

 

 

38,682

 

 

38,855

 

 

39,479

 

 

156,945

Provision for loan losses

 

 

5,423

 

 

3,710

 

 

1,858

 

 

1,453

 

 

12,444

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

 

 

34,506

 

 

34,972

 

 

36,997

 

 

38,026

 

 

144,501

Non-interest income

 

 

15,419

 

 

3,761

 

 

2,747

 

 

(479)

 

 

21,448

Non-interest expense

 

 

42,230

 

 

38,677

 

 

40,393

 

 

36,724

 

 

158,024

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

 

7,695

 

 

56

 

 

(649)

 

 

823

 

 

7,925

Income tax expense (benefit)

 

 

4,355

 

 

(1,580)

 

 

692

 

 

(423)

 

 

3,044

Net income (loss)

 

$

3,340

 

$

1,636

 

$

(1,341)

 

$

1,246

 

$

4,881

Income (loss) per share-basic

 

$

0.11

 

$

0.05

 

$

(0.04)

 

$

0.03

 

$

0.14

Income (loss) per share-diluted

 

$

0.11

 

$

0.05

 

$

(0.04)

 

$

0.03

 

$

0.14

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2014

 

    

Fourth

    

Third

    

Second

    

First

    

 

 

 

 

quarter

 

quarter

 

quarter

 

quarter

 

Total

Interest and dividend income

 

$

46,280

 

$

45,492

 

$

46,005

 

$

46,885

 

$

184,662

Interest expense

 

 

3,696

 

 

3,597

 

 

3,582

 

 

3,538

 

 

14,413

Net interest income before provision for loan losses

 

 

42,584

 

 

41,895

 

 

42,423

 

 

43,347

 

 

170,249

Provision for loan losses

 

 

1,265

 

 

1,515

 

 

1,660

 

 

1,769

 

 

6,209

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

 

 

41,319

 

 

40,380

 

 

40,763

 

 

41,578

 

 

164,040

Non-interest income

 

 

(5,117)

 

 

1,614

 

 

2,161

 

 

(354)

 

 

(1,696)

Non-interest expense

 

 

33,149

 

 

37,981

 

 

39,855

 

 

39,018

 

 

150,003

Income before income taxes

 

 

3,053

 

 

4,013

 

 

3,069

 

 

2,206

 

 

12,341

Income tax expense

 

 

774

 

 

676

 

 

940

 

 

775

 

 

3,165

Net income

 

$

2,279

 

$

3,337

 

$

2,129

 

$

1,431

 

$

9,176

Income per share-basic

 

$

0.06

 

$

0.08

 

$

0.05

 

$

0.03

 

$

0.22

Income per share-diluted

 

$

0.06

 

$

0.08

 

$

0.05

 

$

0.03

 

$

0.22

 

 

 

 

 

125


 

Table of Contents

Item 9.       CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURES.

 

There were no changes in or disagreements with accountants on accounting and financial disclosures.

 

Item 9A.   CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES .

 

Conclusion Regarding the Effectiveness of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

 

Our management, with the participation of our principal executive officer and principal financial officer, conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures, as such term is defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as of December 31, 2016. Based on this evaluation, our principal executive officer and our principal financial officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of December 31, 2016.

 

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

 

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(f). Our management, with the participation of our principal executive officer and principal financial officer, conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016 based on the framework in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Based on this evaluation , our management concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2016. KPMG LLP, the independent registered public accounting firm that audited our consolidated financial statements included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, has issued a report on our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016, which report is included in this Item 9A below.

 

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

 

There were no changes made in the Company's internal controls over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company's internal control over financial reporting.

 

 

 

126


 

Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

The Board of Directors and Shareholders
National Bank Holdings Corporation:

We have audited National Bank Holdings Corporation’s (the Company) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, National Bank Holdings Corporation maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated statements of financial condition of the Company as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss), changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three‑year period ended December 31, 2016, and our report dated February 24, 2017 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements.

As discussed in note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company has changed its method of accounting for stock‑based compensation in 2016 due to the adoption of FASB Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2016‑09, Improvements to Employee Share‑Based Payment Accounting .

 

IMAGE - IMAGE2.JPEG

 

Kansas City, Missouri

February 24, 2017

127


 

Table of Contents

Item 9B.     OTHER INFORMATIO N

None.

 

PART III

 

Item 10.       DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE .

 

The Information required by this Item is incorporated herein by reference to our Proxy Statement (Schedule 14A) for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be filed with the SEC within 120 days of our fiscal year-end.

 

The Company's Supplemental Code of Ethics for CEO and Senior Financial Officers, which applies to the CEO, Chief Financial Officer and Principal Accounting Officer, is available at www.nationalbankholdings.com. Amendments to, and waivers of, the code of ethics are publicly disclosed as required by applicable law, regulation or rule.

 

Item 11.       EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION .

 

The Information required by this Item is incorporated herein by reference to our Proxy Statement (Schedule 14A) for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be filed with the SEC within 120 days of our fiscal year-end.

 

Item 12.       SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTERS.

 

The Information required by this Item is incorporated herein by reference to our Proxy Statement (Schedule 14A) for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be filed with the SEC within 120 days of our fiscal year-end.

 

Item 13.       CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE.

 

The Information required by this Item is incorporated herein by reference to our Proxy Statement (Schedule 14A) for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be filed with the SEC within 120 days of our fiscal year-end.

 

Item 14.       PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES .

 

The Information required by this Item is incorporated herein by reference to our Proxy Statement (Schedule 14A) for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be filed with the SEC within 120 days of our fiscal year-end.

 

128


 

Table of Contents

PART I V

 

Item 15.       EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES .

 

(a)

The following documents are filed as a part of this report:

 

(1)  Financial Statements:

 

(2)  Financial Statement Schedules:

 

All schedules are omitted as such information is inapplicable or is included in the financial statements.

 

(b)

The exhibits filed as part of this report and exhibits incorporated herein by reference to other documents are listed in the Index to Exhibits.

 

129


 

Table of Contents

 

SIGNATURE S

 

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on February 24, 2017, on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

National Bank Holdings Corporation

 

 

 

 

By

 

/s/ G. Timothy Laney

 

 

G. Timothy Laney

 

 

Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below on February 24, 2017, by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities indicated.

 

130


 

Table of Contents

 

 

 

/s/ G. TIMOTHY LANEY

G. Timothy Laney

Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer

(principal executive officer)

 

/s/ BRIAN F. LILLY

Brian F. Lilly

Chief Financial Officer; Chief of M&A and Strategy

(principal financial officer)

 

/s/ MICHAEL J. DALEY

Michael J. Daley

Chief Accounting Officer

(principal accounting officer)

 

/s/ RALPH W. CLERMONT

Ralph W. Clermont, Lead Director

 

/s/ ROBERT E. DEAN

Robert E. Dean, Director

 

/s/ FRED J. JOSEPH

Fred J. Joseph, Director

 

/s/ MICHO F. SPRING

Micho F. Spring, Director

 

/s/ BURNEY S. WARREN, III

Burney S. Warren, III, Director

 

/s/ ART ZEILE

Art Zeile, Director

 

 

 

131


 

Table of Contents

INDEX TO EXHIBIT S

 

 

 

 

3.1

 

Second Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to our Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-177971), filed on August 22, 2012)

 

 

 

3.2

 

Second Amended and Restated By-Laws (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to our Form 10-Q, filed on November 7, 2014)

 

 

 

4.1

 

Specimen common stock certificate (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to our Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-177971), filed on August 22, 2012)

 

 

 

4.2

 

Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009, by and between NBH Holdings Corp. and FBR Capital Markets, Inc. (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to our Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-177971), filed on November 14, 2011)

 

 

 

4.3

 

Amendment No. 1, dated as of July 20, 2011, to the Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009 by and between NBH Holdings Corp. and FBR Capital Markets, Inc. (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to our Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-177971), filed on November 14, 2011)

 

 

 

10.1

 

Form of Indemnification Agreement by and between NBH Holdings Corp. and each of its directors and executive officers (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to our Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration Statement No. 333-177971), filed on September 10, 2012)^

 

 

 

10.2

 

Employment Agreement, dated May 22, 2010, by and between G. Timothy Laney and NBH Holdings Corp. (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to our Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration Statement No. 333-177971), filed on September 10, 2012)^

 

 

 

10.3

 

First Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated November 17, 2015, by and between G. Timothy Laney and National Bank Holdings Corporation (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to our Form 8-K, filed on November 20, 2015)^

 

 

 

10.4

 

Separation and Consulting Agreement, dated November 17, 2015, by and between Thomas M. Metzger and National Bank Holdings Corporation (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to our Form 8-K, filed on November 20, 2015)^

 

 

 

10.5

 

Amended and Restated Employment Agreement, dated November 17, 2015, by and between Richard U. Newfield, Jr. and National Bank Holdings Corporation (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to our Form 8-K, filed on November 20, 2015)^

 

 

 

10.6

 

Employment Agreement, dated November 17, 2015, by and between Brian F. Lilly and National Bank Holdings Corporation (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to our Form 8-K, filed on November 20, 2015)^

 

 

 

10.7

 

Employment Agreement, dated November 17, 2015, by and between Zsolt K. Besskó and National Bank Holdings Corporation (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to our Form 8-K, filed on November 20, 2015)^

 

 

 

10.8

 

National Bank Holdings Corporation Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Annex A to the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A, filed on March 30, 2015)^

 

 

 

10.9

 

NBH Holdings Corp. 2009 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to our Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-177971), filed on November 14, 2011)^

 

 

 

10.10

 

Amendment to the NBH Holdings Corp. 2009 Equity Incentive Plan dated February 22, 2017 (filed herewith)^

 

 

 

132


 

Table of Contents

10.11

 

National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Annex A to the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A, filed on March 31, 2014)^

 

 

 

10.12

 

Form of National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan Performance Stock Unit Award Agreement (For Management) (filed herewith)^

 

 

 

10.13

 

Form of National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Award Agreement (For Management) (filed herewith)^

 

 

 

10.14

 

Form of National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement (For Management) (filed herewith)^

 

 

 

10.15

 

Form of National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan Market-Based Performance Award Agreement (For Management) (filed herewith)^

 

 

 

10.16

 

Form of National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Award Agreement (For Non-Employee Directors) (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to our Form 10-Q, filed on May 9, 2014)^

 

 

 

21.1

 

Subsidiaries of National Bank Holdings Corporation

 

 

 

23.1

 

Consent of KPMG LLP

 

 

 

31.1

 

Certification of CEO pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

 

 

 

31.2

 

Certification of CFO pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

 

 

 

32

 

Certifications of CEO and CFO pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

 

 

 

101

 

Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T: (i) the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition, (ii) the Consolidated Statements of Operations, (iii) the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss), (iv) the Consolidated Statements of Changes in Equity, (v) the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows and (vi) the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, tagged as blocks of text and in detail*

 


* This information is deemed furnished, not filed.

^ Indicates a management contract or compensatory plan.

 

133


 

Table of Contents

Corporate Headquarters

National Bank Holdings Corporation

7800 East Orchard Road, Suite 300

Greenwood Village, CO  80111

Tel:  720.554.6680

www.nationalbankholdings.com

 

 

Stock Exchange Listings

NYSE

Symbol:  NBHC

 

 

Independent Accountants

KPMG LLP

Kansas City, MO

 

 

Transfer Agent, Registrar and

Dividend Disbursing Agent

American Stock Exchange &

Trust Company, LLC

6201 15th Avenue

Brooklyn, NY  11219

Tel:  718.921.8275

Fax:  718.765.8717

www.amstock.com

 

 

 

134


Exhibit 10.10

AMENDMENT TO NBH HOLDINGS CORP. 2009 EQUITY INCENTIVE PLAN

Effective on February 22, 2017, Section 12(d)(ii) of the NBH Holdings Corp. 2009 Equity Incentive Plan dated October 20, 2009 is hereby amended and restated its entirety as follows:

“(ii)  Without limiting the generality of clause (i) above, the Committee may, in its sole discretion, permit a Participant to satisfy, in whole or in part, the foregoing withholding liability by (A) delivery of shares of Stock owned by the Participant, provided that such shares of Stock are not subject to any pledge or other security interest and have such other characteristics as may be determined in the sole discretion of the Committee) with a Fair Market Value no greater than the aggregate amount of such liabilities based on the maximum statutory withholding rates in such Participant’s applicable jurisdictions for federal, state, local or other income, employment, or other taxes or (B) having the Company withhold from the number of shares of Stock otherwise issuable pursuant to the exercise or settlement of the Award a number of shares with a Fair Market Value no greater than the aggregate amount of such liabilities based on the maximum statutory withholding rates in such Participant’s applicable jurisdictions for federal, state, local or other income, employment, or other taxes.  In the event of a conflict between the terms and provisions contained in this Section 12(d)(ii) and the terms and provisions in an award agreement issued pursuant to this Plan, the terms and provisions of this Section 12(d)(ii) shall govern and prevail.”

 


 

Exhibit 10.12

 

2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan
PERFORMANCE Stock UNIT Award Agreement

THIS PERFORMANCE STOCK UNIT AWARD AGREEMENT (this “ Agreement ”), dated as of [___________] (the “ Date of Grant ”), is made by and between National Bank Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“ NBHC ”), and [__________] (“ Participant ”).    Capitalized terms used herein without definition have the meanings ascribed to such terms in the National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “ Plan ”).

WHEREAS, NBHC has adopted the Plan to provide NBHC officers, employees, directors, and consultants an opportunity to participate in NBHC’s future performance and align the interests of such officers, employees, directors, and consultants with those of the shareholders of NBHC; and

WHEREAS, the Committee has determined that it would be in the best interests of NBHC and its shareholders to grant Participant a number of performance vesting Restricted Stock Units on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement and the Plan.

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the covenants of the parties contained in this Agreement, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto, for themselves, their successors and assigns, hereby agree as follows:

1. Grant of Performance Stock Unit Award .

(a)

Grant .  NBHC hereby grants to Participant an award of performance-vesting Restricted Stock Units (the “ PSUs ”) in respect of [_____] Shares (the “ EPS Target Number ”) and [ ______ ] Shares (the “ TSR Target Number ” and, together with the EPS Target Number, the “ Target Numbers ”),  in each case, on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement and as otherwise provided in the Plan.

(b)

Incorporation by Reference, Etc .  The provisions of the Plan are hereby incorporated herein by reference.  Except as otherwise expressly set forth herein, this Agreement shall be construed in accordance with the provisions of the Plan.

2. Vesting and Settlement .

(a)

General .  Except as may otherwise be provided herein, a number of PSUs (rounded down to the nearest whole number) (the “ Earned PSUs ”), if any, equal to the sum of (i) the EPS Earned PSUs (as defined in Annex A hereto) plus (ii) the TSR Earned PSUs (as defined in Annex A hereto) shall vest on the third anniversary of the Date of Grant (such date, the “ Vesting Date ”), subject to Participant having not incurred a Termination of Employment prior to the Vesting Date.  NBHC shall issue one Share to Participant for each Earned PSU within 10 days following the Vesting Date (and in no event later than March 15, 20[__]).

 


 

(b)

Determination of Earned PSUs and Vesting and Settlement in Connection with a Change in Control

(i)

Determination of Earned PSUs .  Notwithstanding anything in the Plan, effective as of immediately prior to a Change in Control, subject to the occurrence of such Change in Control, the number of Earned PSUs shall be established by the Committee based on the greater of the applicable Target Number and the level of achievement of actual performance as determined through the latest practicable date prior to such Change in Control (as determined by the Committee in its sole discretion).

(ii)

Vesting and Settlement of Earned PSUs .  The Earned PSUs shall be settled within five days following the occurrence of such Change in Control, unless a replacement or substitute award meeting the requirements of this Section  2(b)(ii) is provided to Participant in respect of the Earned PSUs (an award meeting the requirements of this Section  2(b)(ii), a “ Replacement Award ”).  An award shall qualify as a Replacement Award if: (A) it is a restricted stock unit with respect to a publicly traded equity security of NBHC or the surviving corporation  or the ultimate parent of the applicable entity following the Change in Control, (B) it has a fair market value at least equal to the value of the Earned PSUs established pursuant to Section  2(b)(i) as of the date of the Change in Control, (C) it contains terms relating to service-based vesting (including with respect to Termination of Employment) that are substantially identical to the terms set forth in this Agreement and does not contain any terms related to performance-based vesting, and (D) its other terms and conditions are not less favorable to Participant than the terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement or in the Plan (including provisions that apply in the event of a subsequent Change in Control) as of the date in the Change in Control. The determination of whether the conditions of this Section  2(b)(ii) are satisfied shall be made by the Committee, as constituted immediately prior to the Change in Control, in its sole discretion, prior to a Change in Control.  If a Replacement Award is provided, the Earned PSUs shall not be settled upon a Change in Control in accordance with the first sentence of this Section  2(b)(ii).

(iii)

Replacement Award .  If, in connection with a Change in Control, Participant is provided with a Replacement Award, such Replacement Award shall vest on the Vesting Date and be settled at the time provided in Section ‎2(a),  subject to Participant having not incurred a Termination of Employment prior to the Vesting Date;  provided that, if,  within two years following such Change in Control, Participant incurs a Termination of Employment without Cause, due to Participant’s resignation with Good Reason (as defined in Section ‎7(b)), or due to Participant’s death or Disability, then the Replacement Award shall become fully vested effective as of the date Termination of Employment, and NBHC shall issue one Share to Participant for each Replacement Award as soon as reasonably practicable, and in no event more than 10 days, following the date of Termination of Employment .

 

2

 


 

(c)

Other Terminations of Employment .  If Participant incurs a Termination of Employment prior to a Change in Control or under circumstances other than those set forth in Section  2(b)(ii) as applicable to a Replacement Award, any unvested PSUs shall be forfeited by Participant without consideration effective as of the date of Termination of Employment.

3. Tax Withholding; Independent Tax Advice .  NBHC shall reasonably determine the amount of any federal, state, local, or other income, employment, or other taxes that NBHC or any of its Subsidiaries may reasonably be obligated to withhold with respect to the grant, vesting, settlement, or other event with respect to the PSUs.  NBHC’s obligation to deliver any certificates evidencing the Shares provided upon settlement of the PSUs (or to make a book-entry or other electronic notation indicating ownership of such Shares) is subject to the condition precedent that Participant either pay or provide for the amount of any such withholding obligations in such manner as may be authorized by the Committee or as may otherwise be permitted under Section 14(d) of the Plan. Participant acknowledges that the tax laws and regulations applicable to the PSUs and the disposition of the Shares provided upon settlement of the PSUs are complex and subject to change, and it is the sole responsibility of Participant to obtain Participant’s own advice as to the tax treatment of the terms of this Agreement.

4. No Rights as Stockholder; Dividend Equivalent Credits .  Until such time as the PSUs have been settled pursuant to Section  2 and the underlying Shares have been delivered to Participant, and Participant has become the holder of such Shares, Participant shall have no rights as a stockholder, including, without limitation, the right to dividends or other distributions and the right to vote.    Notwithstanding the foregoing or Section 7(c) of the Plan, each PSU shall entitle Participant to dividend equivalents with respect to ordinary cash dividends that would otherwise be paid on the Share underlying such PSU during the period from the Date of Grant to the date such Share is delivered in accordance with Section  2.  Any such dividend equivalents shall be subject to the same vesting conditions applicable to the underlying PSU with respect to which they accrue, and shall, if the underlying PSU vests, be paid at the time as the underlying PSU is settled.

5. Non-Transferability .  The PSUs may not, at any time prior to becoming vested, be assigned, alienated, pledged, attached, sold, or otherwise transferred or encumbered by Participant other than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution, and any such purported assignment, alienation, pledge, attachment, sale, transfer, or encumbrance shall be void and unenforceable against NBHC, its Subsidiaries, and its Affiliates; provided that the designation of a beneficiary shall not constitute an assignment, alienation, pledge, attachment, sale, transfer, or encumbrance.  The PSUs shall be subject to the restrictions set forth in the Plan and this Agreement.

6. Adjustment .  In the event of any event described in Section 2(h) of the Plan occurring after the Date of Grant, the adjustment provisions as provided for under Section 2(h) of the Plan shall apply to the PSUs.

 

3

 


 

7.

Certain Definitions and Administration .

(a) Termination with Cause .  Unless otherwise provided under the termination with “cause” provisions of an Individual Agreement, to invoke a termination with Cause, NBHC must provide written notice to Participant of the existence of such grounds within 30 days following NBHC’s knowledge of the existence of such grounds, specifying in reasonable detail the grounds constituting Cause, and, with respect to the grounds enumerated in clauses (A), (C), (D), and (E) in the definition of Cause in the Plan, Participant shall have 30 days following receipt of such written notice during which he or she may remedy the ground if such ground is reasonably subject to cure as determined by NBHC. 

(b)

Good Reason ” shall have the meaning given to such term in an Individual Agreement, or if there is no such Individual Agreement or if it does not define Good Reason, then, Good Reason shall mean the occurrence of the following,  in the absence of Participant’s written consent:

(i)

a material diminution in Participant’s annual base salary from that in effect immediately prior to a Change in Control; or

(ii)

the assignment to Participant of any duties materially inconsistent with Participant’s positions (including status, offices, titles, and reporting requirements), authority, duties, or responsibilities, or any other action by NBHC that results in a material diminution in such positions, authority, duties, or responsibilities, in each case, from those in effect immediately prior to a Change in Control;

provided that, in each case, (A) Participant provides written notice to NBHC of the existence of one or more of the conditions described in clauses (i) through (ii) within 30 days following Participant’s knowledge of the initial existence of such condition or conditions, specifying in reasonable detail the conditions constituting Good Reason;  (B) NBHC and its Affiliates fail to cure such event or condition within 30 days following the receipt of such notice; and (C) Participant incurs a Termination of Employment within 30 days following the expiration of such cure period.

8. Forfeiture .    Participant agrees that, notwithstanding any other provision of any agreement to which he or she is subject with NBHC or NBH Bank (collectively, the “ Company ”), and in addition to and not in contravention of any clawback provision or policy applicable to Participant as in effect from time to time (including any clawback policies or provisions implemented pursuant to Section 954 of the Dodd-Frank Wall  Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act or other applicable law):

(a)

If the Company is required to prepare an accounting restatement due to material noncompliance of the Company as a result of Participant’s misconduct in connection with any financial reporting requirement under the federal securities laws, the Committee may require Participant to forfeit unvested the PSUs, and/or to reimburse the Company for all amounts received under this Agreement from the Company during the 12-month period following the first public issuance or filing with the Securities and Exchange Commission (whichever first occurs) of the financial

 

4

 


 

document embodying such financial reporting requirement, and any amounts received with respect to, or amounts realized upon, the settlement of the PSUs or the subsequent sale of the Shares that were issued upon settlement of the PSUs or the cancellation of the PSUs during that 12-month period;

(b)

If the Committee shall determine that Participant has engaged in a serious breach of conduct, the Committee may require Participant to forfeit unvested PSUs, may terminate this Agreement and/or require Participant to repay any amounts realized upon the settlement of the PSUs or on the subsequent sale of the Shares that were issued upon settlement of the PSUs or the cancellation of the PSUs; and

(c)

If Participant is found guilty of misconduct by any judicial or administrative authority in connection with any (i) formal investigation by the Securities and Exchange Commission or (ii) other federal or state regulatory investigation, then the Committee may require Participant to forfeit unvested PSUs and/or may require the repayment of any amounts realized upon the settlement of the PSUs or on the subsequent sale of the Shares that were issued upon settlement of the PSUs or the cancellation of the PSUs without regard to the timing of the determination of misconduct in relation to the timing of the settlement or sale of the award.

The foregoing provisions of this Section ‎8 shall cease to apply following a Change in Control, except as otherwise required by applicable law.

9. Compliance with Legal Requirements .  The grant of the PSUs and any other obligations of NBHC under this Agreement shall be subject to all applicable federal and state laws, rules, and regulations and to such approvals by any regulatory or governmental agency as may be required.  The Committee, in its sole discretion, may postpone the issuance or delivery of Shares as the Committee may consider appropriate and may require Participant to make such representations and furnish such information as it may consider appropriate in connection with the issuance or delivery of Shares in compliance with applicable laws, rules, and regulations.

10. Miscellaneous .

(a)

Confidentiality of this Agreement .  Participant agrees to keep confidential the terms of this Agreement, unless and until such terms have been disclosed publicly other than through a breach by Participant of this covenant.  This provision does not prohibit Participant from providing this information on a confidential and privileged basis to Participant’s attorneys or accountants for purposes of obtaining legal or tax advice or as otherwise required by law.

(b)

Restrictive Covenants .  The grant, vesting, and settlement of the PSUs pursuant to this Agreement shall be in partial consideration for, and subject to Participant’s continued compliance with, any restrictive covenants set forth in an Individual Agreement. 

(c)

Section 409A of the Code .  It is intended that the Awards granted pursuant to this Agreement and the provisions of this Agreement be exempt from or comply with Section 409A of the Code, and all provisions of this Agreement shall be construed

 

5

 


 

and interpreted in a manner consistent with Section 11(e) of the Plan and the requirements for avoiding taxes or penalties under Section 409A of the Code.

(d)

Waiver and Amendment .  The Committee may waive any conditions or rights under, or amend any terms of, this Agreement and the PSUs granted hereunder; provided that any such waiver or amendment that would impair the rights of any Participant or any holder or beneficiary of any PSUs heretofore granted shall not to that extent be effective without the consent of Participant.  No waiver of any right hereunder by any party shall operate as a waiver of any other right, or as a waiver of the same right with respect to any subsequent occasion for its exercise, or as a waiver of any right to damages.  No waiver by any party of any breach of this Agreement shall be held to constitute a waiver of any other breach or a waiver of the continuation of the same breach.

(e)

Notices .  All notices, demands and other communications provided for or permitted hereunder shall be made in writing and shall be by registered or certified first-class mail, return receipt requested, facsimile, courier service or personal delivery:

if to NBHC to:
National Bank Holdings Corporation
7800 East Orchard Road, Suite 300
Greenwood Village, CO 80111
Facsimile:  (855)  576-3479
Attention:  General Counsel

if to Participant:  at the address last on the records of NBHC.

All such notices, demands and other communications shall be deemed to have been duly given (i) when delivered by hand, if personally delivered; (ii) when delivered by courier, if delivered by commercial courier service; (iii) five business days after being deposited in the mail, postage prepaid, if mailed; and (iv) when receipt is mechanically acknowledged, if by facsimile.

(f) Severability .  The invalidity or unenforceability of any provision of this Agreement shall not affect the validity or enforceability of any other provision of this Agreement, and each other provision of this Agreement shall be severable and enforceable to the extent permitted by law.

(g) No Rights to Service .  Nothing contained in this Agreement shall be construed as giving Participant any right to be retained, in any position, as an employee, consultant, or director of NBHC or its Affiliates or shall interfere with or restrict in any way the right of NBHC or its Affiliates, which is hereby expressly reserved, to remove, terminate, or discharge Participant at any time for any reason whatsoever.

(h) Beneficiary .  Participant may file with NBHC a written designation of a beneficiary on such form as may be prescribed by the Committee and may, from time to time, change or revoke such designation by filing a new designation with NBHC.  The last such designation received by NBHC shall be controlling; provided ,   however , that no designation, or change or

 

6

 


 

revocation thereof, shall be effective unless received by NBHC prior to Participant’s death, and in no event shall it be effective as of a date prior to such receipt.  If no beneficiary designation is filed by Participant, the beneficiary shall be deemed to be his or her spouse or, if Participant is unmarried at the time of death, his or her estate.

(i) Successors .  The terms of this Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of NBHC, its successors and assigns, and of Participant and the beneficiaries, executors, administrators, heirs and successors of Participant.

(j) Entire Agreement .  This Agreement and the Plan contain the entire agreement and understanding of the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter contained herein and supersede all prior communications, representations and negotiations with respect thereto.

(k) Bound by the Plan .  By signing this Agreement, Participant acknowledges that he or she has received a copy of the Plan and has had an opportunity to review the Plan and agrees to be bound by all the terms and provisions of the Plan.

(l) Governing Law .  This Agreement shall be construed and interpreted in accordance with the internal laws of the State of Delaware without regard to principles of conflicts of law thereof, or principles of conflicts of laws of any other jurisdiction that could cause the application of the laws of any jurisdiction other than the State of Delaware .

(m) Headings .  The headings of the Sections of this Agreement are provided for convenience only and are not to serve as a basis for interpretation or construction, and shall not constitute a part, of this Agreement.

(n) Counterparts .  This Agreement may be signed in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

[ Signature Page Follows ]

 

 

7

 


 

 

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement as of the date first written above.

NATIONAL BANK HOLDINGS CORPORATION

 

 

By: _____________________________________
      Name:

      Title:

 

 

By: _____________________________________
      Name:

      Title:

 

 

PARTICIPANT

 

 

_________________________________________
[
Participant Name ]

 

 

[ Signature Page to PSU Award Agreement ]

 


 

 

 

 

Annex A
Performance Metrics

For purposes of this Agreement, the following terms have the meanings ascribed thereto below:

Adjusted Relative TSR Factor ” shall mean (a) if NBHC’s TSR for the Measurement Period is less than zero, then the lesser of (i) the Relative TSR Factor and (ii) 1.000; and (b) if NBHC’s TSR for the Measurement Period is equal to or greater than zero, then the Relative TSR Factor.

“Cumulative EPS” shall mean NBHC’s cumulative earnings per share for each of the fiscal years during the Performance Period, as reported in NBHC’s audited financial statements in NBHC’s Annual Report on Form 10-K (the “ Annual Report ”), as adjusted to eliminate the effects of the following: (a) changes in law or accounting principles, (b) one-time effects of mergers and acquisitions, (c) gains or losses on the extinguishment of debt or the sale of investment securities, (d) restructuring charges, and (e) any other expenses or losses resulting from unusual and/or nonrecurring events, as described in management's discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations appearing in the Company’s Annual Report for the applicable fiscal year during the Performance Period, in each case as determined in good faith by the Compensation Committee. 

 

EPS Earned PSUs ” shall mean the product of (a) the EPS Target Number multiplied by (b) the EPS Factor.

EPS Factor ” shall mean the factor determined and certified by the Committee based on Cumulative EPS for the Measurement Period as follows:

Cumulative EPS for the Measurement Period

EPS Factor

Less than [$___].....................................................................................

0.000 

Equal to [$___].......................................................................................

0.500 

Equal to [$___].......................................................................................

1.000 

Equal to or greater than [$___]...............................................................

1.500 

 

 

Linear interpolation shall be used between the applicable Cumulative EPS targets set forth above.  In no event will the EPS Factor exceed 1.500.

GAAP ” shall mean the generally accepted accounting principles in effect from time to time in the United States, applied on a consistent basis.

Measurement Period ” shall mean the period commencing on January 1, 20[__] and ending on December 31, 20[end of 3 rd fiscal year from commencement date].

Relative TSR ” shall mean the percentile ranking of NBHC’s TSR among the TSRs for the companies included in the KBW Regional Banking Index as of the first day of the Measurement Period; provided that any company that is not continuously included in the KBW

A-1


 

Regional Banking Index during the Measurement Period shall be excluded from the determination of Relative TSR.

Relative TSR Factor ” shall mean the factor determined and certified by the Committee based on Relative TSR for the Measurement Period as follows:

Relative TSR for the Measurement Period (%ile)

Relative TSR Payment Factor

Less than [___] percentile.......................................................................

0.000 

Equal to [___] percentile.........................................................................

0.500 

Equal to [___] percentile.........................................................................

1.000 

Greater than [___] percentile...................................................................

1.500 

 

 

Linear interpolation shall be used between the applicable Relative TSR targets set forth above.  In no event will the Relative TSR Factor exceed 1.500.

TSR ” shall mean, with respect to a particular company, total shareholder return for such company over the Measurement Period,  calculated using the average closing stock price for the 20 trading days prior to and including December 31, 20[__] and the average closing stock price for the 20 trading days prior to and including December 31, 20[+  3 years], assuming dividends are reinvested in such company’s common stock on the ex-dividend date.

TSR Earned PSUs ” shall mean the product of (a) the TSR Target Number multiplied by (b) the Adjusted Relative TSR Factor.

 

A-2


 

Exhibit 10.13

 

2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan 
Restricted Stock Award Agreement

THIS RESTRICTED STOCK AWARD AGREEMENT (this “ Agreement ”), dated as of [_______] (the “ Date of Grant ”), is made by and between National Bank Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“ NBHC ”), and [____________] (“ Participant ”).    Capitalized terms used herein without definition have the meanings ascribed to such terms in the National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “ Plan ”).

WHEREAS, NBHC has adopted the Plan to provide NBHC officers, employees, directors and consultants an opportunity to participate in NBHC’s future performance and align the interests of such officers, employees, directors and consultants with those of the shareholders of NBHC; and

WHEREAS, the Committee has determined that it would be in the best interests of NBHC and its shareholders to grant Participant a number of restricted shares of Common Stock on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement and the Plan.

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the covenants of the parties contained in this Agreement, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto, for themselves, their successors and assigns, hereby agree as follows:

1. Grant of Restricted Stock Award .

(a)

Grant .  NBHC hereby grants to Participant an award of Restricted Stock with respect to an aggregate of [_______] restricted shares of Common Stock (the “ Restricted Stock ”), on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement and as otherwise provided in the Plan.

(b)

Incorporation by Reference, Etc .  The provisions of the Plan are hereby incorporated herein by reference.  Except as otherwise expressly set forth herein, this Agreement shall be construed in accordance with the provisions of the Plan.

2. Vesting .

(a)

General .   Except as may otherwise be provided herein, (i) one-third (rounded down to the nearest whole Share if applicable) of the Shares of Restricted Stock shall vest on [_____________]; (ii) one-third (rounded down to the nearest whole Share if applicable) of the Shares of Restricted Stock shall vest on [_____________]; and (iii) the remaining Shares of Restricted Stock shall vest on [_____________], in each case, subject to Participant not having incurred a Termination of Employment as of the applicable vesting date. 

(b)

Vesting upon Death or Disability .  If Participant incurs a Termination of Employment due to Participant’s death or Disability, the restrictions on any unvested Restricted Stock shall immediately lapse and the Restricted Stock shall be fully vested as of the date of Termination of Employment.

 


 

(c)

Vesting Following a Change in Control .  If, in connection with a Change in Control, Participant is provided with a Replacement Award (as defined in Section ‎9)  and within two years following such Change in Control, Participant incurs a Termination of Employment without Cause or due to Participant’s resignation with Good Reason (as defined in Section ‎13), all the unvested Restricted Stock (or other form of Replacement Award) shall become fully vested.  If Participant is not provided with a Replacement Award in connection with a Change in Control, the Restricted Stock will vest in accordance with Section ‎9.

(d)

Other Termination of Employment .  If Participant incurs a Termination of Employment (i) that is not within two years following a Change in Control or (ii) for any reason other than death or Disability, any unvested Restricted Stock shall be forfeited by Participant without consideration.

3. Tax Withholding .  NBHC shall reasonably determine the amount of any federal, state, local or other income, employment or other taxes that NBHC or any of its subsidiaries may reasonably be obligated to withhold with respect to the grant, vesting or other event with respect to the Restricted Stock.  NBHC’s obligation to deliver the Restricted Stock or any certificates evidencing the Restricted Stock (or to make a book entry or other electronic notation indicating ownership of the Shares), or otherwise remove the restrictive notations or legends on such Shares or certificates that refer to nontransferability as set forth in Section  5, is subject to the condition precedent that Participant either pay or provide for the amount of any such withholding obligations in such manner as may be authorized by the Committee or as may otherwise be permitted under Section 14(d) of the Plan.

4. Independent Tax Advice .  Participant acknowledges that the tax laws and regulations applicable to the Restricted Stock and the disposition of the Restricted Stock following vesting are complex and subject to change, and it is the sole responsibility of Participant to obtain Participant’s own advice as to the tax treatment of the terms of this Agreement.

5. Issuance of Restricted Stock .  The Restricted Stock shall be issued by NBHC and shall be registered in Participant’s name on the stock transfer books of NBHC promptly after the Date of Grant.   Any certificates representing Restricted Stock shall remain in the physical custody of NBHC or its designee at all times prior to, in the case of any particular Share of the Restricted Stock, the date on which such Share vests.  Any certificates representing Restricted Stock shall have affixed thereto a legend in substantially the following form, in addition to any other legends that may be required under federal or state securities laws:

Transfer of this certificate and the shares represented hereby is restricted pursuant to the terms of the National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan and a Restricted Stock Award Agreement, dated as of [____________], between National Bank Holdings Corporation and [____________].  A copy of such Agreement is on file at the offices of National Bank Holdings Corporation.

As soon as practicable following the vesting of any Restricted Stock, NBHC shall ensure that its stock transfer books reflect the vesting.  If certificates for the Restricted Stock exist, such

 

2

 


 

certificates for such vested Restricted Stock shall be delivered to Participant or to Participant’s legal representative along with the stock powers relating thereto.

6. Dividend and Voting Rights .  After the Date of Grant, Participant shall be the record owner of the Restricted Stock, unless and until such Restricted Stock is forfeited pursuant to Participant’s Termination of Employment or sold or otherwise disposed of, and as record owner shall be entitled to all rights of a common stockholder of NBHC, including, without limitation, voting rights and rights to payment of cash or in-kind dividends, if any, with respect to the Restricted Stock; provided that the Restricted Stock shall be subject to the limitations on transfer and encumbrance set forth in this Agreement and the Plan.

7. Non-Transferability .  The Restricted Stock may not, at any time prior to becoming vested, be assigned, alienated, pledged, attached, sold or otherwise transferred or encumbered by Participant other than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution, and any such purported assignment, alienation, pledge, attachment, sale, transfer or encumbrance shall be void and unenforceable against NBHC, its Subsidiaries and its Affiliates;   provided that the designation of a beneficiary shall not constitute an assignment, alienation, pledge, attachment, sale, transfer or encumbrance.  The Restricted Stock shall be subject to the restrictions set forth in the Plan and this Agreement.

8. Adjustment .  In the event of any event described in Section 3(h) of the Plan occurring after the Date of Grant, the adjustment provisions as provided for under Section 3(h) of the Plan shall apply to the Restricted Stock.

9. Change in Control .  Notwithstanding anything in the Plan or otherwise set forth in this Agreement to the contrary, upon the occurrence of a Change in Control, all restrictions on the Restricted Stock shall immediately lapse and the Restricted Stock shall be fully vested, except to the extent that another award meeting the requirements of this Section ‎9 is provided to Participant to replace the Restricted Stock award (an award meeting the requirements of this Section ‎9, a “ Replacement Award ”).  An award shall meet the conditions of this Section ‎9 (and hence, qualify as a Replacement Award) if: (i) it is a restricted publicly traded equity security of NBHC or the surviving corporation or the ultimate parent of the applicable entity following the Change in Control, (ii) it has a fair market value at least equal to the value of the Restricted Stock granted pursuant to this Agreement as of the date of the Change in Control, (iii) it contains terms relating to vesting (including with respect to Termination of Employment) that are substantially identical to the terms set forth in this Agreement, and (iv) its other terms and conditions are not less favorable to Participant than the terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement or in the Plan (including provisions that apply in the event of a subsequent Change in Control) as of the date in the Change in Control.  Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, a Replacement Award may take the form of a continuation of this award if the requirements of the preceding sentence are satisfied.  If a Replacement Award is granted, the Restricted Stock shall not vest upon a Change in Control.  The determination of whether the conditions of this Section ‎9 are satisfied shall be made by the Committee, as constituted immediately prior to the Change in Control, in its sole discretion.

10. Forfeiture .    Participant agrees that, notwithstanding any other provision of any agreement to which he or she is subject with NBHC or NBH Bank (collectively, the “ Company ”), and in

 

3

 


 

addition to and not in contravention of any clawback provision or policy applicable to Participant as in effect from time to time (including any clawback policies or provisions implemented pursuant to Section 954 of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act or other applicable laws):

(a)

If the Company is required to prepare an accounting restatement due to material noncompliance of the Company as a result of Participant’s misconduct in connection with any financial reporting requirement under the federal securities laws, the Committee may require Participant to forfeit unvested Restricted Stock, and/or to reimburse the Company for all amounts received under this Agreement from the Company during the 12-month period following the first public issuance or filing with the Securities and Exchange Commission (whichever first occurs) of the financial document embodying such financial reporting requirement,  and any amounts received with respect to, or amounts realized from, the vesting of Restricted Stock or the subsequent sale of Shares or the cancellation of Restricted Stock during that 12 month period ;

(b)

If the Committee shall determine that Participant has engaged in a serious breach of conduct, the Committee may require Participant to forfeit unvested Restricted Stock, may terminate this Agreement and/or require Participant to repay any amounts realized upon the vesting of Restricted Stock  or on the subsequent sale of the shares of common stock that were granted as Restricted Stock or the cancellation of shares relating to Restricted Stock ; and

(c)

If Participant is found guilty of misconduct by any judicial or administrative authority in connection with any (i) formal investigation by the Securities and Exchange Commission or (ii) other federal or state regulatory investigation, the Committee may require Participant to forfeit unvested Restricted Stock and/or may require the repayment of any amounts realized upon the vesting of Restricted Stock or on the subsequent sale of the shares of common stock that were granted as Restricted Stock or the cancellation of shares relating to Restricted Stock without regard to the timing of the determination of misconduct in relation to the timing of the vesting or sale of the award .

The foregoing provisions of this Section 10 shall cease to apply following a Change in Control, except as otherwise required by applicable law.

 

11. Miscellaneous .

(a)

Confidentiality of this Agreement .  Participant agrees to keep confidential the terms of this Agreement, unless and until such terms have been disclosed publicly other than through a breach by Participant of this covenant.  This provision does not prohibit Participant from providing this information on a confidential and privileged basis to Participant’s attorneys or accountants for purposes of obtaining legal or tax advice or as otherwise required by law.

 

4

 


 

(b)

Restrictive Covenant.  The grant and vesting of the Restricted Stock pursuant to this Agreement shall be in partial consideration and subject to Participant’s continued compliance with any restrictive covenants set forth in an Individual Agreement.

(c)

Waiver and Amendment .  The Committee may waive any conditions or rights under, or amend any terms of, this Agreement and the Restricted Stock granted hereunder; provided that any such waiver or amendment that would impair the rights of any Participant or any holder or beneficiary of any Restricted Stock heretofore granted shall not to that extent be effective without the consent of Participant.  No waiver of any right hereunder by any party shall operate as a waiver of any other right, or as a waiver of the same right with respect to any subsequent occasion for its exercise, or as a waiver of any right to damages.  No waiver by any party of any breach of this Agreement shall be held to constitute a waiver of any other breach or a waiver of the continuation of the same breach.

(d)

Notices .  All notices, demands and other communications provided for or permitted hereunder shall be made in writing and shall be by registered or certified first-class mail, return receipt requested, facsimile, courier service or personal delivery:

if to NBHC to:
National Bank Holdings Corporation
7800 East Orchard Road, Suite 300
Greenwood Village, CO 80111
Facsimile:  (855) 576-3479
Attention:  Legal Department

if to Participant:  at the address last on the records of NBHC.

All such notices, demands and other communications shall be deemed to have been duly given (i) when delivered by hand, if personally delivered; (ii) when delivered by courier, if delivered by commercial courier service; (iii) five business days after being deposited in the mail, postage prepaid, if mailed; and (iv) when receipt is mechanically acknowledged, if by facsimile.

(e) Severability .  The invalidity or unenforceability of any provision of this Agreement shall not affect the validity or enforceability of any other provision of this Agreement, and each other provision of this Agreement shall be severable and enforceable to the extent permitted by law.

(f) No Rights to Service .  Nothing contained in this Agreement shall be construed as giving Participant any right to be retained, in any position, as an employee, consultant or director of NBHC or its Affiliates or shall interfere with or restrict in any way the right of NBHC or its Affiliates, which is hereby expressly reserved, to remove, terminate or discharge Participant at any time for any reason whatsoever.

(g) Beneficiary .  Participant may file with NBHC a written designation of a beneficiary on such form as may be prescribed by the Committee and may, from time to time, change or revoke such designation by filing a new designation with NBHC.  The last such designation

 

5

 


 

received by NBHC shall be controlling; provided ,   however , that no designation, or change or revocation thereof, shall be effective unless received by NBHC prior to Participant’s death, and in no event shall it be effective as of a date prior to such receipt.  If no beneficiary designation is filed by Participant, the beneficiary shall be deemed to be his or her spouse or, if Participant is unmarried at the time of death, his or her estate.

(h) Successors .  The terms of this Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of NBHC, its successors and assigns, and of Participant and the beneficiaries, executors, administrators, heirs and successors of Participant.

(i) Entire Agreement .  This Agreement and the Plan contain the entire agreement and understanding of the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter contained herein and supersede all prior communications, representations and negotiations with respect thereto.

(j) Bound by the Plan .  By signing this Agreement, Participant acknowledges that he or she has received a copy of the Plan and has had an opportunity to review the Plan and agrees to be bound by all the terms and provisions of the Plan.

(k) Governing Law .  This Agreement shall be construed and interpreted in accordance with the internal laws of the State of Delaware without regard to principles of conflicts of law thereof, or principles of conflicts of laws of any other jurisdiction that could cause the application of the laws of any jurisdiction other than the State of Delaware .

(l) Headings .  The headings of the Sections of this Agreement are provided for convenience only and are not to serve as a basis for interpretation or construction, and shall not constitute a part, of this Agreement.

(m) Counterparts .  This Agreement may be signed in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

12. Compliance with Legal Requirements .  The grant of the Restricted Stock and any other obligations of NBHC under this Agreement shall be subject to all applicable federal and state laws, rules and regulations and to such approvals by any regulatory or governmental agency as may be required.  The Committee, in its sole discretion, may postpone the issuance or delivery of Shares as the Committee may consider appropriate and may require Participant to make such representations and furnish such information as it may consider appropriate in connection with the issuance or delivery of the Shares in compliance with applicable laws, rules and regulations.

13.

Definitions and Administration .

(a)

Termination for Cause .    Unless otherwise provided under the termination with “cause” provisions of an Individual Agreement, to invoke a termination for Cause, NBHC must provide written notice to Participant of the existence of such grounds within 30 days following NBHC’s knowledge of the existence of such grounds, specifying in reasonable detail the grounds constituting Cause, and, with respect to the grounds enumerated in clauses (A), (C), (D) and (E) of the definition of Cause in the Plan, Participant shall have 30 days following receipt of such written notice

 

6

 


 

during which he or she may remedy the ground if such ground is reasonably subject to cure as determined by NBHC. 

(b)

Good Reason ” shall have the meaning given to such term in an Individual Agreement, or if there is no such Individual Agreement or if it does not define Good Reason, then, Good Reason shall mean the occurrence of the following, in the absence of Participant’s written consent:

(i)

a material diminution in Participant’s annual base salary from that in effect immediately prior to a Change in Control; or

(ii)

the assignment to Participant of any duties materially inconsistent with Participant’s positions (including status, offices, titles and reporting requirements), authority, duties or responsibilities, or any other action by NBHC that results in a material diminution in such positions, authority, duties or responsibilities, in each case, from those in effect immediately prior to a Change in Control; or

provided that, in each case, (A) Participant provides written notice to NBHC of the existence of one or more of the conditions described in clauses (i) through (ii) above within 30 days following Participant’s knowledge of the initial existence of such condition or conditions, specifying in reasonable detail the conditions constituting Good Reason; (B) NBHC and its Affiliates fail to cure such event or condition within 30 days following the receipt of such notice; and (C) Participant incurs a Termination of Employment within 30 days following the expiration of such cure period.

[ Signature Page Follows ]

 

 

7

 


 

 

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement as of the date first written above.

NATIONAL BANK HOLDINGS CORPORATION

 

 

By: ____________________________________
Name:
Title:  

 

 

By: ____________________________________
Name:
Title:  

 

 

PARTICIPANT

 

 

_______________________________________
[Participant]

 

[ Signature Page to Restricted Stock Award Agreement ]

 


Exhibit 10.14

 

2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan 
Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement

THIS OPTION AGREEMENT (this “ Agreement ”), dated as of [________]  (the “ Date of Grant ”), is made by and between National Bank Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“ NBHC ”), and [____________] (“ Participant ”).  Capitalized terms used herein without definition have the meanings ascribed to such terms in the National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “ Plan ”).

WHEREAS, NBHC has adopted the Plan pursuant to which Nonqualified Stock Options may be granted to purchase shares of Common Stock; and

WHEREAS, the Committee has determined that it would be in the best interests of NBHC and its shareholders to grant Participant Nonqualified Stock Options on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement and the Plan.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the covenants of the parties contained in this Agreement, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto, for themselves, their successors and assigns, hereby agree as follows:

1.

Grant of Option .

(a)

Grant .  NBHC hereby grants to Participant a Nonqualified Stock Option (the “ Option ” and any portion thereof, the “ Options ”) to purchase [______] shares of Common Stock (such shares of Common Stock, the “ Shares ”), on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement and as otherwise provided in the Plan.  The Option is not intended to qualify as an incentive stock option within the meaning of Section 422 of the Code.

(b)

Incorporation by Reference, Etc .  The provisions of the Plan are hereby incorporated herein by reference.  Except as otherwise expressly set forth herein, this Agreement shall be construed in accordance with the provisions of the Plan.

2.

Option; Option Price .

(a)

Option Price .  The option price, being the price at which Participant shall be entitled to purchase the Shares upon the exercise of all or any of the Options, shall be $[_____] per Share (the “ Option Price ”).

(b)

Payment of the Option Price .  The Option may be exercised only by written notice, substantially in the form provided by NBHC, delivered in accordance with Section  11(d) and accompanied by payment of the Option Price.  The aggregate Option Price shall be payable in cash, or, to the extent permitted by the Committee, by any of the other methods permitted under Section 5(g) of the Plan.

 


 

3.

Vesting .    Except as may otherwise be provided herein, the Option shall become nonforfeitable (any Options that shall have become nonforfeitable pursuant to this Section  3, the “ Vested Options ”) and shall become exercisable according to the following provisions:

(a)

General Vesting .  (i) one-third of the Options (rounded down to the nearest whole Share, if applicable) shall become Vested Options and shall become exercisable on the [______________]; (ii) one-third of the Options (rounded down to the nearest whole Share, if applicable) shall become Vested Options and shall become exercisable on the [______________]; and (iii) the remaining Options shall become Vested Options and shall become exercisable on [______________],  in each case, subject to Participant not having incurred a Termination of Employment as of the applicable vesting date. 

(b)

Vesting upon Retirement .   If Participant incurs a Termination of Employment due to Retirement (as defined below), the Options shall continue to vest and be exercisable according to the terms of this Agreement as though no Termination of Employment had occurred.  For the purposes of this Agreement, “ Retirement ” shall mean Participant’s voluntary resignation at a time when (i) Participant is at least 60 years of age and (ii) Participant has been employed by NBHC for no less than 10 years.  For the purposes of determining Participant’s eligibility for Retirement under this Agreement, if Participant was employed by a company or entity that NBHC acquired or that merged with NBHC, Participant’s employment with NBHC shall be deemed to have begun on the closing date of the transaction in which NBHC acquired or merged with such company or entity.

(c)

Vesting upon Death or Disability .   If Participant incurs a Termination of Employment due to death or Disability, or dies following Participant’s Termination of Employment due to Retirement, all Options that have not theretofore become Vested Options shall become Vested Options and be exercisable in accordance with Section  4.

(d)

Vesting Following a Change in Control .   If, in connection with a Change in Control, Participant is provided with a Replacement Award (as defined in Section 8) and within two years following such a Change in Control, Participant incurs a Termination of Employment without Cause or due to Participant’s resignation with Good Reason (as defined in Section  12), all of the Options (or other form of Replacement Award) that were not theretofore Vested Options shall become Vested Options (or otherwise vest as applicable to the Replacement Award) and shall be exercisable as of the date of such Termination of Employment.   The Option (or other form of Replacement Award) shall remain exercisable, if applicable, as provided in Section  4(b).   If no Replacement Award is provided in connection with a Change in Control, the outstanding Option shall vest and become exercisable in full in accordance with Section 8.

(e)

Other Termination of Employment .    If Participant incurs a Termination of Employment (i) that is not within two years following a Change in Control or (ii) for any reason other than Retirement, death or Disability, any Options that have not

2


 

theretofore become Vested Options shall be forfeited by Participant without consideration.

4.

Termination .

(a)

The Options (to the extent not otherwise forfeited) shall automatically terminate and shall become null and void, be unexercisable and be of no further force and effect upon the earliest of:

(i)

the tenth anniversary of the Date of Grant;

(ii)

the first anniversary of Participant’s Termination of Employment in the case of a Termination of Employment due to death or Disability;

(iii)

the 90th day following Participant’s Termination of Employment in the case of a Termination of Employment by NBHC without Cause or a Termination of Employment due to Participant’s resignation for any reason; and

(iv)

the day of Participant’s Termination of Employment in the case of a Termination of Employment for Cause.

(b)

Notwithstanding the provisions of Section  4(a) to the contrary, in the event of Participant’s Termination of Employment for any reason (other than due to a Termination of Employment for Cause) during the two-year period following a Change in Control, the Option (or other form of Replacement Award, if applicable) shall remain outstanding and exercisable until the earlier of (i) the tenth anniversary of the Date of Grant and (ii) the fifth anniversary of such Termination of Employment.

5.

Compliance with Legal Requirements .    The grant and exercise of the Option and any other obligations of NBHC under this Agreement shall be subject to all applicable federal and state laws, rules and regulations and to such approvals by any regulatory or governmental agency as may be required.  The Committee, in its sole discretion, may postpone the issuance or delivery of the Shares as the Committee may consider appropriate, and may require Participant to make such representations and furnish such information as it may consider appropriate in connection with the issuance or delivery of the Shares in compliance with applicable laws, rules and regulations.

6.

Non-Transferability .    The Option may not be assigned, alienated, pledged, attached, sold or otherwise transferred or encumbered by Participant other than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution, and any such purported assignment, alienation, pledge, attachment, sale, transfer or encumbrance shall be void and unenforceable against NBHC, its Subsidiaries or Affiliates;   provided that the designation of a beneficiary shall not constitute an assignment, alienation, pledge, attachment, sale, transfer or encumbrance.  The Option and any Shares received upon exercise thereof shall be subject to the restrictions set forth in the Plan and this Agreement.

3


 

7.

Adjustment .    In the event of any event described in Section 3(h) of the Plan occurring after the Date of Grant, the adjustment provisions as provided for under Section 3(h) of the Plan shall apply to the Option.

8.

Change in Control .    Notwithstanding anything in the Plan or otherwise set forth in this Agreement to the contrary, upon the occurrence of a Change in Control, the Option, if outstanding, shall vest and become exercisable in full, except to the extent that another award meeting the requirements of this Section  8 is provided to Participant to replace the Option (any award meeting the requirements of this Section  8, a “ Replacement Award ”).   An award shall meet the conditions of this Section  8 (and hence qualify as a Replacement Award) if: (a) it is a stock option or stock appreciation right in respect of publicly traded equity securities of NBHC or the surviving corporation or the ultimate parent of the applicable entity following the Change in Control, (b) it has a value at least equal to the value of the Option as of the date of the Change in Control (other than in respect of customary fractional rounding of share amounts and exercise price), (c) it contains terms relating to vesting and exercisability (including with respect to Termination of Employment) that are substantially identical to those of the Option, and (d) its other terms and conditions are not less favorable to Participant than the terms and conditions of the Option (including provisions that apply in the event of a subsequent Change in Control) as of the date of the Change in Control.  Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, a Replacement Award may take the form of a continuation of the Option if the requirements of the preceding sentence are satisfied.  The determination of whether the conditions of this Section  8 are satisfied shall be made by the Committee, as constituted immediately before the Change in Control, in its sole discretion. 

9.

Tax Withholding .  As a condition to exercising the Option, in whole or in part, Participant will pay to NBHC, or, to the extent permitted by the Committee, make provisions satisfactory to NBHC for payment of, any federal, state or local tax in respect of the exercise or the transfer of the Shares pursuant to Section 14(d) of the Plan.

10.

Forfeiture .   Participant agrees that, notwithstanding any other provision of any agreement to which he or she is subject with NBHC or NBH Bank (collectively, the “ Company ”), and in addition to and not in contravention of any clawback provision or policy applicable to Participant as in effect from time to time (including any clawback policies or provisions implemented pursuant to Section 954 of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act or other applicable laws):

(a)

If the Company is required to prepare an accounting restatement due to material noncompliance of the Company as a result of Participant’s misconduct in connection with any financial reporting requirement under the federal securities laws, Participant shall reimburse the Company for all amounts received under this Agreement from the Company during the 12-month period following the first public issuance or filing with the Securities and Exchange Commission (whichever first occurs) of the financial document embodying such financial reporting requirement, and any amounts received with respect to, or amounts realized upon, the exercise of Options or the subsequent sale of the underlying Shares that were issued upon the exercise of the Options or the cancellation of the Options during that 12-month period;

4


 

(b)

If the Committee shall determine that Participant has engaged in a serious breach of conduct, the Committee may terminate this Agreement, cancel all Options and/ or require Participant to repay gain realized on the exercise of Options; and

(c)

If Participant is found guilty of misconduct by any judicial or administrative authority in connection with any (i) formal investigation by the Securities and Exchange Commission or (ii) other federal or state regulatory investigation, then the Committee may terminate this Agreement, require Participant to forfeit Options and/or may require the repayment of any gain realized on the exercise of any Options without regard to the timing of the determination of misconduct in relation to the timing of the exercise of the Option.

The foregoing provisions of this Section 10 shall cease to apply following a Change in Control, except as otherwise required by applicable law.

11.

Miscellaneous .

(a)

Confidentiality of this Agreement .  Participant agrees to keep confidential the terms of this Agreement, unless and until such terms have been disclosed publicly other than through a breach by Participant of this covenant.  This provision does not prohibit Participant from providing this information on a confidential and privileged basis to Participant’s attorneys or accountants for purposes of obtaining legal or tax advice or as otherwise required by law.

(b)

Restrictive Covenant.  The grant and vesting of the Options pursuant to this Agreement shall be in partial consideration and subject to Participant’s continued compliance with any restrictive covenants set forth in an Individual Agreement.

(c)

Waiver and Amendment .  The Committee may waive any conditions or rights under, or amend any terms of, this Agreement and the Option granted hereunder; provided that any such waiver or amendment that would impair the rights of any Participant or any holder or beneficiary of any Option heretofore granted shall not to that extent be effective without the consent of Participant.  No waiver of any right hereunder by any party shall operate as a waiver of any other right, or as a waiver of the same right with respect to any subsequent occasion for its exercise, or as a waiver of any right to damages.  No waiver by any party of any breach of this Agreement shall be held to constitute a waiver of any other breach or a waiver of the continuation of the same breach.

(d)

Notices .  All notices, demands and other communications provided for or permitted hereunder shall be made in writing and shall be by registered or certified first-class mail, return receipt requested, facsimile, courier service or personal delivery:

if to NBHC to:
National Bank Holdings Corporation
7800 East Orchard Road, Suite 300
Greenwood Village, CO 80111

5


 

Facsimile:  (855) 576-3479
Attention:  Legal Department

if to Participant:  at the address last on the records of NBHC.

All such notices, demands and other communications shall be deemed to have been duly given (i) when delivered by hand, if personally delivered; (ii) when delivered by courier, if delivered by commercial courier service; (iii) five business days after being deposited in the mail, postage prepaid, if mailed; and (iv) when receipt is mechanically acknowledged, if by facsimile.

 

(e)

Severability .  The invalidity or unenforceability of any provision of this Agreement shall not affect the validity or enforceability of any other provision of this Agreement, and each other provision of this Agreement shall be severable and enforceable to the extent permitted by law.

(f)

No Rights to Service .  Nothing contained in this Agreement shall be construed as giving Participant any right to be retained, in any position, as an employee, consultant or director of NBHC or its Affiliates or shall interfere with or restrict in any way the right of NBHC or its Affiliates, which is hereby expressly reserved, to remove, terminate or discharge Participant at any time for any reason whatsoever.

(g)

Beneficiary .  Participant may file with NBHC a written designation of a beneficiary on such form as may be prescribed by the Committee and may, from time to time, change or revoke such designation by filing a new designation with NBHC.  The last such designation received by NBHC shall be controlling; provided ,   however , that no designation, or change or revocation thereof, shall be effective unless received by NBHC prior to Participant’s death, and in no event shall it be effective as of a date prior to such receipt.  If no beneficiary designation is filed by Participant, the beneficiary shall be deemed to be his or her spouse or, if Participant is unmarried at the time of death, his or her estate.

(h)

Successors .  The terms of this Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of NBHC, its successors and assigns, and of Participant and the beneficiaries, executors, administrators, heirs and successors of Participant.

(i)

Entire Agreement .  This Agreement and the Plan contain the entire agreement and understanding of the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter contained herein and supersede all prior communications, representations and negotiations with respect thereto.

(j)

Bound by the Plan .  By signing this Agreement, Participant acknowledges that he or she has received a copy of the Plan and has had an opportunity to review the Plan and agrees to be bound by all the terms and provisions of the Plan.

(k)

Governing Law .  This Agreement shall be construed and interpreted in accordance with the internal laws of the State of Delaware without regard to principles of conflicts of law thereof, or principles of conflicts of laws of any other jurisdiction that

6


 

could cause the application of the laws of any jurisdiction other than the State of Delaware.

(l)

Headings .  The headings of the Sections of this Agreement are provided for convenience only and are not to serve as a basis for interpretation or construction, and shall not constitute a part, of this Agreement.

(m)

Counterparts .  This Agreement may be signed in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

12.

 Certain Definitions and Administration .

(a)

Termination for Cause .   Unless otherwise provided under the termination with “cause” provisions of an Individual Agreement, to invoke a termination for Cause, NBHC must provide written notice to Participant of the existence of such grounds within 30 days following NBHC’s knowledge of the existence of such grounds, specifying in reasonable detail the grounds constituting Cause, and, with respect to the grounds enumerated in clauses (A), (C), (D) and (E) of the definition of Cause in the Plan, Participant shall have 30 days following receipt of such written notice during which he or she may remedy the ground if such ground is reasonably subject to cure as determined by NBHC. 

(b)

Good Reason ” shall have the meaning given to such term in an Individual Agreement, or if there is no such Individual Agreement or if it does not define Good Reason then Good Reason shall mean the occurrence of the following, in the absence of Participant’s written consent:

(i)

a material diminution in Participant’s annual base salary from that in effect immediately prior to a Change in Control; or

(ii)

the assignment to Participant of any duties materially inconsistent with Participant’s positions (including status, offices, titles and reporting requirements), authority, duties or responsibilities, or any other action by NBHC that results in a material diminution in such positions, authority, duties or responsibilities, in each case, from those in effect immediately prior to a Change in Control; or

provided that, in each case, (A) Participant provides written notice to NBHC of the existence of one or more of the conditions described in clauses (i) through (ii) above within 30 days following Participant’s knowledge of the initial existence of such condition or conditions, specifying in reasonable detail the conditions constituting Good Reason; (B) NBHC and its Affiliates fail to cure such event or condition within 30 days following the receipt of such notice; and (C) Participant incurs a Termination of Employment within 30 days following the expiration of such cure period.

[ Signature Page Follows ]

 

7


 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement as of the date first written above.

NATIONAL BANK HOLDINGS CORPORATION

 

 

 

By:  ____________________________________
Name:
Title: 

 

 

By:  ____________________________________
Name:
Title:  

 

 

PARTICIPANT

 

 

_______________________________________

[Participant]

 

[ Signature Page to Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement ]

 


 

Exhibit 10.15

 

 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan
PERFORMANCE RESTRICTED Stock Award Agreement

THIS PERFORMANCE RESTRICTED STOCK AWARD AGREEMENT (this “ Agreement ”), dated as of [________] (the “ Date of Grant ”), is made by and between National Bank Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“ NBHC ”), and [________] (“ Participant ”).    Capitalized terms used herein without definition have the meanings ascribed to such terms in the National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “ Plan ”).

WHEREAS, NBHC has adopted the Plan to provide NBHC officers, employees, directors, and consultants an opportunity to participate in NBHC’s future performance and align the interests of such officers, employees, directors, and consultants with those of the shareholders of NBHC; and

WHEREAS, the Committee has determined that it would be in the best interests of NBHC and its shareholders to grant Participant shares of performance vesting Restricted Stock on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement and the Plan.

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the covenants of the parties contained in this Agreement, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto, for themselves, their successors and assigns, hereby agree as follows:

1. Grant of Performance Restricted Stock Award .

(a)

Grant .  NBHC hereby grants to Participant an award of performance-vesting Restricted Stock (the “ Restricted Stock ”) in respect of [ ___ ] Shares (the “ Shares ”), on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement and as otherwise provided in the Plan.

(b)

Incorporation by Reference, Etc .  The provisions of the Plan are hereby incorporated herein by reference.  Except as otherwise expressly set forth herein, this Agreement shall be construed in accordance with the provisions of the Plan.

2. Vesting .

(a)

General .  Except as may otherwise be provided herein, subject to Participant’s continued employment, the Restricted Stock shall vest and become nonforfeitable upon the later of (i) the third anniversary of the Date of Grant (the “ Service Condition ”) and (ii) the Stock Price (as defined in Section 2(b) below) of a Share equaling or exceeding [___] per Share (“ Stock Price Goal ”) prior to the fifth anniversary of the Date of Grant (the “ Performance Condition ”).

(b)

Determination of Stock Price . The “ Stock Price ” for purposes of determining whether the Restricted Stock vests shall be determined based on the average closing price of the Shares on the Applicable Exchange for any consecutive 30-day trading period prior to the fifth anniversary of the Date of Grant. For the avoidance of doubt, once

 


 

the Stock Price Goal has been achieved, there is no requirement that the Stock Price be maintained for any period following the date of the achievement of the Stock Price Goal to satisfy the Performance Condition.

(c)

Change in Control

(i)

If, in connection with a Change in Control, Participant is provided with a Replacement Award (as defined below) and within two years following such Change in Control, Participant incurs a Termination of Employment without Cause, due to Participant’s resignation with Good Reason or due to Participant’s death or Disability, the restrictions applicable to the Replacement Award shall lapse and such Replacement Award shall become free of all restrictions as if the Service Condition and the Performance Condition had been achieved and become fully vested and transferable, notwithstanding anything contained in the Plan or the this Agreement.  If Participant is not provided with a Replacement Award in connection with a Change in Control, the Restricted Stock will vest in accordance with Section  2(c)(ii) below.

(ii)

Notwithstanding anything in the Plan or otherwise set forth in this Agreement to the contrary, upon the occurrence of a Change in Control, all restrictions on the Restricted Stock shall immediately lapse and the Restricted Stock shall be fully vested, except to the extent that another award meeting the requirements of this Section  2(c)(ii) is provided to Participant to replace the Restricted Stock award (an award meeting the requirements of this Section  2(c)(ii) , a “ Replacement Award ”).  An award shall meet the requirements of this Section 2(c)(ii) (and hence, qualify as a Replacement Award) if: (A) it is a restricted publicly traded equity security of NBHC or the surviving corporation  or the ultimate parent of the applicable entity following the Change in Control, (B) it has a fair market value at least equal to the value of the Restricted Stock as of the date of the Change in Control, (C) it contains terms relating to vesting (including with respect to Termination of Employment) that are substantially identical to the terms set forth in this Agreement, and (D) its other terms and conditions are not less favorable to Participant than the terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement or in the Plan (including provisions that apply in the event of a subsequent Change in Control) as of the date in the Change in Control.  Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, a Replacement Award may take the form of a continuation of the Restricted Stock award granted hereunder if the requirements of the preceding sentence are satisfied.  If a Replacement Award is granted, the Restricted Stock shall not vest upon a Change in Control.  The determination of whether the conditions of this Section 2(c)(ii) are satisfied shall be made by NBHC’s Compensation Committee, as constituted immediately prior to the Change in Control, in its sole discretion.    

(d)

Other Terminations of Employment .  Except as provided in the immediately following sentence, if Participant incurs a Termination of Employment prior to a Change in Control or under circumstances other than those set forth in Section  2(c)(i) as applicable to a Replacement Award, any unvested Restricted Stock or Replacement Award, as applicable, shall be forfeited by Participant without consideration, effective


 

as of the date of Termination of Employment (the “ Termination Date ”).  Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event that, prior to a Change in Control, Participant incurs a Termination of Employment without Cause, for Good Reason or due to Participant’s death or Disability, any remaining Service Condition on the unvested Restricted Stock shall be deemed to have been satisfied and the Restricted Stock shall vest to the extent the Performance Condition has been satisfied as of the Termination Date or is satisfied during the period beginning on the Termination Date and ending on the earlier of the first anniversary of the Termination Date and the fifth anniversary of the Date of Grant.

(e)

Expiration of Restricted Stock . Restricted Stock that is unvested on the fifth anniversary of the Date of Grant shall be forfeited by Participant for no consideration.

3. Tax Withholding .  NBHC shall reasonably determine the amount of any federal, state, local, or other income, employment, or other taxes that NBHC or any of its Subsidiaries may reasonably be obligated to withhold with respect to the grant, vesting, settlement, or other event with respect to the Restricted Stock.  NBHC’s obligation to deliver any certificates evidencing the Restricted Stock (or to make a book-entry or other electronic notation indicating ownership of such Shares), or otherwise remove the restrictive notations or legends on such Shares or certificates that refer to nontransferability as set forth in Section 5, is subject to the condition precedent that Participant either pay or provide for the amount of any such withholding obligations in such manner as may be authorized by the Committee or as may otherwise be permitted under Section 14(d) of the Plan.

4. Dividend and Voting Rights .  After the Grant Date of Grant, Participant shall be the record owner of the Restricted Stock unless and until such Shares are forfeited pursuant to Participant’s Termination of Employment or sold or otherwise disposed of, and as record owner shall be entitled to all rights of a common shareholder of NBHC, including, without limitation, voting rights, if any, with respect to the Restricted Stock; provided that (x) any cash or in-kind dividends paid with respect to unvested Restricted Stock shall be withheld by NBHC and shall be paid to Participant, without interest, only when, and if, such Restricted Stock becomes vested and (y) the Restricted Stock shall be subject to the limitations on transfer and encumbrance set forth in this Agreement and the Plan.

5. Non-Transferability .  The Restricted Stock may not, at any time prior to becoming vested, be assigned, alienated, pledged, attached, sold or otherwise transferred or encumbered by Participant other than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution, and any such purported assignment, alienation, pledge, attachment, sale, transfer or encumbrance shall be void and unenforceable against NBHC, its Subsidiaries and its Affiliates; provided that the designation of a beneficiary shall not constitute an assignment, alienation, pledge, attachment, sale, transfer or encumbrance.  The Restricted Stock shall be subject to the restrictions set forth in the Plan and this Agreement.

6. Issuance of Restricted Stock .  The Restricted Stock shall be issued by NBHC and shall be registered in Participant’s name on the stock transfer books of NBHC promptly after the date hereof. Any certificates representing Restricted Stock shall remain in the physical custody of NBHC or its designee at all times prior to the date on which the Restricted Stock vests.  Any certificates representing Restricted Stock shall have affixed thereto a legend in substantially the

3


 

following form, in addition to any other legends that may be required under federal or state securities laws: 

Transfer of this certificate and the shares represented hereby is restricted pursuant to the terms of the National Bank Holdings Corporation 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan and a Performance Restricted Stock Award Agreement, dated as of [________], between National Bank Holdings Corporation and [________].  A copy of such Agreement is on file at the offices of National Bank Holdings Corporation.

As soon as practicable following the vesting of the Restricted Stock, NBHC shall ensure that its stock transfer books reflect the vesting. If certificates for the Restricted Stock exist, such certificates for such vested Restricted Stock shall be delivered to Participant or to Participant’s legal representative along with the stock powers relating thereto.

7. Adjustment .  In the event of any event described in Section 3(h) of the Plan occurring after the Date of Grant, the adjustment provisions as provided for under Section 3(h) of the Plan shall apply to the Restricted Stock, both with respect to the amount of Shares and with respect to the Stock Price Goal set forth in Section 2 of this Agreement.

8.

Certain Definitions and Administration .

(a)

Termination with Cause .  Unless otherwise provided under the termination with “cause” provisions of an Individual Agreement, to invoke a termination with Cause, NBHC must provide written notice to Participant of the existence of such grounds within 30 days following NBHC’s knowledge of the existence of such grounds, specifying in reasonable detail the grounds constituting Cause, and, with respect to the grounds enumerated in clauses (A), (C), (D), and (E) in the definition of Cause in the Plan, Participant shall have 30 days following receipt of such written notice during which he or she may remedy the ground if such ground is reasonably subject to cure as determined by NBHC. 

(b)

Good Reason ” shall have the meaning given to such term in an Individual Agreement, or if there is no such Individual Agreement or if it does not define Good Reason, then, Good Reason shall mean the occurrence of the following,  in the absence of Participant’s written consent:

(i)

a material diminution in Participant’s annual base salary from that in effect immediately prior to a Change in Control; or

(ii)

the assignment to Participant of any duties materially inconsistent with Participant’s positions (including status, offices, titles, and reporting requirements), authority, duties, or responsibilities, or any other action by NBHC that results in a material diminution in such positions, authority, duties, or responsibilities, in each case, from those in effect immediately prior to a Change in Control;

provided that, in each case, (A) Participant provides written notice to NBHC of the existence of one or more of the conditions described in clauses (i) through (ii) within


 

30 days following Participant’s knowledge of the initial existence of such condition or conditions, specifying in reasonable detail the conditions constituting Good Reason;  (B) NBHC and its Affiliates fail to cure such event or condition within 30 days following the receipt of such notice; and (C) Participant incurs a Termination of Employment within 30 days following the expiration of such cure period.

9. Forfeiture .    Participant agrees that, notwithstanding any other provision of any agreement to which he or she is subject with NBHC or NBH Bank (collectively, the “ Company ”), and in addition to and not in contravention of any clawback provision or policy applicable to Participant as in effect from time to time (including any clawback policies or provisions implemented pursuant to Section 954 of the Dodd-Frank Wall  Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act or other applicable law):

(a)

If the Company is required to prepare an accounting restatement due to material noncompliance of the Company as a result of Participant’s misconduct in connection with any financial reporting requirement under the federal securities laws, the Committee may require Participant to forfeit unvested Restricted Stock, and/or to reimburse the Company for all amounts received under this Agreement from the Company during the 12-month period following the first public issuance or filing with the Securities and Exchange Commission (whichever first occurs) of the financial document embodying such financial reporting requirement; and any amounts received with respect to, or amounts realized from the vesting of Restricted Stock or the subsequent sale of Shares or the cancellation of the Restricted Stock during that 12 month period ;

(b)

If the Committee shall determine that Participant has engaged in a serious breach of conduct, the Committee may require Participant to forfeit unvested Restricted Stock, may terminate this Agreement and/or require Participant to repay any amounts realized upon the vesting of Restricted Stock  or on the subsequent sale of the shares of common stock that were granted as Restricted Stock or the cancellation of shares relating to Restricted Stock ;  and

(c)

If Participant is found guilty of misconduct by any judicial or administrative authority in connection with any (i) formal investigation by the Securities and Exchange Commission or (ii) other federal or state regulatory investigation, the Committee may require Participant to forfeit unvested Restricted Stock and/or may require the repayment of any amounts realized upon the vesting of Restricted Stock or on the subsequent sale of the shares of common stock that were granted as Restricted Stock or the cancellation of shares relating to Restricted Stock without regard to the timing of the determination of misconduct in relation to the timing of the vesting or sale of the award .

The foregoing provisions of this Section 9 shall cease to apply following a Change in Control, except as otherwise required by applicable law.

10. Compliance with Legal Requirements .  The grant of the Restricted Stock and any other obligations of NBHC under this Agreement shall be subject to all applicable federal and state laws, rules, and regulations and to such approvals by any regulatory or governmental agency as

5


 

may be required.  The Committee, in its sole discretion, may postpone the issuance or delivery of Shares as the Committee may consider appropriate and may require Participant to make such representations and furnish such information as it may consider appropriate in connection with the issuance or delivery of Shares in compliance with applicable laws, rules, and regulations.

11. Miscellaneous .

(a)

Confidentiality of this Agreement .  Participant agrees to keep confidential the terms of this Agreement, unless and until such terms have been disclosed publicly other than through a breach by Participant of this covenant.  This provision does not prohibit Participant from providing this information on a confidential and privileged basis to Participant’s attorneys or accountants for purposes of obtaining legal or tax advice or as otherwise required by law.

(b)

Restrictive Covenants .  The grant and vesting of the Restricted Stock pursuant to this Agreement shall be in partial consideration for, and subject to Participant’s continued compliance with, any restrictive covenants set forth in an Individual Agreement.

(c)

Section 409A of the Code .  It is intended that the Awards granted pursuant to this Agreement and the provisions of this Agreement be exempt from or comply with Section 409A of the Code, and all provisions of this Agreement shall be construed and interpreted in a manner consistent with Section 11(e) of the Plan and the requirements for avoiding taxes or penalties under Section 409A of the Code.

(d)

Waiver and Amendment .  The Committee may waive any conditions or rights under, or amend any terms of, this Agreement and the Restricted Stock granted hereunder; provided that any such waiver or amendment that would impair the rights of any Participant or any holder or beneficiary of any Restricted Stock heretofore granted shall not to that extent be effective without the consent of Participant.  No waiver of any right hereunder by any party shall operate as a waiver of any other right, or as a waiver of the same right with respect to any subsequent occasion for its exercise, or as a waiver of any right to damages.  No waiver by any party of any breach of this Agreement shall be held to constitute a waiver of any other breach or a waiver of the continuation of the same breach.

(e)

Notices .  All notices, demands and other communications provided for or permitted hereunder shall be made in writing and shall be by registered or certified first-class mail, return receipt requested, facsimile, courier service or personal delivery:

if to NBHC to:
National Bank Holdings Corporation
7800 East Orchard Road, Suite 300
Greenwood Village, CO 80111
Facsimile:  (855) 576-3479
Attention:  General Counsel

if to Participant:  at the address last on the records of NBHC.


 

All such notices, demands and other communications shall be deemed to have been duly given (i) when delivered by hand, if personally delivered; (ii) when delivered by courier, if delivered by commercial courier service; (iii) five business days after being deposited in the mail, postage prepaid, if mailed; and (iv) when receipt is mechanically acknowledged, if by facsimile.

(f) Severability .  The invalidity or unenforceability of any provision of this Agreement shall not affect the validity or enforceability of any other provision of this Agreement, and each other provision of this Agreement shall be severable and enforceable to the extent permitted by law.

(g) No Rights to Service .  Nothing contained in this Agreement shall be construed as giving Participant any right to be retained, in any position, as an employee, consultant, or director of NBHC or its Affiliates or shall interfere with or restrict in any way the right of NBHC or its Affiliates, which is hereby expressly reserved, to remove, terminate, or discharge Participant at any time for any reason whatsoever.

(h) Beneficiary .  Participant may file with NBHC a written designation of a beneficiary on such form as may be prescribed by the Committee and may, from time to time, change or revoke such designation by filing a new designation with NBHC.  The last such designation received by NBHC shall be controlling; provided ,   however , that no designation, or change or revocation thereof, shall be effective unless received by NBHC prior to Participant’s death, and in no event shall it be effective as of a date prior to such receipt.  If no beneficiary designation is filed by Participant, the beneficiary shall be deemed to be his or her spouse or, if Participant is unmarried at the time of death, his or her estate.

(i) Successors .  The terms of this Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of NBHC, its successors and assigns, and of Participant and the beneficiaries, executors, administrators, heirs and successors of Participant.

(j) Entire Agreement .  This Agreement and the Plan contain the entire agreement and understanding of the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter contained herein and supersede all prior communications, representations and negotiations with respect thereto.

(k) Bound by the Plan .  By signing this Agreement, Participant acknowledges that he or she has received a copy of the Plan and has had an opportunity to review the Plan and agrees to be bound by all the terms and provisions of the Plan.

(l) Governing Law .  This Agreement shall be construed and interpreted in accordance with the internal laws of the State of Delaware without regard to principles of conflicts of law thereof, or principles of conflicts of laws of any other jurisdiction that could cause the application of the laws of any jurisdiction other than the State of Delaware .

(m) Headings .  The headings of the Sections of this Agreement are provided for convenience only and are not to serve as a basis for interpretation or construction, and shall not constitute a part, of this Agreement.

7


 

(n) Counterparts .  This Agreement may be signed in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

[ Signature Page Follows ]

 


 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement as of the date first written above.

NATIONAL BANK HOLDINGS CORPORATION

 

 

By: _____________________________________
      Name:

      Title:

 

 

By: _____________________________________
      Name:

      Title:

 

 

PARTICIPANT

 

 

_________________________________________
[Participant] 

 

[ Signature Page to Performance Restricted Stock Award Agreement ]

 

 


 

Exhibit 21.1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Subsidiary

    

Jurisdiction of Organization

    

Trade Names

NBH Bank

 

Colorado

 

Bank Midwest; Community Banks of Colorado; Hillcrest Bank; and NBH Capital Finance

NBH Realty I, LLC

 

Missouri

 

 

NBH Realty II, LLC

 

Missouri

 

 

 

 


 

Exhibit 23.1

 

 

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

The Board of Directors and Shareholders

National Bank Holdings Corporation:

 

We consent to the incorporation by reference in the registration statement No. 333-177971 on Form S-1, No. 333-184054 on Form S-3, and No. 333-204071 and No. 333-195785 on Form S-8 of National Bank Holdings Corporation and subsidiaries (the Company) of our reports dated February 24, 2017, with respect to the consolidated statements of financial condition of the Company as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss), changes in shareholders' equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2016, and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016, which reports appear in the December 31, 2016 annual report on Form 10-K of the Company. Our report refers to the Company’s adoption of FASB Accounting Standards Update (ASU) No. 2016-09, Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting in 2016.

IMAGE - IMAGE1.JPEG

 

Kansas City,  Missouri

February 24, 2017

 

 


 

Exhibit 31.1

Certifications of CEO pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

I, G. Timothy Laney, Chief Executive Officer, certify that:

1.

I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of National Bank Holdings Corporation;

2.

Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

3.

Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

4. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:

a.

Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

b.

Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

c.

Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

d.

Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

5. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

a.

All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

b.

Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

 

 

Date:

February 24, 2017

/s/ G. Timothy Laney

 

 

G. Timothy Laney

 

 

Chief Executive Officer

 

 


 

Exhibit 31.2

Certifications of CFO pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

I, Brian F. Lilly, Chief Financial Officer, certify that:

1.

I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of National Bank Holdings Corporation;

2.

Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

3.

Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

4.

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:

a.

Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

b.

Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

c.

Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

d.

Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

5. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

a.

All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

b.

Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

9

 

 

Date:

February 24, 2017

/s/ Brian F. Lilly

 

 

Brian F. Lilly

 

 

Chief Financial Officer; Chief of M&A and Strategy

 

 


 

Exhibit 32

Certifications of CEO and CFO pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

In connection with the annual report of National Bank Holdings Corporation (the “Company”) on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2016, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “Report”), each of the undersigned officers certifies pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that, to the best of his knowledge: (1) this Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and (2) the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operation of the Company.

 

 

 

 

Date:

February 24, 2017

/s/ G. Timothy Laney

 

 

G. Timothy Laney

 

 

Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 

Date:

February 24, 2017

/s/ Brian F. Lilly

 

 

Brian F. Lilly

 

 

Chief Financial Officer; Chief of M&A and Strategy